Document the change to system_filter_user's default.
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
1 . $Cambridge: exim/doc/doc-docbook/spec.xfpt,v 1.88 2010/06/14 18:51:09 pdp Exp $
2 .
3 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
5 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
6 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
7 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
8 .
9 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
10 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
11 . unwanted vertical space.
12 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13
14 .include stdflags
15 .include stdmacs
16
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
19 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20
21 .docbook
22
23 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
25 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
26 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
27 . processors.
28 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29
30 .literal xml
31 <?sdop
32 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
33 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
34 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
35 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
36 ?>
37 .literal off
38
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
41 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42
43 .book
44
45 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
46 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing. Remember that
47 . the <bookinfo> element must also be updated for each new edition.
48 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
49
50 .set previousversion "4.71"
51 .set version "4.72"
52
53 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
54 .set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
55
56
57 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
58 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
59 . provided in the xfpt library.
60 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
61
62 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
63
64 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
65
66 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
67 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
68
69 .flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
70 .flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
71
72 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
73 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
74 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
75 . --- index entry.
76
77 .macro option
78 .arg 5
79 .oindex "&%$5%&"
80 .endarg
81 .arg -5
82 .oindex "&%$1%&"
83 .endarg
84 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
85 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
86 .endtable
87 .endmacro
88
89 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
90 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
91 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
92
93 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
94 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
95 .endmacro
96
97 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
98 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
99 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
100
101 .macro irow
102 .arg 4
103 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
104 .endarg
105 .arg -4
106 .arg 3
107 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
108 .endarg
109 .arg -3
110 .row "&I;$1" "$2"
111 .endarg
112 .endarg
113 .endmacro
114
115 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
116 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
117 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
118 . --- ID that ties them together.
119
120 .macro cindex
121 &<indexterm role="concept">&
122 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
123 .arg 2
124 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
125 .endarg
126 &</indexterm>&
127 .endmacro
128
129 .macro scindex
130 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
131 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
132 .arg 3
133 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
134 .endarg
135 &</indexterm>&
136 .endmacro
137
138 .macro ecindex
139 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
140 .endmacro
141
142 .macro oindex
143 &<indexterm role="option">&
144 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
145 .arg 2
146 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
147 .endarg
148 &</indexterm>&
149 .endmacro
150
151 .macro vindex
152 &<indexterm role="variable">&
153 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
154 .arg 2
155 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
156 .endarg
157 &</indexterm>&
158 .endmacro
159
160 .macro index
161 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
162 .endmacro
163 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
164
165
166 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
167 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
168 . output formats.
169 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
170
171 .literal xml
172 <bookinfo>
173 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
174 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
175 <date>29 May 2010</date>
176 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
177 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
178 <revhistory><revision>
179 <revnumber>4.72</revnumber>
180 <date>29 May 2010</date>
181 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
182 </revision></revhistory>
183 <copyright><year>2009</year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
184 </bookinfo>
185 .literal off
186
187
188 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
189 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
190 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
191 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193
194 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
195 .literal xml
196
197 <indexterm role="variable">
198 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
199 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
200 </indexterm>
201 <indexterm role="concept">
202 <primary>address</primary>
203 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
204 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
205 </indexterm>
206 <indexterm role="concept">
207 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
208 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
209 </indexterm>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
213 </indexterm>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>CR character</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
217 </indexterm>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CRL</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
221 </indexterm>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>delivery</primary>
224 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
225 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
226 </indexterm>
227 <indexterm role="concept">
228 <primary>dialup</primary>
229 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
230 </indexterm>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>exiscan</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
234 </indexterm>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>failover</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
238 </indexterm>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>fallover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242 </indexterm>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>filter</primary>
245 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
246 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
247 </indexterm>
248 <indexterm role="concept">
249 <primary>ident</primary>
250 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
251 </indexterm>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>LF character</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
255 </indexterm>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>maximum</primary>
258 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
259 </indexterm>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>monitor</primary>
262 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
263 </indexterm>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
266 <see>entry for xxx</see>
267 </indexterm>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>NUL</primary>
270 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
271 </indexterm>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>passwd file</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
275 </indexterm>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>process id</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
279 </indexterm>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>RBL</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
283 </indexterm>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>redirection</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
287 </indexterm>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>return path</primary>
290 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
291 </indexterm>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>scanning</primary>
294 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
295 </indexterm>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>SSL</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
299 </indexterm>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>string</primary>
302 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
303 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
304 </indexterm>
305 <indexterm role="concept">
306 <primary>top bit</primary>
307 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
308 </indexterm>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>variables</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
312 </indexterm>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
316 </indexterm>
317
318 .literal off
319
320
321 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
322 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
323 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
324 . chapter "Introduction"
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326
327 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
328 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
329 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
330 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
331
332 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
333 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
334 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
335 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
336 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
337 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
338 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
339
340 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
341 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
342 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
343
344 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
345 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
346 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
347
348 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
349 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
350 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
351 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
352 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
353
354 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
355 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
356 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
357 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
358 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
359
360 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
361 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
362 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
363 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
364 contributors.
365
366
367 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
368 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
369 .new
370 .cindex "documentation"
371 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version; of Exim.
372 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
373 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
374 capable of showing a change indicator.
375 .wen
376
377 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
378 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
379 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
380 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
381 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
382 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
383 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
384 very wide interest.
385
386 .cindex "books about Exim"
387 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
388 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
389 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
390 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
391
392 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
393 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
394 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
395 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
396
397 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
398 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
399 Debian-specific features in the file
400 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
401 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
402 information.
403
404 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
405 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
406 .cindex "change log"
407 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
408 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
409 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
410 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
411 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
412
413 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
414 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
415 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
416 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
417
418 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
419 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
420
421 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
422 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
423 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
424 directory are:
425
426 .table2 100pt
427 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
428 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
429 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
430 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
431 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
432 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
433 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
434 .endtable
435
436 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
437 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
438 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
439
440
441
442 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
443 .cindex "web site"
444 .cindex "FTP site"
445 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
446 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
447 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
448 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
449 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
450 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
451
452 .cindex "wiki"
453 .cindex "FAQ"
454 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
455 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
456 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
457 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
458 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
459
460 .cindex Bugzilla
461 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
462 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
463 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
464
465
466
467 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
468 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
469 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
470
471 .table2 140pt
472 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
473 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
474 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
475 .row &'exim-future@exim.org'& "Discussion of long-term development"
476 .endtable
477
478 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
479 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
480 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
481 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
482 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
483 via this web page:
484 .display
485 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
486 .endd
487 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
488 lists.
489
490 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
491 .cindex "training courses"
492 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
493 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
494 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
495 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
496
497 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
498 .cindex "bug reports"
499 .cindex "reporting bugs"
500 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
501 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
502 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
503 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
504
505
506
507 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
508 .cindex "FTP site"
509 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
510 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
511 .display
512 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
513 .endd
514 This is mirrored by
515 .display
516 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
517 .endd
518 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
519 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
520 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
521
522 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
523 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
524 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
525 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
526 .display
527 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
528 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
529 .endd
530 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
531 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
532 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
533
534 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
535 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
536 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
537 The distributions are currently signed with Nigel Metheringham's GPG key. The
538 corresponding public key is available from a number of keyservers, and there is
539 also a copy in the file &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. The signatures for the tar bundles are
540 in:
541 .display
542 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
543 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
544 .endd
545 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
546 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
547 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
548
549 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
550 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
551 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
552 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
553 .display
554 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
555 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
556 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
557 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
558 .endd
559 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
560 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
561
562
563 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
564 .ilist
565 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
566 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
567 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
568 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
569 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
570 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
571 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
572 .next
573 .cindex "domainless addresses"
574 .cindex "address" "without domain"
575 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
576 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
577 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
578 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
579 arrival.
580 .next
581 .cindex "transport" "external"
582 .cindex "external transports"
583 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
584 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
585 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
586 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
587 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
588 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
589 .next
590 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
591 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
592 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
593 other means.
594 .next
595 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
596 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
597 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
598 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
599 a number of common scanners are provided.
600 .endlist
601
602
603 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
604 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
605 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
606 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
607 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
608 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
609
610
611 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
612 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
613 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
614 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
615 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
616 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
617 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
618 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
619 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
620 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
621 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
622 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
623
624 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
625 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
626 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
627 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
628
629
630
631 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
632 .cindex "terminology definitions"
633 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
634 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
635 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
636 below) by a blank line.
637
638 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
639 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
640 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
641 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
642 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
643 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
644 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
645 rise to further bounce messages.
646
647 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
648 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
649 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
650 otherwise.
651
652 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
653 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
654 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
655 until a later time.
656
657 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
658 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
659 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
660
661 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
662 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
663 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
664 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
665 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
666 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
667 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
668 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
669
670 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
671 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
672 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
673 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
674 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
675 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
676 line.
677
678 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
679 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
680 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
681 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
682 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
683
684 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
685 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
686 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
687 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
688 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
689 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
690
691 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
692 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
693 message's envelope.
694
695 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
696 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
697 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
698 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
699 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
700
701 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
702 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
703 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
704 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
705 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
706
707 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
708 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
709 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
710 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
711 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
712 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
713
714
715
716
717
718
719 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
720 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
721
722 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
723 .cindex "incorporated code"
724 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
725 .cindex "PCRE"
726 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
727
728 .ilist
729 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
730 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
731 &copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
732 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
733 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
734 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
735 .next
736 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
737 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
738 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
739 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
740 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
741 following statements:
742
743 .blockquote
744 Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
745
746 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
747 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
748 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
749 version.
750 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
751 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
752 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
753 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
754 restrictions applied to it).
755 .endblockquote
756 .next
757 .cindex "SPA authentication"
758 .cindex "Samba project"
759 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
760 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
761 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
762 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
763 under the Gnu GPL.
764 .next
765 .cindex "Cyrus"
766 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
767 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
768 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
769 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
770 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
771 conditions expressed therein.
772
773 .blockquote
774 Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
775
776 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
777 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
778 are met:
779
780 .olist
781 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
782 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
783 .next
784 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
785 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
786 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
787 distribution.
788 .next
789 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
790 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
791 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
792 details, please contact
793 .display
794 Office of Technology Transfer
795 Carnegie Mellon University
796 5000 Forbes Avenue
797 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
798 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
799 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
800 .endd
801 .next
802 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
803 acknowledgment:
804
805 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
806 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
807
808 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
809 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
810 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
811 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
812 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
813 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
814 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
815 .endlist
816 .endblockquote
817
818 .next
819 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
820 .cindex "X-windows"
821 .cindex "Athena"
822 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
823 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
824 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
825 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
826
827 .blockquote
828 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
829 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
830
831 All Rights Reserved
832
833 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
834 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
835 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
836 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
837 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
838 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
839 software without specific, written prior permission.
840
841 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
842 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
843 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
844 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
845 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
846 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
847 SOFTWARE.
848 .endblockquote
849
850 .next
851 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
852 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
853 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
854 .endlist
855
856
857
858
859
860 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
861 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
862
863 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
864 "Receiving and delivering mail"
865
866
867 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
868 .cindex "design philosophy"
869 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
870 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
871 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
872 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
873 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
874 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
875
876
877 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
878 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
879 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
880 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
881 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
882 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
883 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
884
885 .ilist
886 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
887 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
888 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
889 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
890 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
891 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
892 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
893 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
894 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
895 error code.
896 .next
897 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
898 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
899 .next
900 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
901 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
902 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
903 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
904 .next
905 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
906 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
907 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
908 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
909 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
910 .next
911 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
912 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
913 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
914 .next
915 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
916 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
917 runs at the start of every delivery process.
918 .endlist
919
920
921
922 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
923 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
924 .cindex "Sieve filter"
925 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
926 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
927 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
928 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
929 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
930 of filtering are available:
931
932 .ilist
933 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
934 by RFC 3028.
935 .next
936 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
937 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
938 .endlist
939
940 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
941
942
943
944 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
945 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
946 .cindex "format" "of message id"
947 .cindex "id of message"
948 .cindex "base62"
949 .cindex "base36"
950 .cindex "Darwin"
951 .cindex "Cygwin"
952 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
953 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
954 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
955 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
956 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
957 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
958 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
959 not always case-sensitive.
960
961 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
962 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
963 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
964 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
965 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
966 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
967 somewhat eccentric:
968
969 .ilist
970 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
971 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
972 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
973 way of representing the date and time of day).
974 .next
975 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
976 received the message.
977 .next
978 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
979 .olist
980 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
981 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
982 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
983 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
984 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
985 .next
986 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
987 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
988 (1/100) of a second.
989 .endlist
990 .endlist
991
992 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
993 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
994 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
995 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
996 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
997
998
999 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1000 .cindex "receiving mail"
1001 .cindex "message" "reception"
1002 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1003 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1004 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1005 there are several possibilities:
1006
1007 .ilist
1008 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1009 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1010 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1011 .next
1012 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1013 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1014 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1015 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1016 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1017 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1018 .next
1019 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1020 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1021 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1022 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1023 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1024 .next
1025 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1026 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1027 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1028 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1029 .endlist
1030
1031
1032 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1033 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1034 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1035 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1036 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1037 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1038 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1039 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1040 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1041 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1042 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1043 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1044 users to change sender addresses.
1045
1046 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1047 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1048 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1049 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1050 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1051 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1052 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1053
1054 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1055 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1056 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1057 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1058 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1059 message is received.
1060
1061
1062
1063
1064
1065 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1066 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1067 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1068 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1069 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1070 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1071 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1072 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1073
1074 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1075 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1076 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1077 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1078 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1079 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1080 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1081 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1082 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1083 affect file system performance.
1084
1085 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1086 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1087 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1088 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1089 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1090
1091 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1092 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1093 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1094 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1095 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1096 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1097 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1098 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1099 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1100 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1101 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1102 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1103
1104
1105
1106 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1107 .cindex "message" "life of"
1108 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1109 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1110 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1111 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1112 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1113 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1114 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1115
1116 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1117 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1118 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1119 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1120 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1121 to be sent.
1122
1123 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1124 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1125 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1126 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1127 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1128
1129 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1130 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1131 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1132 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1133 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1134 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1135 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1136 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1137 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1138 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1139 systems.
1140
1141 .cindex "journal file"
1142 .cindex "file" "journal"
1143 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1144 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1145 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1146 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1147 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1148 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1149 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1150 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1151
1152 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1153 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1154 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1155 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1156 deliveries caused by crashes.
1157
1158
1159
1160 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1161 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1162 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1163 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1164 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1165 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1166 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1167 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1168 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1169
1170 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1171 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1172 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1173 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1174 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1175 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1176 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1177 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1178 the driver's features in general.
1179
1180 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1181 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1182 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1183 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1184 to be bounced.
1185
1186 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1187 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1188 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1189 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1190 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1191 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1192
1193 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1194 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1195 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1196 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1197 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1198 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1199
1200 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1201 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1202 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1203 configuration.
1204
1205 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1206 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1207 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1208 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1209 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1210 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1211 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1212 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1213 configured to fail the address.
1214
1215 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1216 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1217 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1218 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1219 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1220 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1221
1222 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1223 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1224 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1225 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1226 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1227 the address is bounced.
1228
1229
1230
1231 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1232 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1233 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1234 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1235 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1236 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1237 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1238 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1239
1240 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1241 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1242 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1243 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1244 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1245 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1246 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1247 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1248
1249
1250
1251
1252 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1253 .cindex "router" "running details"
1254 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1255 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1256 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1257 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1258 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1259 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1260 the following:
1261
1262 .ilist
1263 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1264 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1265 original address ceases,
1266 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1267 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1268 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1269 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1270 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1271 end of routing.
1272
1273 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1274 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1275 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1276 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1277 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1278 .next
1279 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1280 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1281 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1282 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1283 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1284 .next
1285 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1286 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1287 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1288 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1289 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1290 .next
1291 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1292 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1293 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1294 .next
1295 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1296 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1297 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1298 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1299 .next
1300 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1301 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1302 .endlist
1303
1304 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1305 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1306 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1307 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1308 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1309
1310 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1311 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1312 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1313 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1314 facility for this purpose.
1315
1316
1317 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1318 .cindex "case of local parts"
1319 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1320 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1321 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1322 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1323 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1324 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1325 routed addresses are shown.
1326
1327
1328
1329 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1330 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1331 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1332 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1333 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1334 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1335
1336 .ilist
1337 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1338 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1339 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1340 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1341 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1342 of any other conditions.
1343 .next
1344 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1345 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1346 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1347 address.
1348 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1349 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1350 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1351 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1352 .next
1353 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1354 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1355 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1356 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1357 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1358 .next
1359 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1360 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1361 .next
1362 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1363 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1364 .next
1365 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1366 of domains that it defines.
1367 .next
1368 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1369 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1370 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1371 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1372 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1373 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1374 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1375 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1376 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1377 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1378 .next
1379 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1380 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1381 .vindex "&$home$&"
1382 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1383 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1384 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1385 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1386 remaining preconditions.
1387 .next
1388 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1389 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1390 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1391 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1392 could lead to confusion.
1393 .next
1394 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1395 set of addresses that it defines.
1396 .next
1397 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1398 specified files is tested.
1399 .next
1400 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1401 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1402 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1403 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1404 .endlist
1405
1406
1407 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1408 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1409 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1410 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1411 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1412 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1413 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1414
1415
1416
1417 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1418 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1419 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1420
1421 .ilist
1422 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1423 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1424 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1425 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1426 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1427 filtering'&.
1428 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1429 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1430
1431 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1432 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1433 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1434 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1435 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1436 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1437 filter.
1438 .next
1439 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1440 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1441 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1442 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1443 processed entirely independently of each other.
1444 .next
1445 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1446 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1447 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1448 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1449 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1450 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1451 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1452 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1453 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1454 .next
1455 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1456 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1457 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1458 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1459 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1460 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1461 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1462 addresses to the same domain.
1463 .next
1464 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1465 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1466 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1467 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1468 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1469 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1470 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1471 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1472 .next
1473 .cindex "queue runner"
1474 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1475 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1476 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1477 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1478 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1479 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1480 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1481 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1482 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1483 .next
1484 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1485 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1486 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1487 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1488 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1489 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1490 .next
1491 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1492 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1493 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1494 messages to other addresses.
1495 .next
1496 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1497 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1498 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1499 &'deferred'&.
1500 .next
1501 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1502 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1503 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1504 .endlist
1505
1506
1507
1508
1509 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1510 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1511 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1512 .cindex "queue runner"
1513 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1514 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1515 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1516 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1517 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1518 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1519 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1520 passed its retry time.
1521 You can run several queue runners at once.
1522
1523 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1524 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1525 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1526 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1527 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1528 as permanent.
1529
1530
1531
1532 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1533 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1534 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1535 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1536 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1537 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1538 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1539 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1540 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1541 also apply.
1542
1543 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1544 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1545 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1546 deferred,
1547
1548 .cindex "hints database"
1549 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1550 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1551 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1552 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1553 one connection.
1554
1555
1556
1557
1558 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1559 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1560 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1561 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1562 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1563 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1564 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1565 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1566 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1567 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1568 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1569
1570 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1571 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1572 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1573 automatically.
1574
1575 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1576 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1577 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1578 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1579 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1580 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1581 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1582 of the list.
1583
1584
1585
1586 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1587 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1588 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1589 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1590 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1591 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1592 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1593 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1594
1595
1596
1597
1598
1599 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1600 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1601
1602 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1603 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1604
1605 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1606 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1607 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1608 &_exim-&version;_&) into which the following files are placed:
1609
1610 .table2 140pt
1611 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1612 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1613 documented"
1614 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1615 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1616 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1617 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1618 instructions"
1619 .endtable
1620
1621 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1622 following subdirectories are created:
1623
1624 .table2 140pt
1625 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1626 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1627 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1628 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1629 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1630 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1631 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1632 .endtable
1633
1634 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1635 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1636 that may be useful to some sites.
1637
1638
1639 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1640 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1641 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1642 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1643 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1644 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1645 system.
1646 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1647 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1648 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1649 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1650 overridden if necessary.
1651
1652
1653 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1654 .cindex "PCRE library"
1655 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1656 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1657 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1658 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1659 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1660 headers are in an unusual location you will need to set the PCRE_LIBS
1661 and INCLUDE directives appropriately. If your operating system has no
1662 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1663 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1664
1665 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1666 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1667 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1668 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1669 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1670 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1671 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1672
1673 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1674 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1675 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1676 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1677 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1678 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1679 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1680 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1681
1682 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1683 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1684 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1685 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1686 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1687 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1688 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1689 Berkeley DB library.
1690
1691 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1692 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1693 possibilities:
1694
1695 .olist
1696 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1697 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1698 .next
1699 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1700 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1701 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1702 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1703 file name is used unmodified.
1704 .next
1705 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1706 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1707 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1708 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1709 .next
1710 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1711 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1712 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1713 .next
1714 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1715 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1716 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1717 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1718 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1719 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1720 .next
1721 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1722 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1723 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1724 operates on a single file.
1725 .endlist
1726
1727 .cindex "USE_DB"
1728 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1729 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1730 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1731 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1732 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1733 .code
1734 USE_DB=yes
1735 .endd
1736 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1737 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1738
1739 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1740 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1741 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1742 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1743 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1744 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1745
1746 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1747 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1748 in one of these lines:
1749 .code
1750 DBMLIB = -ldb
1751 DBMLIB = -ltdb
1752 .endd
1753 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1754 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1755 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1756 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1757 this example:
1758 .code
1759 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1760 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1761 .endd
1762 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1763 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1764
1765
1766
1767 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1768 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1769 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1770 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1771 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1772 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1773 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1774 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1775 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1776 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1777 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1778 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1779
1780 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1781 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1782 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1783 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1784 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1785 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1786
1787 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1788 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1789 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1790 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1791 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1792 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1793 be logged.
1794
1795 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1796 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1797 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1798 facilities, you need to set
1799 .code
1800 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1801 .endd
1802 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1803 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1804
1805
1806 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1807 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1808 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1809 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1810 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1811 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1812 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1813
1814 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1815 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1816 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1817 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1818 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1819 do this.
1820
1821
1822
1823 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1824 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1825 .cindex "RFC 2047"
1826 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1827 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1828 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1829 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1830 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1831 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1832 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1833
1834 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1835 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1836 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1837 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1838 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1839 .code
1840 HAVE_ICONV=yes
1841 .endd
1842 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1843
1844
1845
1846 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1847 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1848 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1849 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1850 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1851 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1852 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1853 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1854 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1855 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1856 line option).
1857
1858 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1859 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1860 implementing SSL.
1861
1862 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1863 .code
1864 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1865 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1866 .endd
1867 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1868 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1869 .code
1870 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1871 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1872 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1873 .endd
1874 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1875 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1876 .code
1877 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1878 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1879 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1880 .endd
1881 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1882 library and include files. For example:
1883 .code
1884 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1885 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1886 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1887 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1888 .endd
1889 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1890 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1891 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1892
1893
1894
1895
1896 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1897 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1898 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1899 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1900 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1901 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1902 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1903 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1904 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1905 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1906 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1907 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1908 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1909 you might have
1910 .code
1911 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1912 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1913 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1914 .endd
1915 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1916 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1917 .code
1918 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1919 .endd
1920 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1921 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1922 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1923 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1924 in &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1925 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1926 further details.
1927
1928
1929
1930 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1931 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1932 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1933 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1934 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1935 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1936 library files.
1937
1938 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1939 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1940 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1941 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1942 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&. It is not known
1943 if anyone is actually using A6 records. Exim has support for A6 records, but
1944 this is included only if you set &`SUPPORT_A6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
1945 support has not been tested for some time.
1946
1947
1948
1949 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
1950 .cindex "build directory"
1951 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
1952 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
1953 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
1954 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
1955 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
1956 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
1957 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
1958
1959 &*Warning*&: The &%-j%& (parallel) flag must not be used with &'make'&; the
1960 building process fails if it is set.
1961
1962 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
1963 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
1964 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
1965 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
1966 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
1967 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
1968 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
1969 directory, should this ever be necessary.
1970
1971 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
1972 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
1973 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
1974
1975
1976
1977 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
1978 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
1979 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
1980 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
1981 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
1982 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
1983 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
1984 .code
1985 FULLECHO='' make -e
1986 .endd
1987 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
1988 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
1989 given in addition to the short output.
1990
1991
1992
1993 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
1994 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
1995 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
1996 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
1997 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
1998 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
1999 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2000 order:
2001 .display
2002 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2003 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2004 &_Local/Makefile_&
2005 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2006 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2007 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2008 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2009 .endd
2010 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2011 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2012 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2013 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2014 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2015 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2016 and are often not needed.
2017
2018 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2019 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2020 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2021 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2022 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2023 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2024 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2025 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2026 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2027
2028
2029 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2030 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2031 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2032 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2033 default values are.
2034
2035
2036 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2037 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2038 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2039 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2040 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2041 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2042 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2043 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2044 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2045 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2046 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2047 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2048 containing the lines
2049 .code
2050 CC=cc
2051 CFLAGS=-std1
2052 .endd
2053 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2054 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2055
2056 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2057 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2058 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2059
2060
2061 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2062 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2063 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2064 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2065 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2066 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2067 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2068 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2069 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2070 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2071 .code
2072 LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2073 LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2074 LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2075 .endd
2076 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2077 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2078 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2079 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2080 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2081 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2082 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2083 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2084 errors.
2085
2086 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2087 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2088 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2089 .code
2090 EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2091 .endd
2092 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2093 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2094
2095 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2096 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2097 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2098 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2099 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2100 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2101 .code
2102 X11=/usr/X11R6
2103 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2104 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2105 .endd
2106 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2107 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2108 .code
2109 X11=/usr/openwin
2110 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2111 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2112 .endd
2113 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2114 definition of all three of these variables into your
2115 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2116
2117 .cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2118 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2119 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2120 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2121 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2122
2123 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2124 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2125 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2126 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2127 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2128 libraries.
2129
2130 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2131 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2132 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2133 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2134 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2135
2136
2137 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2138 .cindex "&_os.h_&"
2139 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2140 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2141 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2142 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2143 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2144 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2145
2146
2147
2148 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2149 .cindex "building Eximon"
2150 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2151 where the files that are involved are
2152 .display
2153 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2154 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2155 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2156 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2157 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2158 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2159 .endd
2160 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2161 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2162 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2163 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2164 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2165 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2166 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2167 .ecindex IIDbuex
2168
2169
2170 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2171 .cindex "installing Exim"
2172 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2173 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2174 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2175 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2176 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2177 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2178 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2179 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2180 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2181 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2182 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2183 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2184
2185 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2186 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2187 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2188 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2189 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2190 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2191 alternative files, no default is installed.
2192
2193 .cindex "system aliases file"
2194 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2195 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2196 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2197 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2198 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2199 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2200 and outputs a comment to the user.
2201
2202 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2203 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2204 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2205 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2206 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2207
2208 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2209 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2210 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2211 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2212 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2213 over SMTP.
2214
2215 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2216 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2217 command such as
2218 .code
2219 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2220 .endd
2221 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2222 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2223 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2224 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2225 but this usage is deprecated.
2226
2227 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2228 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2229 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2230 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2231 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2232 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2233
2234 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2235 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2236 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2237 for example &_exim-&version;-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2238 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2239 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2240 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2241
2242 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2243 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2244 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2245 command:
2246 .code
2247 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2248 .endd
2249 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2250 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2251 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2252 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2253 command:
2254 .code
2255 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2256 .endd
2257 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2258 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2259
2260 .ilist
2261 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2262 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2263 .next
2264 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2265 installed binary.
2266 .endlist
2267
2268 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2269 .code
2270 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2271 .endd
2272 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2273 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2274 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2275 .code
2276 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2277 .endd
2278
2279
2280
2281 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2282 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2283 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2284 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2285 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2286 &<<SECTavail>>&).
2287
2288 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2289 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2290 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2291
2292
2293
2294 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2295 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2296 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2297 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2298 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2299 necessary.
2300
2301
2302
2303
2304 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2305 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2306 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2307 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2308 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2309 .code
2310 exim -bV
2311 .endd
2312 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2313 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2314 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2315 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2316 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2317 example,
2318 .display
2319 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2320 .endd
2321 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2322 .display
2323 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2324 .endd
2325 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2326 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2327 user agent. For example:
2328 .code
2329 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2330 From: user@your.domain.example
2331 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2332 Subject: Testing Exim
2333
2334 This is a test message.
2335 ^D
2336 .endd
2337 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2338 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2339 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2340
2341 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2342 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2343 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2344 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2345 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2346 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2347 .display
2348 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2349 .endd
2350 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2351 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2352 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2353 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2354 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2355
2356 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2357 .cindex "lock files"
2358 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2359 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2360 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2361 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2362 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2363 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2364 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2365 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2366 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2367 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2368 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2369 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2370
2371 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2372 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2373 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2374 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2375 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2376 incoming SMTP mail.
2377
2378 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2379 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2380 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2381 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2382 production version.
2383
2384
2385 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2386 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2387 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2388 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2389 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2390 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2391 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2392 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2393 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2394 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2395 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2396 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2397 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2398
2399 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2400 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2401 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2402 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2403 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2404 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2405 as follows:
2406 .code
2407 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2408 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2409 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2410 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2411 .endd
2412 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2413 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2414 favourite user agent.
2415
2416 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2417 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2418 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2419 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2420 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2421 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2422
2423
2424
2425 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2426 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2427 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2428 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2429 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2430 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2431 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2432 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2433 configuration file.
2434
2435
2436
2437
2438 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2439 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2440 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2441 .code
2442 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2443 .endd
2444 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2445 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2446 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2447 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2448 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2449 .code
2450 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2451 .endd
2452 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2453
2454 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2455 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2456 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2457
2458
2459
2460
2461 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2462 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2463
2464 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2465 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2466 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2467 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2468 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2469 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2470 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2471 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2472 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2473
2474
2475 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2476 .cindex "&'mailq'&"
2477 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2478 were present before any other options.
2479 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2480 standard output.
2481 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2482 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2483 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2484
2485 .cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2486 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2487 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2488 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2489 format.
2490
2491 .cindex "&'rmail'&"
2492 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2493 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2494 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2495
2496 .cindex "&'runq'&"
2497 .cindex "queue runner"
2498 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2499 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2500 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2501
2502 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2503 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2504 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2505 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2506 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2507 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2508 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2509 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2510
2511
2512 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2513 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2514 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2515 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2516 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2517 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2518
2519 .ilist
2520 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2521 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2522 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2523 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2524 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2525 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2526
2527 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2528 .cindex "envelope sender"
2529 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2530 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2531 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2532 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2533 users to set envelope senders.
2534
2535 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2536 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2537 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2538 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2539 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2540
2541 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2542 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2543 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2544 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2545 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2546 that are available to trusted users.
2547 .next
2548 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2549 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2550 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2551 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2552 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2553
2554 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2555 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2556 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2557 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2558
2559 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2560 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2561 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2562 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2563
2564 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2565 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2566 false.
2567 .endlist
2568
2569
2570 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2571 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2572 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2573 &<<CHAPconf>>&.
2574
2575
2576
2577
2578 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2579 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2580 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2581 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2582 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2583 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2584 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2585 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2586
2587 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2588 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2589 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2590 . creates a man page for the options.
2591 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2592
2593 .literal xml
2594 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2595 .literal off
2596
2597
2598 .vlist
2599 .vitem &%--%&
2600 .oindex "--"
2601 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2602 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2603 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2604 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2605
2606 .vitem &%--help%&
2607 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2608 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2609 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2610 no arguments.
2611
2612 .vitem &%--version%&
2613 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2614 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2615 displayed.
2616
2617 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2618 .oindex "&%-B%&"
2619 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2620 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2621 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2622 clean; it ignores this option.
2623
2624 .vitem &%-bd%&
2625 .oindex "&%-bd%&"
2626 .cindex "daemon"
2627 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2628 .cindex "queue runner"
2629 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2630 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2631 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2632
2633 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2634 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2635 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2636 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2637
2638 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2639 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2640 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2641 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2642
2643 When a listening daemon
2644 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2645 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2646 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2647 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2648 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2649 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2650 running as root.
2651
2652 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2653 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2654 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2655
2656 The SIGHUP signal
2657 .cindex "SIGHUP"
2658 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2659 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2660 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2661 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2662 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2663 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2664 because these are reread each time they are used.
2665
2666 .vitem &%-bdf%&
2667 .oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2668 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2669 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2670
2671 .vitem &%-be%&
2672 .oindex "&%-be%&"
2673 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2674 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2675 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2676 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2677 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2678 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2679
2680 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2681 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2682 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2683 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2684 test data. A line history is supported.
2685
2686 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2687 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2688 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2689 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2690 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2691 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2692 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2693
2694 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2695 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2696 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2697 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2698
2699 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2700 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
2701 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2702 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2703 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2704 of a file. For example:
2705 .code
2706 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2707 .endd
2708 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2709 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2710 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2711 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2712 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2713 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2714 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2715 &%-be%&).
2716
2717 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2718 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
2719 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2720 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2721 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2722 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2723 system filters are recognized.
2724
2725 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2726 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
2727 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2728 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2729 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2730 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2731 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2732 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2733 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2734 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2735 supplied.
2736
2737 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2738 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2739 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2740 .code
2741 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2742 .endd
2743 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2744 variables that are used by the user filter.
2745
2746 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2747 .code
2748 # Exim filter
2749 # Sieve filter
2750 .endd
2751 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2752 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2753 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2754 redirection lists.
2755
2756 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2757 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2758 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2759 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2760
2761 When testing a filter file,
2762 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2763 .cindex "envelope sender"
2764 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2765 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2766 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2767 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2768 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2769 options).
2770
2771 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2772 .oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2773 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2774 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2775 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2776 &$qualify_domain$&.
2777
2778 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2779 .oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2780 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2781 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2782 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2783 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2784 actually being delivered.
2785
2786 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2787 .oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2788 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2789 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2790 prefix.
2791
2792 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2793 .oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2794 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2795 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2796 suffix.
2797
2798 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2799 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
2800 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2801 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2802 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2803 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2804 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2805 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2806 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2807 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2808 after a full stop. For example:
2809 .code
2810 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2811 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2812 .endd
2813 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2814 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2815 conversion to the canonical form is
2816 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2817
2818 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2819 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2820 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2821 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2822 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2823
2824 &*Warning 1*&:
2825 .cindex "RFC 1413"
2826 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2827 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2828 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2829 connection.
2830
2831 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2832 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2833 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2834
2835 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2836 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2837 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2838 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2839 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2840 session were authenticated.
2841
2842 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2843 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2844 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2845
2846 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2847 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2848 specialized SMTP test program such as
2849 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2850
2851 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2852 .oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2853 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2854 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2855 updating the callout cache database.
2856
2857 .vitem &%-bi%&
2858 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
2859 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2860 .cindex "building alias file"
2861 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2862 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2863 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2864 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2865 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2866 recognized.
2867
2868 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2869 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2870 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2871 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2872 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2873 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2874 &%-bi%& is a no-op.
2875
2876 .vitem &%-bm%&
2877 .oindex "&%-bm%&"
2878 .cindex "local message reception"
2879 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
2880 locally-generated message on the current input. The recipients are given as the
2881 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
2882 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
2883 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
2884 if no other conflicting option is present.
2885
2886 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
2887 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
2888 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
2889 suppressing this for special cases.
2890
2891 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
2892 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
2893
2894 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
2895 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
2896 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
2897
2898 The format
2899 .cindex "message" "format"
2900 .cindex "format" "message"
2901 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2902 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
2903 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
2904 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
2905 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
2906 .code
2907 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
2908 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
2909 .endd
2910 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
2911 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
2912 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
2913 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
2914 option, which can be changed if necessary.
2915
2916 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
2917 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
2918 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
2919 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
2920 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
2921
2922 .vitem &%-bnq%&
2923 .oindex "&%-bnq%&"
2924 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
2925 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
2926 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
2927 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
2928 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
2929 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
2930 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
2931
2932 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
2933 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
2934 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
2935 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
2936 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
2937
2938 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
2939 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
2940 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
2941 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
2942
2943
2944 .vitem &%-bP%&
2945 .oindex "&%-bP%&"
2946 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
2947 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
2948 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
2949 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
2950 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
2951 arguments, for example:
2952 .code
2953 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
2954 .endd
2955 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
2956 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
2957 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
2958 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
2959 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
2960 users, the output is as in this example:
2961 .code
2962 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
2963 .endd
2964 If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
2965 configuration file is output.
2966 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
2967 is the name of the file that was actually used.
2968
2969 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2970 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2971 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
2972 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
2973 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
2974 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
2975 written directly into the spool directory.
2976
2977 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
2978 .code
2979 exim -bP +local_domains
2980 .endd
2981 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
2982 local part) and outputs what it finds.
2983
2984 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
2985 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
2986 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
2987 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
2988 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
2989 that driver are output. For example:
2990 .code
2991 exim -bP transport local_delivery
2992 .endd
2993 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
2994 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
2995 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
2996 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
2997 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
2998 &%authenticators%&.
2999
3000 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3001 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3002 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3003 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3004 The output format is one item per line.
3005
3006 .vitem &%-bp%&
3007 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
3008 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3009 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3010 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3011 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3012 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3013 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3014 to allow any user to see the queue.
3015
3016 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3017 .code
3018 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3019 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3020 <other addresses>
3021 .endd
3022 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3023 .cindex "size" "of message"
3024 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3025 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3026 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3027 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3028 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3029 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3030 before the sender address.
3031
3032 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3033 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3034 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3035
3036 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3037 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3038 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3039 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3040 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3041 complete.
3042
3043
3044 .vitem &%-bpa%&
3045 .oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3046 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3047 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3048 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3049 of just &"D"&.
3050
3051
3052 .vitem &%-bpc%&
3053 .oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3054 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3055 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3056 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3057 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3058
3059
3060 .vitem &%-bpr%&
3061 .oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3062 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3063 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3064 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3065 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3066
3067 .vitem &%-bpra%&
3068 .oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3069 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3070
3071 .vitem &%-bpru%&
3072 .oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3073 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3074
3075
3076 .vitem &%-bpu%&
3077 .oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3078 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3079 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3080 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3081 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3082
3083
3084 .vitem &%-brt%&
3085 .oindex "&%-brt%&"
3086 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3087 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3088 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3089 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3090 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3091 .code
3092 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3093 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3094 .endd
3095 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3096 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3097 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3098 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3099 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3100 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3101 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3102 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3103 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3104 .code
3105 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3106 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3107 .endd
3108
3109 .vitem &%-brw%&
3110 .oindex "&%-brw%&"
3111 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3112 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3113 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3114 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3115 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3116 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3117 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3118
3119 .vitem &%-bS%&
3120 .oindex "&%-bS%&"
3121 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3122 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3123 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3124 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3125 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3126 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3127 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3128 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3129 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3130
3131 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3132 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3133 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3134
3135 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3136 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3137 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3138 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3139
3140 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3141 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3142 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3143
3144 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3145 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3146 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3147 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3148 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3149
3150 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3151 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3152
3153 .vitem &%-bs%&
3154 .oindex "&%-bs%&"
3155 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3156 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3157 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3158 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3159 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3160 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3161 messages to the MTA.
3162
3163 In
3164 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3165 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3166 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3167 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3168 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3169 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3170 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3171
3172 .cindex "inetd"
3173 The
3174 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3175 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3176 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3177 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3178 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3179 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3180 the listening daemon.
3181
3182 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3183 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3184 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3185 .cindex "malware scan test"
3186 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3187 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3188 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3189 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3190 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3191 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3192
3193 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3194 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3195 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3196 This option requires admin privileges.
3197
3198 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3199 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3200 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3201
3202 .vitem &%-bt%&
3203 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
3204 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3205 .cindex "address" "testing"
3206 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3207 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3208 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3209 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3210 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3211
3212 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3213 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3214
3215 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3216 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3217 security issues.
3218
3219 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3220 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3221 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3222 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3223 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3224 program.
3225
3226 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3227 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3228 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3229 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3230
3231 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3232 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3233 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3234 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3235 always shown.
3236
3237 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3238 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3239 message,
3240 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3241 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3242 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3243 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3244 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3245 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3246 doing such tests.
3247
3248 .vitem &%-bV%&
3249 .oindex "&%-bV%&"
3250 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3251 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3252 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3253 It also lists the DBM library this is being used, the optional modules (such as
3254 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3255 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3256
3257 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3258 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3259 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3260 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3261 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3262 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3263 dynamic testing facilities.
3264
3265 .vitem &%-bv%&
3266 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
3267 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3268 .cindex "address" "verification"
3269 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3270 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3271 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3272 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3273 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3274 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3275
3276 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3277 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3278 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3279
3280 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3281 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3282
3283 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3284 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3285 security issues.
3286
3287 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3288 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3289 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3290 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3291 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3292
3293 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3294 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3295 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3296 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3297 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3298 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3299 to succeed.
3300
3301 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3302 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3303 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3304
3305 The
3306 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3307 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3308 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3309 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3310
3311 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3312 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3313 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3314 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3315
3316 .vitem &%-bvs%&
3317 .oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3318 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3319 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3320 might happen.
3321
3322 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3323 .oindex "&%-C%&"
3324 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3325 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3326 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3327 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3328 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3329 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3330 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3331 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3332 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3333
3334 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3335 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3336 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3337 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_PREFIX_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&,
3338 root privilege is retained for any configuration file which matches a prefix
3339 listed in that file.
3340
3341 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_PREFIX_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing
3342 a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3343 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3344 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3345 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3346 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3347 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3348
3349 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3350 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3351 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3352 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3353 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3354 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3355 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3356
3357 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3358 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3359 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3360 configuration file.
3361
3362 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3363 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3364 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3365 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3366 specified by this option.
3367
3368 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3369 .oindex "&%-D%&"
3370 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3371 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3372 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3373 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3374 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3375 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3376
3377 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3378 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3379 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3380 synonymous:
3381 .code
3382 exim -DABC ...
3383 exim -DABC= ...
3384 .endd
3385 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3386 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3387 example:
3388 .code
3389 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3390 .endd
3391 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3392
3393 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3394 .oindex "&%-d%&"
3395 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3396 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3397 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3398 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3399 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3400 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3401 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3402 return code.
3403
3404 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3405 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3406 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3407 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3408 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3409 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3410 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3411 are:
3412 .display
3413 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3414 &`auth `& authenticators
3415 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3416 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3417 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3418 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3419 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3420 &`filter `& filter handling
3421 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3422 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3423 &`ident `& ident lookup
3424 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3425 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3426 &`load `& system load checks
3427 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3428 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3429 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3430 &`memory `& memory handling
3431 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3432 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3433 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3434 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3435 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3436 &`retry `& retry handling
3437 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3438 &`route `& address routing
3439 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3440 &`tls `& TLS logic
3441 &`transport `& transports
3442 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3443 &`verify `& address verification logic
3444 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3445 .endd
3446 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3447 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3448 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3449 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3450 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3451 turn everything off.
3452
3453 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3454 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3455 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3456 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3457 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3458 rather than stderr.
3459
3460 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3461 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3462 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3463 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3464 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3465 run in parallel.
3466
3467 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3468 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3469 in processing.
3470
3471 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3472 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3473
3474 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3475 .oindex "&%-dd%&"
3476 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3477 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3478 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3479 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3480
3481 .vitem &%-dropcr%&
3482 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3483 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3484 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3485 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3486
3487 .vitem &%-E%&
3488 .oindex "&%-E%&"
3489 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3490 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3491 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3492 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3493 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3494 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3495 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3496 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3497
3498 .vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3499 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3500 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3501 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3502 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3503 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3504
3505 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3506 .oindex "&%-F%&"
3507 .cindex "sender" "name"
3508 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3509 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3510 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3511 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3512 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3513 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3514
3515 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3516 .oindex "&%-f%&"
3517 .cindex "sender" "address"
3518 .cindex "address" "sender"
3519 .cindex "trusted users"
3520 .cindex "envelope sender"
3521 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3522 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3523 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3524 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3525 users to use it.
3526
3527 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3528 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3529 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3530 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3531 domain.
3532
3533 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3534 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3535 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3536 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3537 examples of shell commands:
3538 .code
3539 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3540 exim -f "" user@domain
3541 .endd
3542 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3543 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3544 &%-bv%& options.
3545
3546 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3547 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3548 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3549 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3550
3551 White
3552 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3553 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3554 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3555 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3556 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3557 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3558
3559 .vitem &%-G%&
3560 .oindex "&%-G%&"
3561 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-G%& option ignored"
3562 This is a Sendmail option which is ignored by Exim.
3563
3564 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3565 .oindex "&%-h%&"
3566 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3567 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3568 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3569 headers.)
3570
3571 .vitem &%-i%&
3572 .oindex "&%-i%&"
3573 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3574 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3575 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3576 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3577 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3578 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3579
3580 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3581 .oindex "&%-M%&"
3582 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3583 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3584 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3585 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3586 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3587 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3588 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3589
3590 Retry
3591 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3592 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3593 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3594 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3595 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3596 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3597
3598 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3599 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3600 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3601 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3602
3603 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3604 .oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3605 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3606 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3607 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3608 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3609 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3610 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3611 can be used only by an admin user.
3612
3613 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3614 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3615 .oindex "&%-MC%&"
3616 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3617 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3618 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3619 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3620 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3621 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3622 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3623 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3624
3625 .vitem &%-MCA%&
3626 .oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3627 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3628 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3629 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3630
3631 .vitem &%-MCP%&
3632 .oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3633 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3634 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3635 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3636
3637 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3638 .oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3639 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3640 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3641 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3642 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3643 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3644 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3645
3646 .vitem &%-MCS%&
3647 .oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3648 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3649 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3650 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3651 connection.
3652
3653 .vitem &%-MCT%&
3654 .oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3655 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3656 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3657 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3658
3659 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3660 .oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3661 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3662 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3663 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3664 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3665 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3666 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3667 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3668 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3669 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3670 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3671 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3672 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3673 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3674
3675 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3676 .oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3677 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3678 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3679 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3680 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3681 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3682 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3683 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3684 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3685
3686 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3687 .oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3688 .cindex "freezing messages"
3689 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3690 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3691 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3692 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3693 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3694 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3695 user.
3696
3697 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3698 .oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3699 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3700 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3701 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3702 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3703 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3704 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3705 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3706 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3707 user.
3708
3709 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3710 .oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3711 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3712 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3713 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3714 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3715 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3716
3717 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3718 .oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3719 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3720 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3721 .cindex "removing recipients"
3722 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3723 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3724 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3725 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3726 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3727 can be used only by an admin user.
3728
3729 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3730 .oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3731 .cindex "removing messages"
3732 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3733 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3734 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3735 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3736 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3737 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3738 placed on the queue.
3739
3740 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3741 .oindex "&%-Mset%&
3742 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3743 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3744 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3745 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3746 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3747 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3748 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3749 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3750 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3751
3752 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3753 .oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3754 .cindex "thawing messages"
3755 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3756 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3757 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3758 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3759 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3760 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3761 by an admin user.
3762
3763 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3764 .oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3765 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3766 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3767 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3768 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3769
3770 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3771 .oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3772 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3773 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3774 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3775 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3776 only by an admin user.
3777
3778 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3779 .oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
3780 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3781 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3782 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3783 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3784 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3785
3786 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3787 .oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
3788 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3789 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3790 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3791 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3792
3793 .vitem &%-m%&
3794 .oindex "&%-m%&"
3795 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3796 treats it that way too.
3797
3798 .vitem &%-N%&
3799 .oindex "&%-N%&"
3800 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3801 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3802 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3803 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3804 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3805 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3806 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
3807 than &"=>"&.
3808
3809 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
3810 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
3811 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
3812 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
3813 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
3814 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
3815 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
3816 for that message.
3817
3818 .vitem &%-n%&
3819 .oindex "&%-n%&"
3820 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-n%& option ignored"
3821 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&. It is ignored
3822 by Exim.
3823
3824 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
3825 .oindex "&%-O%&"
3826 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
3827 Exim.
3828
3829 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
3830 .oindex "&%-oA%&"
3831 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
3832 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
3833 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
3834 description above.
3835
3836 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
3837 .oindex "&%-oB%&"
3838 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3839 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3840 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3841 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
3842 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
3843 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
3844
3845 .vitem &%-odb%&
3846 .oindex "&%-odb%&"
3847 .cindex "background delivery"
3848 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
3849 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
3850 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
3851 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
3852 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
3853 processes to finish.
3854
3855 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
3856 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
3857 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
3858 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
3859
3860 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
3861 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
3862 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
3863 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
3864
3865 .vitem &%-odf%&
3866 .oindex "&%-odf%&"
3867 .cindex "foreground delivery"
3868 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
3869 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
3870 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
3871 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
3872 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
3873
3874 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
3875 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
3876 during deliveries.
3877
3878 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
3879 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
3880
3881 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
3882 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
3883 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
3884 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
3885
3886
3887 .vitem &%-odi%&
3888 .oindex "&%-odi%&"
3889 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
3890 Sendmail.
3891
3892 .vitem &%-odq%&
3893 .oindex "&%-odq%&"
3894 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
3895 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
3896 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
3897 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
3898 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
3899 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
3900 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
3901 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
3902 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
3903 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
3904 forces queueing.
3905
3906 .vitem &%-odqs%&
3907 .oindex "&%-odqs%&"
3908 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
3909 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
3910 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
3911 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
3912 configuration file is in effect.
3913
3914 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
3915 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
3916 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
3917 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
3918 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
3919 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
3920 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
3921 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
3922 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
3923 &%-qq%& option.
3924
3925 .vitem &%-oee%&
3926 .oindex "&%-oee%&"
3927 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3928 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
3929 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
3930 message.
3931
3932 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
3933 Provided
3934 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
3935 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
3936 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 any other error. This is
3937 the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
3938
3939 .vitem &%-oem%&
3940 .oindex "&%-oem%&"
3941 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3942 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
3943 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
3944 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
3945 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
3946
3947 .vitem &%-oep%&
3948 .oindex "&%-oep%&"
3949 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3950 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
3951 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
3952 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
3953 The return code is 1 for all errors.
3954
3955 .vitem &%-oeq%&
3956 .oindex "&%-oeq%&"
3957 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3958 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
3959 effect as &%-oep%&.
3960
3961 .vitem &%-oew%&
3962 .oindex "&%-oew%&"
3963 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3964 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
3965 effect as &%-oem%&.
3966
3967 .vitem &%-oi%&
3968 .oindex "&%-oi%&"
3969 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3970 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
3971 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
3972 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
3973 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
3974 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
3975
3976 .vitem &%-oitrue%&
3977 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
3978 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
3979
3980 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
3981 .oindex "&%-oMa%&"
3982 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
3983 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
3984 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
3985 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
3986 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
3987 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
3988
3989 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
3990 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
3991 .code
3992 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
3993 .endd
3994 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
3995 followed by a colon and the port number:
3996 .code
3997 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
3998 .endd
3999 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4000 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4001 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4002 whichever one is last.
4003
4004 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4005 .oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4006 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4007 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4008 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4009 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4010 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4011 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4012
4013 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4014 .oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4015 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4016 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4017 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4018 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4019 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4020 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4021
4022 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4023 .oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4024 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4025 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4026 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4027 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4028 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4029 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4030 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4031 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4032
4033 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4034 .oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4035 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4036 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4037 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4038 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4039 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4040
4041 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4042 .oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4043 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4044 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4045 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4046 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4047 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4048 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4049 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4050 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4051 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4052 be set by &%-oMr%&.
4053
4054 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4055 .oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4056 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4057 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4058 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4059 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4060 uses the name it is given.
4061
4062 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4063 .oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4064 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4065 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4066 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4067 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4068 used, when there is no default.
4069
4070 .vitem &%-om%&
4071 .oindex "&%-om%&"
4072 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4073 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4074 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4075 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4076
4077 .vitem &%-oo%&
4078 .oindex "&%-oo%&"
4079 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4080 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4081 whatever that means.
4082
4083 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4084 .oindex "&%-oP%&"
4085 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4086 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4087 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4088 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4089 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4090 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4091 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4092
4093 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4094 .oindex "&%-or%&"
4095 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4096 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4097 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4098 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4099 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4100
4101 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4102 .oindex "&%-os%&"
4103 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4104 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4105 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4106 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4107 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4108 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4109
4110 .vitem &%-ov%&
4111 .oindex "&%-ov%&"
4112 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4113
4114 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4115 .oindex "&%-oX%&"
4116 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4117 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4118 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4119 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4120 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4121 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4122 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4123 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4124
4125 .vitem &%-pd%&
4126 .oindex "&%-pd%&"
4127 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4128 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4129 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4130 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4131 needed.
4132
4133 .vitem &%-ps%&
4134 .oindex "&%-ps%&"
4135 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4136 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4137 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4138 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4139 started.
4140
4141 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4142 .oindex "&%-p%&"
4143 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4144 .display
4145 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4146 .endd
4147 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4148 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4149 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4150 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`p`&
4151 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4152
4153 .vitem &%-q%&
4154 .oindex "&%-q%&"
4155 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4156 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4157 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4158 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4159 and &%-S%& options).
4160
4161 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4162 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4163 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4164 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4165 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4166 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4167
4168 If
4169 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4170 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4171 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4172 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4173 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4174 proceeding.
4175
4176 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4177 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4178 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4179 this to be repeated periodically.
4180
4181 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4182 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4183 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4184 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4185
4186 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4187 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4188 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4189
4190 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4191 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4192 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4193 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4194
4195 .vitem &%-qq...%&
4196 .oindex "&%-qq%&"
4197 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4198 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4199 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4200 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4201 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4202 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4203 transports are run.
4204
4205 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4206 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4207 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4208 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4209 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4210 delivered down a single SMTP
4211 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4212 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4213 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4214 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4215 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4216 intermittently.
4217
4218 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4219 .oindex "&%-qi%&"
4220 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4221 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4222 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4223 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4224 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4225
4226 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4227 .oindex "&%-qf%&"
4228 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4229 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4230 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4231 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4232 their retry times are tried.
4233
4234 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4235 .oindex "&%-qff%&"
4236 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4237 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4238 frozen or not.
4239
4240 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4241 .oindex "&%-ql%&"
4242 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4243 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4244 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4245 for later delivery.
4246
4247 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4248 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4249 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4250 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4251 starting message id. For example:
4252 .code
4253 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4254 .endd
4255 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4256 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4257 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4258 .code
4259 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4260 .endd
4261 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4262 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4263 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4264 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4265 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4266 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4267
4268 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4269 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4270 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4271 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4272 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4273 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4274 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4275 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4276 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4277 .code
4278 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4279 .endd
4280 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4281 process every 30 minutes.
4282
4283 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4284 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4285
4286 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4287 .oindex "&%-qR%&"
4288 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4289 compatibility.
4290
4291 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4292 .oindex "&%-qS%&"
4293 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4294
4295 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4296 .oindex "&%-R%&"
4297 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4298 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4299 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4300 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4301 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4302 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4303 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4304
4305 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4306 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4307 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4308 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4309 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4310 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4311
4312 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4313 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4314 .code
4315 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4316 .endd
4317 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4318 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4319 applied to each queue run.
4320
4321 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4322 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4323 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4324 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4325 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4326 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4327 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4328 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4329 address will be skipped.
4330
4331 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4332 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4333 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4334 &'ff'& is present.
4335
4336 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4337 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4338 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4339 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4340 an arbitrary command instead.
4341
4342 .vitem &%-r%&
4343 .oindex "&%-r%&"
4344 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4345
4346 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4347 .oindex "&%-S%&"
4348 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4349 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4350 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4351 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4352 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4353 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4354
4355 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4356 .oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4357 This an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4358 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4359 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4360
4361 .vitem &%-t%&
4362 .oindex "&%-t%&"
4363 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4364 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4365 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4366 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4367 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4368 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4369 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4370 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4371 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4372
4373 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4374 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4375 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4376 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4377 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4378 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4379 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4380 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4381 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4382 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4383 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4384
4385 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4386 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4387 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4388 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4389 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4390 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4391
4392 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4393 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4394 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4395 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4396 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4397 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4398 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4399 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4400 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4401
4402 .vitem &%-ti%&
4403 .oindex "&%-ti%&"
4404 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4405 compatibility with Sendmail.
4406
4407 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4408 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4409 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4410 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4411 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4412 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4413 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4414 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4415
4416
4417 .vitem &%-U%&
4418 .oindex "&%-U%&"
4419 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4420 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4421 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4422 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4423 set. Exim ignores this option.
4424
4425 .vitem &%-v%&
4426 .oindex "&%-v%&"
4427 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4428 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4429 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4430 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4431 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4432 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4433 unconditional.
4434
4435 .vitem &%-x%&
4436 .oindex "&%-x%&"
4437 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4438 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4439 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4440 this option.
4441 .endlist
4442
4443 .ecindex IIDclo1
4444 .ecindex IIDclo2
4445
4446
4447 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4448 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4449 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4450 . creates a man page for the options.
4451 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4452
4453 .literal xml
4454 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4455 .literal off
4456
4457
4458
4459
4460
4461 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4462 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4463
4464
4465 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4466 "The runtime configuration file"
4467
4468 .cindex "run time configuration"
4469 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4470 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4471 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4472 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4473 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4474 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4475 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4476 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4477 control.
4478
4479 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4480 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4481 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4482 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4483 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4484 actually alter the string.
4485
4486 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4487 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4488 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4489 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4490 existing file in the list.
4491
4492 .cindex "EXIM_USER"
4493 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4494 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4495 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4496 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4497 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4498 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4499 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4500 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4501 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4502 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4503
4504 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4505 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4506 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4507 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4508 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4509
4510 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4511 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4512 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4513 compromise the Exim user account.
4514
4515 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4516 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4517 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4518 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4519 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4520 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4521 configuration.
4522
4523
4524
4525 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4526 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4527 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4528 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4529 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4530 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4531 CONFIGURE_FILE) or matches a prefix listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_PREFIX_LIST
4532 file. &%-C%& is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files
4533 before installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration
4534 file specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4535
4536 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4537 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4538 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_PREFIX_LIST file. This locks out the possibility
4539 of testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4540 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4541 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4542 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4543 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4544 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4545 &%-M%&).
4546
4547 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4548 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4549 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4550 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4551 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4552
4553 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4554 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4555 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4556 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4557 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4558 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4559
4560 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4561 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4562 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4563 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4564 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4565 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4566 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4567
4568 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4569 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4570 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4571
4572
4573
4574 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4575 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4576 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4577 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4578 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4579 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4580 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by the name of the part. The
4581 optional parts are:
4582
4583 .ilist
4584 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4585 &<<CHAPACL>>&).
4586 .next
4587 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4588 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4589 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4590 .next
4591 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4592 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4593 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4594 .next
4595 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4596 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4597 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4598 .next
4599 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4600 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4601 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4602 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4603 &<<CHAPretry>>&.
4604 .next
4605 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4606 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4607 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4608 .next
4609 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4610 want to use this feature, you must set
4611 .code
4612 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4613 .endd
4614 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4615 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4616 .endlist
4617
4618 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4619 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4620 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4621 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4622
4623 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4624 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4625 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4626 and does not introduce a comment.
4627
4628 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4629 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4630 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4631 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4632 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4633
4634 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4635 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4636 change settings as required.
4637
4638 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4639 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4640 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4641 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4642 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4643 described.
4644
4645
4646
4647 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4648 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4649 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4650 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4651 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4652 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4653 using this syntax:
4654 .display
4655 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4656 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4657 .endd
4658 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4659 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4660 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4661 name is required.
4662
4663 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4664 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4665 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4666 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4667
4668 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4669 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4670 for example:
4671 .code
4672 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4673 .include /some/file
4674 .endd
4675 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4676 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4677 inclusion appears.
4678
4679
4680
4681 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4682 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4683 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4684 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4685 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4686 definition, and must be of the form
4687 .display
4688 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4689 .endd
4690 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4691 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4692 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4693 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4694 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4695
4696 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4697 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4698 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4699
4700 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4701 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4702 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4703 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4704 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4705 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4706 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4707 define
4708 .display
4709 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4710 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4711 .endd
4712 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4713 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4714 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4715 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4716 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4717 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4718
4719
4720 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4721 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4722 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4723 &'='&. For example:
4724 .code
4725 MAC = initial value
4726 ...
4727 MAC == updated value
4728 .endd
4729 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4730 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4731 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4732 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4733 .code
4734 MAC = initial value
4735 ...
4736 MAC == MAC and something added
4737 .endd
4738 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4739 from a number of other files.
4740
4741 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4742 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4743 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4744 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4745 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4746 file to be ignored.
4747
4748
4749
4750 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4751 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4752 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4753 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4754 .code
4755 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4756 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4757 .endd
4758 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4759 .code
4760 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4761 .endd
4762 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4763 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4764 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4765
4766
4767 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4768 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4769 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4770 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4771 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
4772 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
4773 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
4774
4775 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
4776 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
4777 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
4778 line. Thus:
4779 .code
4780 .ifdef AAA
4781 message_size_limit = 50M
4782 .else
4783 message_size_limit = 100M
4784 .endif
4785 .endd
4786 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined, and 100M
4787 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
4788 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
4789 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
4790
4791 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
4792 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
4793 in this line"& will always be true.
4794
4795 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
4796 to clarify complicated nestings.
4797
4798
4799
4800 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
4801 .cindex "common option syntax"
4802 .cindex "syntax of common options"
4803 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
4804 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
4805 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
4806 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
4807 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
4808 space) and then the value. For example:
4809 .code
4810 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
4811 .endd
4812 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
4813 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
4814 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
4815 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
4816 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
4817 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
4818 word &"hide"&. For example:
4819 .code
4820 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
4821 .endd
4822 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
4823 .code
4824 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
4825 .endd
4826 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
4827 all instances of the same driver.
4828
4829 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
4830 that are found in option settings.
4831
4832
4833 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
4834 .cindex "format" "boolean"
4835 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
4836 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
4837 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
4838 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
4839 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
4840 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
4841 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
4842 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
4843 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
4844 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
4845 .code
4846 queue_only
4847 queue_only = true
4848 .endd
4849 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
4850 .code
4851 no_queue_only
4852 queue_only = false
4853 .endd
4854 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
4855
4856
4857
4858
4859 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
4860 .cindex "integer configuration values"
4861 .cindex "format" "integer"
4862 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
4863 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
4864 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
4865 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
4866 hexadecimal number.
4867
4868 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
4869 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
4870 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
4871 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
4872 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
4873 used.
4874
4875
4876 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
4877 .cindex "integer format"
4878 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
4879 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
4880 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
4881 Such options are always output in octal.
4882
4883
4884 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
4885 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
4886 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
4887 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
4888 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
4889
4890
4891
4892 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
4893 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
4894 .cindex "format" "time interval"
4895 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
4896 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
4897
4898 .table2 30pt
4899 .irow &%s%& seconds
4900 .irow &%m%& minutes
4901 .irow &%h%& hours
4902 .irow &%d%& days
4903 .irow &%w%& weeks
4904 .endtable
4905
4906 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
4907 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
4908 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
4909
4910
4911
4912 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
4913 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
4914 .cindex "format" "string"
4915 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
4916 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
4917 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
4918 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
4919 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
4920 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
4921 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
4922 therefore equivalent:
4923 .code
4924 trusted_users = uucp:mail
4925 trusted_users = uucp:\
4926 # This comment line is ignored
4927 mail
4928 .endd
4929 .cindex "string" "quoted"
4930 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
4931 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
4932 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
4933 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
4934
4935 .table2 100pt
4936 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
4937 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
4938 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
4939 .irow &`\t`& "tab"
4940 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
4941 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
4942 character"
4943 .endtable
4944
4945 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
4946 character, that character replaces the pair.
4947
4948 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
4949 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
4950 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
4951 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
4952 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
4953 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
4954
4955
4956 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
4957 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
4958 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
4959 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
4960 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
4961 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
4962 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
4963 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
4964 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
4965 within a quoted configuration string.
4966
4967
4968 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
4969 .cindex "user name" "format of"
4970 .cindex "format" "user name"
4971 .cindex "groups" "name format"
4972 .cindex "format" "group name"
4973 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
4974 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
4975 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
4976 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
4977
4978
4979 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
4980 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
4981 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
4982 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
4983 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
4984 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
4985 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
4986 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
4987 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
4988 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
4989 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
4990
4991 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
4992 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
4993 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
4994 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
4995 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
4996 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
4997 example, the list
4998 .code
4999 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5000 .endd
5001 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5002
5003 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5004 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5005 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5006 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5007
5008 .section "Changing list separators" "SECID53"
5009 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5010 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5011 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5012 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5013 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5014 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5015 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5016 .code
5017 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5018 .endd
5019 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5020 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5021 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5022
5023 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5024 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5025 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5026 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5027 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5028 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5029 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5030 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5031 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5032 .code
5033 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5034 .endd
5035 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5036 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5037 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5038 the value in quotes. For example:
5039 .code
5040 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5041 .endd
5042 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5043 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5044 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5045 enclosing an empty list item.
5046
5047
5048
5049 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5050 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5051 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5052 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5053 .code
5054 senders = user@domain :
5055 .endd
5056 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5057 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5058 items, the second of which is empty:
5059 .code
5060 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5061 .endd
5062 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5063 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5064 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5065 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5066 .code
5067 senders = :
5068 .endd
5069 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5070 is at the end of the list.
5071
5072
5073
5074
5075 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5076 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5077 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5078 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5079 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5080 a sequence of lines like this:
5081 .display
5082 <&'instance name'&>:
5083 <&'option'&>
5084 ...
5085 <&'option'&>
5086 .endd
5087 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5088 followed by three options settings:
5089 .code
5090 localuser:
5091 driver = accept
5092 check_local_user
5093 transport = local_delivery
5094 .endd
5095 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5096 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5097 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5098 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5099 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5100 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5101
5102 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5103 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5104
5105 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5106 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5107 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5108 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5109 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5110 server.
5111
5112 .cindex "generic options"
5113 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5114 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5115 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5116 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5117 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5118 .cindex "private options"
5119 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5120 they all have default values.
5121
5122 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5123 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5124 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5125
5126 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5127 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5128 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5129 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5130 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5131 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5132 configuration lines:
5133 .code
5134 remote_smtp:
5135 driver = smtp
5136 .endd
5137 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5138 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5139 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5140 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5141 thus:
5142 .code
5143 special_smtp:
5144 driver = smtp
5145 port = 1234
5146 command_timeout = 10s
5147 .endd
5148 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5149 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5150 lines.
5151
5152 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5153 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5154 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5155 option.
5156
5157
5158
5159
5160
5161
5162 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5163 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5164
5165 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5166 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5167 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5168 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5169 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5170 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5171 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5172 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5173 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5174 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5175 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5176
5177
5178
5179 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5180 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5181 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5182 the line
5183 .code
5184 # primary_hostname =
5185 .endd
5186 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5187 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5188 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5189 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5190
5191 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5192 .code
5193 domainlist local_domains = @
5194 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5195 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5196 .endd
5197 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5198 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5199 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5200 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5201
5202 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5203 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5204 on the local host.
5205
5206 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5207 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5208 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5209 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5210 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5211 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5212
5213 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5214 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5215 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5216 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5217 domain is permitted.
5218
5219 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5220 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5221 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5222 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5223 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5224 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5225
5226 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5227 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5228 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5229
5230 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5231 .code
5232 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5233 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5234 .endd
5235 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5236 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5237 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5238 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5239 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5240 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5241 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5242 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5243 contents of a message to be checked.
5244
5245 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5246 .code
5247 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5248 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5249 .endd
5250 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5251 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5252 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5253 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5254
5255 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5256 .code
5257 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5258 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5259 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5260 .endd
5261 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5262 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5263 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5264 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5265 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5266 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5267 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5268
5269 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5270 .code
5271 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5272 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5273 .endd
5274 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5275 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5276 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5277 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5278 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5279 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5280 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5281 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5282 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5283 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5284 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5285 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5286 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5287 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5288 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5289 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5290
5291 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5292 .code
5293 # qualify_domain =
5294 # qualify_recipient =
5295 .endd
5296 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5297 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5298 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5299 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5300 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5301 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5302
5303 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5304 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5305 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5306 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5307 .code
5308 # allow_domain_literals
5309 .endd
5310 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5311 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5312 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5313 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5314 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5315 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5316
5317 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5318 .code
5319 never_users = root
5320 .endd
5321 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5322 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5323 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5324 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5325 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5326 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5327 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5328 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5329
5330 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5331 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5332 line,
5333 .code
5334 host_lookup = *
5335 .endd
5336 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5337 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5338 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5339 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5340 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5341 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5342 unreachable.
5343
5344 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5345 1413 (hence their names):
5346 .code
5347 rfc1413_hosts = *
5348 rfc1413_query_timeout = 5s
5349 .endd
5350 These settings cause Exim to make ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5351 You can limit the hosts to which these calls are made, or change the timeout
5352 that is used. If you set the timeout to zero, all ident calls are disabled.
5353 Although they are cheap and can provide useful information for tracing problem
5354 messages, some hosts and firewalls have problems with ident calls. This can
5355 result in a timeout instead of an immediate refused connection, leading to
5356 delays on starting up an incoming SMTP session.
5357
5358 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5359 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5360 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5361 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5362 .code
5363 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5364 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5365 .endd
5366 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5367 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5368
5369 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5370 .code
5371 # percent_hack_domains =
5372 .endd
5373 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5374 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5375 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5376
5377 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5378 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5379 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5380 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5381 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5382 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5383 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5384 always bounce messages.
5385 .code
5386 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5387 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5388 .endd
5389 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5390 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5391 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5392 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5393 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5394
5395
5396
5397 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5398 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5399 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5400 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5401 It starts with the line
5402 .code
5403 begin acl
5404 .endd
5405 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5406 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5407 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5408
5409 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5410 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5411 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5412 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5413 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5414 result of the ACL processing.
5415 .code
5416 acl_check_rcpt:
5417 .endd
5418 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5419 ACL, and names it.
5420 .code
5421 accept hosts = :
5422 .endd
5423 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5424 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5425 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5426 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5427 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5428 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5429
5430 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5431 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5432 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5433 manner.
5434 .code
5435 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5436 domains = +local_domains
5437 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5438
5439 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5440 domains = !+local_domains
5441 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5442 .endd
5443 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5444 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5445 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5446 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5447 in Internet mail addresses.
5448
5449 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5450 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5451 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5452 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5453 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5454 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5455 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5456 policy of being as safe as possible.
5457
5458 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5459 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5460 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5461 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5462 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5463 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5464
5465 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5466 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5467 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5468 have to modify this rule.
5469
5470 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5471 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5472 common convention of local parts constructed as
5473 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5474 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5475 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5476 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5477 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5478 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5479
5480 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5481 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5482 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5483 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5484 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5485 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5486 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5487 .code
5488 accept local_parts = postmaster
5489 domains = +local_domains
5490 .endd
5491 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5492 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5493 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5494 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5495 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5496
5497 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5498 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5499 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5500 .code
5501 require verify = sender
5502 .endd
5503 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5504 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5505 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5506 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5507 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5508 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5509 discusses the details of address verification.
5510 .code
5511 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5512 control = submission
5513 .endd
5514 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5515 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5516 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5517 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5518 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5519 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5520 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5521 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5522 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5523 .code
5524 accept authenticated = *
5525 control = submission
5526 .endd
5527 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5528 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5529 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5530 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5531 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5532 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5533 .code
5534 require message = relay not permitted
5535 domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
5536 .endd
5537 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5538 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5539 .code
5540 require verify = recipient
5541 .endd
5542 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5543 fails, the address is rejected.
5544 .code
5545 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5546 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5547 # $dnslist_text
5548 # dnslists = black.list.example
5549 #
5550 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5551 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5552 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5553 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5554 .endd
5555 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5556 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5557 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5558 line.
5559 .code
5560 # require verify = csa
5561 .endd
5562 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5563 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5564 records.
5565 .code
5566 accept
5567 .endd
5568 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5569 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5570 .code
5571 acl_check_data:
5572 .endd
5573 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5574 of this ACL are commented out:
5575 .code
5576 # deny malware = *
5577 # message = This message contains a virus \
5578 # ($malware_name).
5579 .endd
5580 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5581 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5582 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5583 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5584 .code
5585 # warn spam = nobody
5586 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5587 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5588 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5589 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5590 .endd
5591 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5592 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5593 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5594 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5595 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5596 whatever the spam score.
5597 .code
5598 accept
5599 .endd
5600 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5601
5602
5603 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5604 .cindex "default" "routers"
5605 .cindex "routers" "default"
5606 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5607 by the line
5608 .code
5609 begin routers
5610 .endd
5611 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5612 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5613 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5614 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5615 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5616 .code
5617 # domain_literal:
5618 # driver = ipliteral
5619 # domains = !+local_domains
5620 # transport = remote_smtp
5621 .endd
5622 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5623 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5624 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5625 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5626 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5627 .code
5628 dnslookup:
5629 driver = dnslookup
5630 domains = ! +local_domains
5631 transport = remote_smtp
5632 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5633 no_more
5634 .endd
5635 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5636 domains. This is specified by the line
5637 .code
5638 domains = ! +local_domains
5639 .endd
5640 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5641 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5642 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5643 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5644 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5645 passed on to the following routers.
5646
5647 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5648 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5649 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5650 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5651 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5652
5653 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5654 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5655 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5656 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5657 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5658 the address fails and is bounced.
5659
5660 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5661 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5662 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5663 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5664 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5665 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5666 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5667 out.
5668 .code
5669 system_aliases:
5670 driver = redirect
5671 allow_fail
5672 allow_defer
5673 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5674 # user = exim
5675 file_transport = address_file
5676 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5677 .endd
5678 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5679 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5680 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5681 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5682 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5683 the next router.
5684
5685 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5686 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5687 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5688 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5689 .code
5690 userforward:
5691 driver = redirect
5692 check_local_user
5693 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5694 # local_part_suffix_optional
5695 file = $home/.forward
5696 # allow_filter
5697 no_verify
5698 no_expn
5699 check_ancestor
5700 file_transport = address_file
5701 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5702 reply_transport = address_reply
5703 .endd
5704 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5705 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5706 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5707 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5708 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5709 namely:
5710 .code
5711 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5712 # local_part_suffix_optional
5713 .endd
5714 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5715 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5716 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5717 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5718 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5719 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5720 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5721
5722 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5723 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5724 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5725 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5726
5727 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5728 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5729 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5730 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5731 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5732 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5733 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5734
5735 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5736 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5737 There are two reasons for doing this:
5738
5739 .olist
5740 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5741 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5742 unnecessary work.
5743 .next
5744 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5745 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5746 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5747 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5748 this time.
5749 .endlist
5750
5751 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5752 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5753 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5754 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5755
5756 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5757 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5758 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5759 .code
5760 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
5761 .endd
5762 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
5763 transport.
5764 .code
5765 localuser:
5766 driver = accept
5767 check_local_user
5768 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5769 # local_part_suffix_optional
5770 transport = local_delivery
5771 .endd
5772 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
5773 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
5774 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
5775 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
5776 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
5777
5778
5779 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
5780 .cindex "default" "transports"
5781 .cindex "transports" "default"
5782 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
5783 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
5784 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
5785 .code
5786 begin transports
5787 .endd
5788 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
5789 .code
5790 remote_smtp:
5791 driver = smtp
5792 .endd
5793 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections. All its
5794 options are defaulted. The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
5795 .code
5796 local_delivery:
5797 driver = appendfile
5798 file = /var/mail/$local_part
5799 delivery_date_add
5800 envelope_to_add
5801 return_path_add
5802 # group = mail
5803 # mode = 0660
5804 .endd
5805 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
5806 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
5807 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
5808 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
5809 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
5810 show how this can be done.
5811
5812 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
5813 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
5814 similarly-named options above.
5815 .code
5816 address_pipe:
5817 driver = pipe
5818 return_output
5819 .endd
5820 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
5821 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
5822 option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
5823 sender.
5824 .code
5825 address_file:
5826 driver = appendfile
5827 delivery_date_add
5828 envelope_to_add
5829 return_path_add
5830 .endd
5831 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
5832 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
5833 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
5834 .code
5835 address_reply:
5836 driver = autoreply
5837 .endd
5838 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
5839 filter files.
5840
5841
5842
5843 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
5844 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
5845 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
5846 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
5847 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
5848 introduced by the line
5849 .code
5850 begin retry
5851 .endd
5852 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
5853 errors:
5854 .code
5855 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
5856 .endd
5857 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
5858 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
5859 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
5860 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
5861
5862 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
5863 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
5864 temporary errors into permanent errors.
5865
5866
5867 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
5868 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
5869 .code
5870 begin rewrite
5871 .endd
5872 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
5873 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
5874
5875
5876
5877 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
5878 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
5879 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
5880 .code
5881 begin authenticators
5882 .endd
5883 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
5884 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
5885 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
5886 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
5887 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
5888 to support most MUA software.
5889
5890 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
5891 .code
5892 #PLAIN:
5893 # driver = plaintext
5894 # server_set_id = $auth2
5895 # server_prompts = :
5896 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
5897 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_cipher }
5898 .endd
5899 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
5900 .code
5901 #LOGIN:
5902 # driver = plaintext
5903 # server_set_id = $auth1
5904 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
5905 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
5906 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_cipher }
5907 .endd
5908
5909 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
5910 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
5911 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
5912 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
5913 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
5914 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
5915 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
5916 need to add support for TLS as described in &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
5917
5918 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
5919 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
5920 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
5921 expression like one of the examples in &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
5922
5923 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
5924 usercode and password are in different positions. &<<CHAPplaintext>>&
5925 covers both.
5926
5927 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
5928
5929
5930
5931 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5932 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5933
5934 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
5935
5936 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
5937 .cindex "PCRE"
5938 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
5939 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
5940 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
5941 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
5942 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
5943 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
5944
5945 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
5946 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
5947 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
5948 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
5949 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
5950 case-insensitive.
5951
5952 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
5953 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
5954 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
5955 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
5956 .code
5957 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
5958 .endd
5959 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
5960 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
5961 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
5962 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
5963 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
5964 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
5965 matched.
5966
5967 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
5968 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
5969 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
5970 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
5971 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
5972 match anywhere in the subject string.
5973
5974 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
5975 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
5976 .code
5977 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
5978 .endd
5979 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
5980 You need to use:
5981 .code
5982 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
5983 .endd
5984 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
5985 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
5986
5987
5988
5989 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5990 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5991
5992 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
5993 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
5994 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
5995 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
5996 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
5997 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
5998
5999 .olist
6000 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6001 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6002 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6003 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6004 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6005 .next
6006 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6007 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6008 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6009 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6010 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6011 .endlist
6012
6013 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6014 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6015 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6016 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6017 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6018 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6019
6020 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6021 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6022 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6023 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6024 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6025 .code
6026 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6027 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6028 .endd
6029 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6030 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6031 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6032 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6033 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6034 .code
6035 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6036 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6037 .endd
6038 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6039 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6040
6041 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6042 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6043 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6044 .code
6045 domain1:
6046 domain2:
6047 .endd
6048 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6049 matches the list item.
6050
6051 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6052 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6053 .code
6054 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6055 .endd
6056 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6057 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6058 causes a second lookup to occur.
6059
6060 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6061 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6062 lookup is permitted.
6063
6064
6065 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6066 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6067 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6068 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6069
6070 .ilist
6071 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6072 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6073 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6074 .next
6075 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6076 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6077 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6078 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6079 .endlist
6080
6081 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6082 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6083 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6084 .code
6085 LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6086 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6087 .endd
6088 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6089 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6090 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6091
6092
6093
6094
6095 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6096 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6097 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6098 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6099
6100 .ilist
6101 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6102 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6103 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6104 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6105 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6106 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6107 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6108 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6109 be found in several places:
6110 .display
6111 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6112 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6113 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6114 .endd
6115 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6116 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6117 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6118 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6119 .next
6120 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6121 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6122 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6123 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6124 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6125 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6126 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6127
6128 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6129 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6130 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6131 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6132 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6133 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6134 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6135 .next
6136 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6137 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6138 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6139 .cindex "Courier"
6140 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6141 .cindex "dmbnz lookup type"
6142 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6143 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6144 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6145 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6146 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6147 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6148 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6149 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6150 .next
6151 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6152 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6153 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6154 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6155 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6156 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6157 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6158 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6159 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6160 .next
6161 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6162 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6163 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6164 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6165 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6166 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6167 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6168 .code
6169 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6170 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6171 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6172 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6173 .endd
6174 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6175 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6176 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6177 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6178 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6179
6180 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6181 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6182 lookup types support only literal keys.
6183
6184 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6185 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6186 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6187 .next
6188 .cindex "linear search"
6189 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6190 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6191 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6192 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6193 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6194 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6195 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6196 in the file is used.
6197
6198 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6199 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6200 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6201 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6202 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6203 colon, for example:
6204 .code
6205 baduser: :fail:
6206 .endd
6207 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6208 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6209 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6210 wildcarding of any kind.
6211
6212 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6213 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6214 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6215 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6216 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6217 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6218 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6219 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6220 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6221
6222 .next
6223 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6224 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6225 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6226 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6227 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6228 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6229 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6230 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6231
6232 .next
6233 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6234 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6235 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6236 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6237 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6238 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6239 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6240 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6241 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6242
6243 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6244 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6245 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6246 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6247
6248 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6249 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6250
6251 .olist
6252 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6253 .code
6254 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6255 *fish data for anythingfish
6256 .endd
6257 .next
6258 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6259 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6260 .code
6261 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6262 .endd
6263 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6264 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6265 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6266 .code
6267 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6268 .endd
6269 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6270 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6271 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6272 .code
6273 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6274 .endd
6275
6276 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6277 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6278 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6279 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6280 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6281
6282 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6283 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6284 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6285 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6286 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6287
6288 .next
6289 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6290 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6291 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6292 example:
6293 .code
6294 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6295 .endd
6296 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6297 .endlist olist
6298
6299 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6300 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6301 be followed by optional colons.
6302
6303 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6304 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6305 lookup types support only literal keys.
6306 .endlist ilist
6307
6308
6309 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6310 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6311 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6312 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6313 many of them are given in later sections.
6314
6315 .ilist
6316 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6317 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6318 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6319 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6320 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6321 .next
6322 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6323 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6324 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6325 .next
6326 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6327 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6328 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6329 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6330 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6331 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6332 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6333 .next
6334 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6335 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6336 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6337 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6338 .next
6339 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6340 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6341 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6342 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6343 .next
6344 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6345 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6346 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6347 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6348 .next
6349 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6350 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6351 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6352 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6353 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6354 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6355 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6356 password value. For example:
6357 .code
6358 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6359 .endd
6360 .next
6361 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6362 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6363 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6364 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6365
6366 .next
6367 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6368 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6369 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6370 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6371
6372 .next
6373 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6374 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6375 .next
6376 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6377 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6378 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6379 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6380 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6381 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6382 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6383 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6384 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6385 .code
6386 require condition = \
6387 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6388 .endd
6389 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6390 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6391 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6392 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6393 .endlist
6394
6395
6396
6397 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6398 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6399 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6400 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6401 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6402 options such as a list of local domains.
6403
6404 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6405 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6406 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6407 or may give up altogether.
6408
6409
6410
6411 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6412 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6413 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6414 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6415 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6416 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6417 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6418 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6419
6420 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6421 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6422 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6423
6424 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6425 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6426 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6427
6428 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6429 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6430 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6431 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6432 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6433 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6434 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6435 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6436 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6437 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6438 .code
6439 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6440 .endd
6441 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6442 looks up these keys, in this order:
6443 .code
6444 jane@eyre.example
6445 *@eyre.example
6446 *
6447 .endd
6448 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6449 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6450 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6451 Exim move on to try the next key.
6452
6453
6454
6455 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6456 .cindex "partial matching"
6457 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6458 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6459 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6460 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6461 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6462 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6463 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6464 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6465 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6466 a key in a DBM file is
6467 .code
6468 *.dates.fict.example
6469 .endd
6470 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6471 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6472 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6473 file.
6474
6475 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6476 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6477 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6478
6479 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6480 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6481 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6482 partial matching keys
6483 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6484 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6485 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6486
6487 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6488 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6489 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6490 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6491 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6492 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6493 remains.
6494
6495 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6496 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6497 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6498 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6499 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6500 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6501 .code
6502 2250.dates.fict.example
6503 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6504 *.dates.fict.example
6505 *.fict.example
6506 .endd
6507 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6508 finishes.
6509
6510 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6511 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6512 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6513 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6514 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6515 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6516 .code
6517 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6518 .endd
6519 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6520 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6521 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6522 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6523 .code
6524 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6525 .endd
6526 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6527 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6528
6529 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6530 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6531 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6532
6533 .ilist
6534 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6535 .next
6536 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6537 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6538 .next
6539 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6540 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6541 for &"*"& on its own.
6542 .next
6543 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6544 .endlist
6545
6546
6547 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6548 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6549 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6550 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6551 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6552 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6553 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6554
6555 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6556 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6557 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6558 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6559 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6560
6561
6562
6563
6564 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6565 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6566 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6567 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6568 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6569 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6570 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6571
6572 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6573 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6574 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6575 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6576 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6577 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6578
6579 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6580 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6581 complete.
6582
6583
6584
6585
6586 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6587 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6588 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6589 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6590 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6591 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6592 .code
6593 [name=$local_part]
6594 .endd
6595 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6596 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6597 .code
6598 [name="$local_part"]
6599 .endd
6600 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6601 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6602 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6603 of the following form is provided:
6604 .code
6605 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6606 .endd
6607 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6608 .code
6609 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6610 .endd
6611 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6612 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6613 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6614
6615
6616
6617
6618 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6619 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6620 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6621 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6622 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6623 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6624 an expansion string could contain:
6625 .code
6626 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6627 .endd
6628 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6629 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6630 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6631 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6632
6633 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SRV, and TXT, and,
6634 when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA (and A6 if that is also
6635 configured). If no type is given, TXT is assumed. When the type is PTR,
6636 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6637 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6638 .code
6639 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6640 .endd
6641 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6642 altered and nothing is added.
6643
6644 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6645 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6646 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6647 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6648 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6649
6650 For any record type, if multiple records are found (or, for A6 lookups, if a
6651 single record leads to multiple addresses), the data is returned as a
6652 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6653 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6654 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6655 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6656 .code
6657 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6658 .endd
6659 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6660 white space is ignored.
6661
6662 .new
6663 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6664 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6665 unless a separator for them is specified using a comma after the separator
6666 character followed immediately by the TXT record item separator. To concatenate
6667 items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
6668 .code
6669 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6670 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6671 .endd
6672 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6673 white space is ignored.
6674 .wen
6675
6676 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
6677 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6678 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6679 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
6680 the pseudo-type MXH:
6681 .code
6682 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
6683 .endd
6684 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
6685 returned.
6686
6687 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
6688 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
6689 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
6690 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
6691 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
6692 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
6693 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
6694 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
6695 .code
6696 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
6697 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
6698 .endd
6699 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
6700 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
6701 the name servers for &%edu%&.
6702
6703 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
6704 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
6705 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
6706 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
6707 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
6708 such a list.
6709
6710 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6711 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
6712 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
6713 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
6714 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
6715 result of a successful lookup such as:
6716 .code
6717 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
6718 .endd
6719 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
6720 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
6721 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
6722
6723
6724 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
6725 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
6726 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
6727 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
6728 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
6729 .code
6730 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
6731 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6732 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
6733 .endd
6734 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
6735 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
6736 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
6737 case, it does not treat it as a list.
6738
6739 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
6740 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
6741 different separator can be specified, as described above.
6742
6743 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6744 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6745 an optional keyword followed by a comma that may appear before the record
6746 type. The possible keywords are &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and
6747 &"defer_lax"&. With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6748 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6749 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6750 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6751 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6752 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6753 .code
6754 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6755 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6756 .endd
6757 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6758 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6759
6760
6761
6762
6763 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
6764 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
6765 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6766 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
6767 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
6768 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
6769 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
6770 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
6771 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
6772 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
6773 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
6774 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
6775 .code
6776 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
6777 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
6778 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
6779 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
6780 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
6781 .endd
6782 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
6783 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
6784
6785 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
6786 the way they handle the results of a query:
6787
6788 .ilist
6789 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
6790 gives an error.
6791 .next
6792 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
6793 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
6794 .next
6795 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
6796 from all of them are returned.
6797 .endlist
6798
6799
6800 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
6801 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
6802 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
6803 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
6804
6805
6806 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
6807 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
6808 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
6809 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
6810 .code
6811 data = ${lookup ldap \
6812 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
6813 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
6814 .endd
6815 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
6816 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
6817 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
6818 encrypted TLS connection is used.
6819
6820
6821 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
6822 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
6823 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
6824 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
6825 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
6826 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
6827
6828 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6829 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
6830 the string:
6831 .code
6832 * => \2A
6833 ( => \28
6834 ) => \29
6835 \ => \5C
6836 .endd
6837 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
6838 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
6839 .code
6840 ! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
6841 .endd
6842 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
6843 .code
6844 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
6845 .endd
6846 yields
6847 .code
6848 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
6849 .endd
6850 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
6851 .code
6852 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
6853 .endd
6854 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6855 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
6856 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
6857 .code
6858 , + " \ < > ;
6859 .endd
6860 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
6861 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
6862 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
6863 .code
6864 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
6865 .endd
6866 yields
6867 .code
6868 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
6869 .endd
6870 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
6871 .code
6872 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
6873 .endd
6874 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
6875 authentication below.
6876
6877
6878 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
6879 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
6880 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
6881 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
6882 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
6883 by starting it with
6884 .code
6885 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
6886 .endd
6887 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
6888 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
6889 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
6890 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
6891 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
6892 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
6893 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
6894 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
6895 failures, and timeouts.
6896
6897 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
6898 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
6899 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
6900 doubled. For example
6901 .code
6902 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
6903 .endd
6904 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
6905 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
6906 the local host) is used.
6907
6908 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
6909 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
6910 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
6911 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
6912 not available.
6913
6914 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
6915 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
6916 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
6917 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
6918 .code
6919 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
6920 .endd
6921 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
6922 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
6923 .code
6924 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
6925 .endd
6926 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
6927 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
6928 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
6929 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
6930 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
6931 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
6932 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
6933 backup host.
6934
6935 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
6936 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
6937 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
6938
6939 .ilist
6940 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
6941 interface.
6942 .next
6943 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
6944 .endlist
6945
6946
6947 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
6948 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
6949
6950
6951
6952 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
6953 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
6954 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
6955 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
6956 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
6957 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
6958 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
6959 them. The following names are recognized:
6960 .display
6961 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
6962 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
6963 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
6964 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
6965 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
6966 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
6967 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
6968 .endd
6969 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
6970 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
6971 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
6972 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
6973
6974 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
6975 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
6976 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
6977 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
6978 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
6979 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
6980 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
6981 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
6982 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
6983
6984 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
6985 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
6986
6987
6988 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
6989 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
6990 .code
6991 ${lookup ldap
6992 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
6993 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
6994 {$value}fail}
6995 .endd
6996 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
6997 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
6998 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
6999 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7000
7001 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7002 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7003 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7004
7005 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7006 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7007 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7008 quoting has two advantages:
7009
7010 .ilist
7011 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7012 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7013 .next
7014 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7015 .endlist
7016
7017 For example, a setting such as
7018 .code
7019 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7020 .endd
7021 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7022
7023 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7024 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7025 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7026 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7027 .code
7028 PASS=${quote:$3}
7029 .endd
7030 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7031 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7032 &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7033
7034
7035
7036 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7037 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7038 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7039 as a sequence of values, for example
7040 .code
7041 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7042 .endd
7043 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7044 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7045 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7046 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7047 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7048 directory.
7049
7050 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7051 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7052 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7053
7054 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7055 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7056 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7057 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7058 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7059 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7060 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7061
7062 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7063 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7064 &%attr1%& has two values, whereas &%attr2%& has only one value:
7065 .code
7066 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7067 value1.1, value1.2
7068
7069 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7070 value two
7071
7072 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7073 attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7074
7075 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7076 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7077 .endd
7078 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7079 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs. You can
7080 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7081 results of LDAP lookups.
7082
7083
7084
7085
7086 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7087 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7088 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7089 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7090 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7091 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7092 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7093 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7094 .code
7095 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7096 .endd
7097 might return the string
7098 .code
7099 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7100 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7101 .endd
7102 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7103 .code
7104 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7105 .endd
7106 would just return
7107 .code
7108 Martin Guerre
7109 .endd
7110 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7111 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7112 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7113
7114
7115
7116 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7117 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7118 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7119 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7120 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7121 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7122 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7123 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7124 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7125 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7126 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7127 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7128 might be
7129 .code
7130 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7131 {$value}fail}
7132 .endd
7133 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7134 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7135 .code
7136 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7137 {$value}}
7138 .endd
7139 might be
7140 .code
7141 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7142 .endd
7143 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7144 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7145 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7146 .code
7147 Mister X
7148 .endd
7149 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7150 with a newline between the data for each row.
7151
7152
7153 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7154 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7155 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7156 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7157 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7158 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7159 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7160 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7161 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7162 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7163 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7164 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7165 information.
7166 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7167 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7168 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7169 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7170 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7171 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7172 .code
7173 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7174 .endd
7175 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7176 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7177 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7178 .code
7179 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7180 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7181 .endd
7182 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7183 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7184 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7185 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7186 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7187 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7188
7189 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7190 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7191 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7192 itself are escaped with backslashes. The &%quote_pgsql%& expansion operator, in
7193 addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
7194 for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
7195 characters are not special.
7196
7197 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7198 For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7199 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7200 done by starting the query with
7201 .display
7202 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7203 .endd
7204 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7205 .olist
7206 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7207 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7208 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7209 taken from there.
7210 .next
7211 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7212 .endlist
7213 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7214 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7215 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7216
7217 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7218 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7219 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7220 like this:
7221 .code
7222 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7223 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7224 master/db/name/pw
7225 .endd
7226 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7227 .code
7228 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7229 .endd
7230 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7231 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7232 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7233 .code
7234 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7235 .endd
7236
7237
7238 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7239 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7240 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7241 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7242 each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7243 .display
7244 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7245 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7246 .endd
7247 Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7248 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7249
7250 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7251 the queries.
7252
7253 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7254 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7255
7256 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7257 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7258 is zero because no rows are affected.
7259
7260
7261 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7262 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7263 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7264 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7265 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7266 looks like this:
7267 .code
7268 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7269 .endd
7270 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7271 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7272 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7273
7274 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7275 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7276 affected.
7277
7278 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7279 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7280 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7281 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7282 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7283 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7284 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7285 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7286 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7287 .code
7288 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7289 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7290 .endd
7291 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7292 .code
7293 domainlist relay_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7294 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7295 .endd
7296 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7297 quote, which it doubles.
7298
7299 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7300 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7301 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7302 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7303 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7304 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7305 option.
7306 .ecindex IIDfidalo1
7307 .ecindex IIDfidalo2
7308
7309
7310 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7311 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7312
7313 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7314 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7315 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7316 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7317 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7318 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7319 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7320 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7321 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7322
7323 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7324 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7325 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7326 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7327
7328
7329
7330 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7331 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7332 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7333 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7334 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7335 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7336 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7337 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7338
7339
7340 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7341 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7342 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7343
7344 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7345 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7346 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7347 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7348 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7349 .code
7350 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7351 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7352 .endd
7353 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7354 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7355 senders based on the receiving domain.
7356
7357
7358
7359
7360 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7361 .cindex "list" "negation"
7362 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7363 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7364 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7365 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7366 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7367 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7368
7369 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7370 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7371 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7372 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7373 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7374 .code
7375 domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7376 .endd
7377 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7378 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7379 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7380 .code
7381 domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c
7382 .endd
7383 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7384 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7385 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7386
7387 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7388 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7389 item.
7390
7391
7392
7393 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7394 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7395 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7396 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7397 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7398 file names are not allowed,
7399 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7400 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7401 lines:
7402
7403 .ilist
7404 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7405 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7406 .next
7407 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7408 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7409 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7410 .code
7411 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7412 .endd
7413 .endlist
7414
7415 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7416 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7417 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7418 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7419
7420 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7421 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7422 .code
7423 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7424 .endd
7425 and the file contains the lines
7426 .code
7427 !a.b.c
7428 *.b.c
7429 .endd
7430 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7431 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7432
7433
7434
7435 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7436 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7437 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7438 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7439 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7440 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7441 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7442 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7443
7444 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7445 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7446 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7447 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7448
7449
7450
7451
7452 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7453 .cindex "named lists"
7454 .cindex "list" "named"
7455 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7456 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7457 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7458 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7459 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7460 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7461 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7462 .code
7463 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7464 .endd
7465 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7466 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7467 configured with the line
7468 .code
7469 domains = +local_domains
7470 .endd
7471 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7472 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7473 .code
7474 dnslookup:
7475 driver = dnslookup
7476 domains = ! +local_domains
7477 transport = remote_smtp
7478 no_more
7479 .endd
7480 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7481 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7482 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7483 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7484 .code
7485 hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7486 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7487 .endd
7488 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7489 .code
7490 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7491 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7492 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7493 .endd
7494 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7495 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7496 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7497 .code
7498 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7499 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7500 .endd
7501 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7502 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7503 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7504 .code
7505 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7506 .endd
7507 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7508 referenced lists if you can.
7509
7510 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7511 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7512 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7513 .code
7514 domains = +local_domains
7515 .endd
7516 on several of your routers
7517 or in several ACL statements,
7518 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7519 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7520 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7521 the same each time they are referenced.
7522
7523 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7524 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7525 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7526 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7527
7528
7529
7530 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7531 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7532 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7533 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7534 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7535 write
7536 .code
7537 ALIST = host1 : host2
7538 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7539 .endd
7540 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7541 .code
7542 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7543 .endd
7544 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7545 list, and write
7546 .code
7547 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7548 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7549 .endd
7550 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7551 .code
7552 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7553 .endd
7554
7555
7556 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7557 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7558 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7559 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7560 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7561 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7562 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7563 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7564 message. For example:
7565 .code
7566 domainlist special_domains = \
7567 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7568 .endd
7569 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7570 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7571 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7572 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7573 same list each time.
7574
7575 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7576 cache the result anyway. For example:
7577 .code
7578 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7579 .endd
7580 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7581 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7582
7583
7584
7585 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7586 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7587 .cindex "list" "domain list"
7588 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7589 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7590
7591 .ilist
7592 .cindex "primary host name"
7593 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7594 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7595 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7596 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
7597 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7598 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7599 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7600 differ only in their names.
7601 .next
7602 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7603 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7604 .cindex "domain literal"
7605 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7606 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7607 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7608 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7609 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7610 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7611 .next
7612 .cindex "@mx_any"
7613 .cindex "@mx_primary"
7614 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
7615 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7616 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7617 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7618 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7619 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7620 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7621 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7622 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7623 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7624
7625 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7626 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7627 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7628 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7629 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7630
7631 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7632 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7633 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7634 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7635 on a router). For example:
7636 .code
7637 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7638 .endd
7639 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7640 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7641
7642 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7643 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7644 contain negative items.
7645
7646 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
7647 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
7648 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
7649 .code
7650 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
7651 an.other.domain : ...
7652 .endd
7653 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
7654 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
7655 .code
7656 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
7657 an.other.domain ? ...
7658 .endd
7659 .next
7660 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
7661 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
7662 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
7663 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
7664 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
7665 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
7666 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
7667 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
7668 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
7669 &'cipher.key.ex'&.
7670
7671 .next
7672 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
7673 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
7674 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
7675 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
7676 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
7677 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
7678 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
7679 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
7680 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
7681
7682 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
7683 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
7684 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
7685 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
7686 expression by expansion, of course).
7687 .next
7688 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
7689 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
7690 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
7691 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
7692 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
7693 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
7694 .code
7695 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
7696 .endd
7697 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
7698 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
7699 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
7700 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
7701 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
7702 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
7703 other statements in the same ACL.
7704
7705 .next
7706 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
7707 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
7708 .code
7709 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
7710 .endd
7711 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
7712 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
7713
7714 .next
7715 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
7716 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
7717 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
7718 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
7719 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
7720 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
7721 expansion variable.
7722 .next
7723 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
7724 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
7725 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
7726 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
7727 .code
7728 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
7729 where domain = '$domain';
7730 .endd
7731 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
7732 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
7733 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
7734 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
7735 variable and can be referred to in other options.
7736 .next
7737 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
7738 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
7739 between the pattern and the domain.
7740 .endlist
7741
7742 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
7743 .code
7744 domainlist funny_domains = \
7745 @ : \
7746 lib.unseen.edu : \
7747 *.foundation.fict.example : \
7748 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
7749 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
7750 nis;domains.byname : \
7751 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
7752 .endd
7753 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
7754 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
7755 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
7756 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
7757 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
7758 patterns earlier.
7759
7760
7761
7762 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
7763 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
7764 .cindex "list" "host list"
7765 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
7766 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
7767 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
7768 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
7769 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
7770 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
7771 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
7772
7773
7774 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
7775 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
7776 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
7777 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
7778 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
7779 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
7780 not used.
7781
7782 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
7783 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
7784 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
7785
7786
7787
7788 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
7789 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
7790 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
7791 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
7792 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
7793 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
7794 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
7795 concerns.)
7796
7797 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
7798 inspecting its IP address:
7799
7800 .ilist
7801 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
7802 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
7803 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
7804 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
7805 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
7806 with the IP address of the subject host.
7807
7808 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
7809 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
7810 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
7811 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
7812 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
7813
7814 .next
7815 .cindex "@ in a host list"
7816 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
7817 domain name, as just described.
7818
7819 .next
7820 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
7821 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
7822 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
7823 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
7824 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
7825 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
7826 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
7827 that can never match a client host.
7828
7829 .next
7830 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
7831 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
7832 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
7833 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
7834 .code
7835 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
7836 accept hosts = @[]
7837 .endd
7838 .next
7839 .cindex "CIDR notation"
7840 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
7841 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
7842 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
7843 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
7844 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
7845 significant end of the address.
7846
7847 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
7848 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
7849 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
7850 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
7851 .code
7852 192.168.23.236/31
7853 .endd
7854 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
7855 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
7856 matches.
7857
7858 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
7859 .code
7860 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
7861 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
7862 .endd
7863 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
7864 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
7865 For example:
7866 .code
7867 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
7868 .endd
7869 could make use of a file containing
7870 .code
7871 172.16.0.0/12
7872 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
7873 .endd
7874 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
7875 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
7876 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
7877 .code
7878 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
7879 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
7880 .endd
7881 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
7882 list.
7883 .endlist
7884
7885
7886
7887 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
7888 "SECThoslispatsikey"
7889 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
7890 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
7891 address, the pattern takes this form:
7892 .display
7893 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
7894 .endd
7895 For example:
7896 .code
7897 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
7898 .endd
7899 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
7900 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
7901 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
7902 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
7903 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
7904 returned by the lookup is not used.
7905
7906 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
7907 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
7908 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
7909 patterns of this form:
7910 .display
7911 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
7912 .endd
7913 For example:
7914 .code
7915 net24-dbm;/networks.db
7916 .endd
7917 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
7918 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
7919 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
7920 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
7921 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
7922
7923 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
7924 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
7925 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
7926 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
7927 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
7928 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
7929 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
7930 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
7931 addresses are always used.
7932
7933 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
7934 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
7935 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
7936 configurations.
7937
7938 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
7939 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
7940 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
7941 case the IP address is used on its own.
7942
7943
7944
7945 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
7946 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
7947 .cindex "unknown host name"
7948 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
7949 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
7950 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
7951 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
7952 address to match against, as described in the section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
7953 above.)
7954
7955 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
7956 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
7957 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
7958 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
7959 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
7960 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
7961 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
7962
7963 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
7964 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
7965
7966 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
7967 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
7968 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
7969 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
7970 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
7971 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
7972 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
7973 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
7974 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
7975
7976 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
7977 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
7978
7979 .cindex "host" "alias for"
7980 .cindex "alias for host"
7981 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
7982 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
7983
7984 .ilist
7985 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
7986 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
7987 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
7988 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
7989 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
7990 expression.
7991 .next
7992 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
7993 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
7994 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
7995 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
7996 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
7997 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
7998 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
7999 example,
8000 .code
8001 ^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8002 .endd
8003 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8004 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8005 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8006 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8007 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8008 .code
8009 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8010 .endd
8011 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8012 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8013 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8014 required.
8015 .endlist
8016
8017
8018
8019
8020 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8021 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8022 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8023 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8024 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8025 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8026
8027 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8028 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8029
8030 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8031 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8032 By default, Exim behaves as if the host does not match the list. This may not
8033 always be what you want to happen. To change Exim's behaviour, the special
8034 items &`+include_unknown`& or &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at
8035 top level &-- they are not recognized in an indirected file).
8036
8037 .ilist
8038 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8039 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8040 .code
8041 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8042 .endd
8043 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8044 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8045
8046 .next
8047 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8048 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8049 example:
8050 .code
8051 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8052 192.168.4.5
8053 .endd
8054 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8055 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8056 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8057 .endlist
8058
8059 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8060 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8061 list.
8062
8063
8064 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8065 "SECTtemdnserr"
8066 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8067 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8068 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8069 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8070 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8071 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analagous to
8072 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8073 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8074 host lists such as whitelists.
8075
8076
8077
8078 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8079 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8080 .cindex "unknown host name"
8081 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8082 If a pattern is of the form
8083 .display
8084 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8085 .endd
8086 for example
8087 .code
8088 dbm;/host/accept/list
8089 .endd
8090 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8091 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8092 is not used.
8093
8094 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8095 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8096 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8097 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8098 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8099 lookup, both using the same file.
8100
8101
8102
8103 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8104 If a pattern is of the form
8105 .display
8106 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8107 .endd
8108 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8109 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8110 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8111 .code
8112 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8113 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8114 .endd
8115 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8116 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8117 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8118 operator.
8119
8120 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8121 looks up the host name if has not already done so. (See section
8122 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8123
8124 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8125 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8126 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8127 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8128 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8129 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8130
8131
8132
8133 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8134 "SECTmixwilhos"
8135 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8136 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same
8137 host list, you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, in an
8138 ACL you could have:
8139 .code
8140 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8141 .endd
8142 The reason for this lies in the left-to-right way that Exim processes lists.
8143 It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an
8144 item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to
8145 compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8146 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even if its
8147 IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8148
8149 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8150 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8151 .code
8152 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8153 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8154 .endd
8155 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8156 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs.
8157
8158
8159
8160
8161
8162 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8163 .cindex "list" "address list"
8164 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8165 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8166 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8167 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8168 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8169 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8170 using this option setting:
8171 .code
8172 senders = :
8173 .endd
8174 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8175 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8176 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8177 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8178
8179 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8180 example:
8181 .code
8182 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8183 .endd
8184 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8185 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8186 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8187 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8188 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8189 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8190 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8191 .code
8192 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8193 *@+hostile_domains:\
8194 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8195 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8196 .endd
8197 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8198 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8199 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8200 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8201 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8202
8203 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8204 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8205 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8206 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8207 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8208 .code
8209 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8210 .endd
8211
8212 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8213 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8214 senders:
8215
8216 .ilist
8217 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8218 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8219 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8220 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8221 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8222 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8223 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8224 .code
8225 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8226 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8227 .endd
8228 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8229 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8230
8231 .next
8232 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8233 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8234 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8235 example:
8236 .code
8237 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8238 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8239 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8240 .endd
8241 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8242 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8243 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8244 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8245
8246 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8247 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8248 panic log.
8249 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8250 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8251 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8252 default. For example, with this lookup:
8253 .code
8254 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8255 .endd
8256 the file could contains lines like this:
8257 .code
8258 user1@domain1.example
8259 *@domain2.example
8260 .endd
8261 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8262 that are tried is:
8263 .code
8264 nimrod@jaeger.example
8265 *@jaeger.example
8266 *
8267 .endd
8268 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8269 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8270
8271 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8272 .code
8273 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8274 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8275 .endd
8276 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8277 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8278 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8279 .endlist
8280
8281
8282 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8283 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8284 always fails.
8285
8286
8287 .ilist
8288 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8289 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8290 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8291 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8292 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8293 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8294 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8295 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8296 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8297
8298 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8299 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8300 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8301 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8302 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8303 with
8304 .code
8305 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8306 .endd
8307 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8308 .code
8309 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8310 .endd
8311 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8312
8313 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8314 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8315 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8316 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8317 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8318 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8319 .code
8320 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8321 spammer3 : spammer4
8322 .endd
8323 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8324 doubling.
8325
8326 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8327 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8328 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8329 might have entries like
8330 .code
8331 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8332 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8333 *: ^\d{8}$
8334 .endd
8335 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8336 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8337 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8338 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8339
8340 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8341 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8342 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8343
8344 .next
8345 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8346 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8347 can only return a single list of local parts.
8348 .endlist
8349
8350 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8351 in these two examples:
8352 .code
8353 senders = +my_list
8354 senders = *@+my_list
8355 .endd
8356 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8357 example it is a named domain list.
8358
8359
8360
8361
8362 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8363 .cindex "case of local parts"
8364 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8365 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8366 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8367 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8368 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8369 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8370 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8371 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8372 default.
8373
8374 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8375 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8376 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8377 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8378 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8379 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8380 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8381 case-independent.
8382
8383 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8384 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8385 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8386 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8387 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8388 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8389 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8390 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8391
8392
8393
8394 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8395 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8396 .cindex "local part" "list"
8397 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8398 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8399 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8400 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8401 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8402 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8403 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8404 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8405
8406 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8407 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8408 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8409 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8410 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8411 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8412 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8413 types.
8414 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8415
8416
8417
8418
8419 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8420 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8421
8422 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8423 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8424 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8425 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8426
8427 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8428 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8429 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8430 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8431 escape character, as described in the following section.
8432
8433
8434
8435 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8436 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8437 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8438 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8439 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8440 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8441 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8442 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8443
8444 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8445 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8446 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8447 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8448 .code
8449 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8450 .endd
8451 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8452 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8453 string.
8454
8455
8456
8457 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8458 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8459 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8460 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8461 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8462 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8463 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8464 encoding.
8465
8466 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8467 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8468 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8469
8470
8471 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8472 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8473 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8474 .oindex "&%-be%&"
8475 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8476 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8477 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8478 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8479 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8480 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8481 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8482 and &%nhash%&.
8483
8484 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8485 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8486 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8487
8488 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
8489 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8490 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8491 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8492 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8493 .code
8494 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8495 .endd
8496 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8497 Exim message identifier. For example:
8498 .code
8499 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8500 .endd
8501 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8502 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8503
8504
8505 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8506 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8507 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8508 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8509 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8510 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8511 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8512 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8513 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8514 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8515 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8516 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8517 being expanded.
8518
8519
8520
8521
8522 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8523 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8524 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8525 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8526 white space is significant.
8527
8528 .vlist
8529 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8530 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8531 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8532 .code
8533 $local_part
8534 ${domain}
8535 .endd
8536 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8537 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8538 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8539 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8540 given, the expansion fails.
8541
8542 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8543 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8544 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8545 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8546 .code
8547 ${lc:$local_part}
8548 .endd
8549 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8550 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8551 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8552 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8553 string easier to understand.
8554
8555 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8556 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8557 expansion item below.
8558
8559 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
8560 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8561 .cindex &%dlfunc%&
8562 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
8563 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
8564 .code
8565 EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
8566 .endd
8567 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
8568 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
8569 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
8570
8571 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
8572 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
8573 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
8574 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
8575 must have the following type:
8576 .code
8577 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
8578 .endd
8579 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
8580 function should return one of the following values:
8581
8582 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
8583 into the expanded string that is being built.
8584
8585 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
8586 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
8587
8588 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
8589 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
8590
8591 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
8592
8593 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
8594 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
8595 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
8596
8597 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
8598 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8599 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
8600 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
8601 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
8602 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
8603 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
8604 form:
8605 .display
8606 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
8607 .endd
8608 .vindex "&$value$&"
8609 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
8610 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
8611 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
8612 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
8613 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
8614 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8615 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8616 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8617 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8618
8619 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8620 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8621 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
8622 yield &"2001"&:
8623 .code
8624 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
8625 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
8626 .endd
8627 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
8628 appear, for example:
8629 .code
8630 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
8631 .endd
8632 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
8633 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
8634
8635
8636 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
8637 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8638 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
8639 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
8640 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
8641 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
8642 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
8643 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
8644 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
8645 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
8646 <&'string3'&> as before.
8647
8648 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
8649 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
8650 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
8651 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
8652 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
8653 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
8654 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
8655 provided. For example:
8656 .code
8657 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8658 .endd
8659 yields &"42"&, and
8660 .code
8661 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8662 .endd
8663 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
8664 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
8665
8666
8667 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
8668 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
8669 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
8670 .vindex "&$item$&"
8671 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
8672 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
8673 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
8674 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
8675 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
8676 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
8677 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
8678 .code
8679 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
8680 .endd
8681 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
8682 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
8683
8684
8685 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
8686 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
8687 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
8688 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
8689 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
8690 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
8691
8692 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
8693 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
8694 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
8695 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8696 .code
8697 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8698 .endd
8699 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
8700 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
8701 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
8702 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
8703 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
8704 .code
8705 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
8706 .endd
8707 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
8708 letters appear. For example:
8709 .display
8710 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
8711 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
8712 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
8713 .endd
8714
8715 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8716 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8717 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8718 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8719 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8720 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
8721 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
8722 .vindex "&$header_$&"
8723 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
8724 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
8725 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
8726 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
8727 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
8728 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
8729 .code
8730 $header_reply-to:
8731 .endd
8732 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
8733 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
8734 lines) may be present.
8735
8736 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
8737 the data in the header line is interpreted.
8738
8739 .ilist
8740 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
8741 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
8742 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
8743
8744 .next
8745 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
8746 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
8747 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
8748 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
8749 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
8750 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
8751 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
8752 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
8753
8754 .next
8755 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
8756 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
8757 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
8758 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
8759 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
8760 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
8761 .endlist ilist
8762
8763 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
8764 command of the following form:
8765 .code
8766 headers charset "UTF-8"
8767 .endd
8768 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
8769 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
8770 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
8771 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
8772 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
8773 ISO-8859-1.
8774
8775 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
8776 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
8777 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
8778 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
8779
8780 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
8781 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
8782 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
8783 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
8784 router or transport are not accessible.
8785
8786 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
8787 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
8788 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
8789 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
8790 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
8791 by earlier ACLs are visible.
8792
8793 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
8794 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
8795 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
8796 white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
8797 If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
8798 replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
8799 &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
8800
8801 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
8802 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
8803 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
8804 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
8805 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
8806 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
8807 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
8808 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
8809
8810
8811 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
8812 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
8813 .cindex &%hmac%&
8814 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
8815 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
8816 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
8817 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
8818 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
8819 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
8820 present. For example:
8821 .code
8822 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
8823 .endd
8824 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
8825 produces:
8826 .code
8827 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
8828 .endd
8829 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
8830 an Exim configuration:
8831 .code
8832 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
8833 .endd
8834 In a router or a transport you could then have:
8835 .code
8836 headers_add = \
8837 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
8838 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
8839 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
8840 .endd
8841 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
8842 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
8843 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
8844 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
8845 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
8846 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
8847
8848
8849 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8850 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
8851 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
8852 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
8853 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
8854 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
8855 .code
8856 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
8857 .endd
8858 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
8859 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
8860 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
8861 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
8862 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
8863
8864 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
8865 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
8866 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
8867 .code
8868 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
8869 .endd
8870 you can use
8871 .code
8872 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
8873 .endd
8874
8875 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8876 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
8877 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
8878 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
8879 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
8880 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
8881 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
8882 some of the braces:
8883 .code
8884 ${length_<n>:<string>}
8885 .endd
8886 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
8887 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
8888 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
8889
8890
8891 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
8892 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
8893 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
8894 described in the next item.
8895
8896 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
8897 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
8898 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
8899 .cindex "file" "lookups"
8900 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
8901 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
8902 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
8903 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
8904 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
8905
8906 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
8907 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
8908 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
8909 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
8910 out by the system administrator.
8911
8912 .vindex "&$value$&"
8913 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
8914 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
8915 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
8916 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
8917 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
8918 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
8919 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
8920 original lookup fails.
8921
8922 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
8923 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
8924 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
8925 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
8926 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
8927 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
8928 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
8929 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
8930
8931 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
8932 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
8933 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
8934 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
8935
8936 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
8937 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
8938 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
8939 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
8940
8941 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
8942 .code
8943 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
8944 .endd
8945 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
8946 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
8947 .code
8948 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
8949 {$value}fail}
8950 .endd
8951
8952
8953 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8954 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
8955 .vindex "&$item$&"
8956 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
8957 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
8958 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
8959 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
8960 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
8961 setting is not included in the output. For example:
8962 .code
8963 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
8964 .endd
8965 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
8966 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
8967 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
8968
8969 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
8970 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
8971 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
8972 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
8973 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
8974 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
8975 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8976 .code
8977 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8978 .endd
8979 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
8980 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
8981 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
8982 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
8983 example,
8984 .code
8985 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
8986 .endd
8987 returns the string &"6/33"&.
8988
8989
8990
8991 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
8992 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
8993 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
8994 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
8995 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
8996 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
8997 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
8998 name of the subroutine, is nine.
8999
9000 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9001 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9002 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9003 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9004 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9005 not its contents.
9006
9007 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9008 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9009 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9010
9011 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9012 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9013
9014
9015 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9016 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9017 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9018 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9019 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9020 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9021 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9022 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9023
9024 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9025 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9026 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9027 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9028 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9029 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9030 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9031 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9032 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9033 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9034
9035 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9036 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9037 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9038 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9039
9040 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9041 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9042 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9043 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9044 is the expansion of the third argument.
9045
9046 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9047 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9048 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9049
9050 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9051 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9052 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9053 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9054 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9055 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9056 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9057 newlines are left in the string.
9058 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9059 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9060 the string expansion fails.
9061
9062 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9063 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9064
9065
9066
9067 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9068 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9069 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9070 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9071 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9072 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or Internet socket into the expanded
9073 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9074 examples:
9075 .code
9076 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9077 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9078 .endd
9079 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9080 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9081 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9082 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9083 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9084 example:
9085 .code
9086 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9087 .endd
9088 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9089 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9090 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9091 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9092 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9093 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9094 .code
9095 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9096 .endd
9097 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9098 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9099 turns them into spaces:
9100 .code
9101 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9102 .endd
9103 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9104 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9105 addition, the following errors can occur:
9106
9107 .ilist
9108 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9109 .next
9110 Failure to connect the socket;
9111 .next
9112 Failure to write the request string;
9113 .next
9114 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9115 .endlist
9116
9117 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9118 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9119 errors occurs. For example:
9120 .code
9121 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9122 {socket failure}}
9123 .endd
9124 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9125 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9126 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9127 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9128 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9129
9130 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9131 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9132
9133
9134 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9135 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9136 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9137 .vindex "&$value$&"
9138 .vindex "&$item$&"
9139 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9140 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9141 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9142 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9143 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9144 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9145 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9146 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9147 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9148 .code
9149 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9150 .endd
9151 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9152 can be found:
9153 .code
9154 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9155 .endd
9156 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9157 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9158 expansion items.
9159
9160 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9161 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9162 expansion item above.
9163
9164 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9165 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9166 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9167 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9168 The command and its arguments are first expanded separately, and then the
9169 command is run in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in
9170 other command executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If you want
9171 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9172
9173 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9174 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9175 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9176 .vindex "&$value$&"
9177 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9178 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9179 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9180 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9181 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9182 &$value$&.
9183
9184 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9185 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9186 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9187 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9188
9189 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
9190 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9191 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9192 .code
9193 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9194 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9195 ...
9196 endif
9197 .endd
9198 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9199 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9200 commands.
9201
9202 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9203 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9204 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9205 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9206
9207 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9208 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9209
9210
9211 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9212 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9213 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9214 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9215 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9216 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9217 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9218 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9219 .code
9220 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9221 .endd
9222 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9223 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9224 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9225 .code
9226 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9227 .endd
9228 yields &"defabc"&, and
9229 .code
9230 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9231 .endd
9232 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9233 the regular expression from string expansion.
9234
9235
9236
9237 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9238 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9239 .cindex "substring extraction"
9240 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9241 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9242 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9243 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9244 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9245 .code
9246 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9247 .endd
9248 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9249 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9250 omitted.
9251
9252 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9253 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9254 length required. For example
9255 .code
9256 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9257 .endd
9258 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9259 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9260 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9261 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9262
9263 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9264 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9265 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9266 .code
9267 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9268 .endd
9269 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9270 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9271 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9272 .code
9273 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9274 .endd
9275 yields an empty string, but
9276 .code
9277 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9278 .endd
9279 yields &"1"&.
9280
9281 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9282 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9283 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9284 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9285 .code
9286 ${substr_-1:abcde}
9287 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9288 .endd
9289 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9290
9291
9292
9293 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9294 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9295 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9296 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9297 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9298 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9299 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9300 replacement list. For example
9301 .code
9302 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9303 .endd
9304 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9305 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9306 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9307 place.
9308 .endlist
9309
9310
9311
9312 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9313 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9314 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9315 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9316 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9317 following operations can be performed:
9318
9319 .vlist
9320 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9321 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9322 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9323 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9324 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9325 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9326
9327
9328 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9329 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9330 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9331 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9332 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9333 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9334 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9335 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9336 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9337
9338 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9339 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9340 character. For example:
9341 .code
9342 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9343 .endd
9344 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9345 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9346 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9347 processing lists.
9348
9349
9350 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9351 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9352 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9353 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9354 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9355 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9356 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9357 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9358 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9359
9360 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9361 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9362 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9363 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9364 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9365 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9366 string.
9367
9368 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9369 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
9370 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9371 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9372 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9373
9374
9375 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9376 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9377 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9378 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9379 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9380 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9381 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9382
9383
9384 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9385 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9386 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9387 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9388 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9389 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9390 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9391 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9392 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9393 C programming language):
9394 .table2 70pt 300pt
9395 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9396 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9397 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
9398 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
9399 .irow "" "and (&&)"
9400 .irow "" "xor (^)"
9401 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
9402 .endtable
9403 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
9404 space is permitted before or after operators.
9405
9406 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
9407 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
9408 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
9409 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
9410 times, which often do have leading zeros.
9411
9412 A number may be followed by &"K"& or &"M"& to multiply it by 1024 or 1024*1024,
9413 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
9414 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"& or &"M"&). For example:
9415
9416 .display
9417 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
9418 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
9419 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
9420 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
9421 &`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
9422 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
9423 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
9424 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
9425 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
9426 &`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
9427 &`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
9428 .endd
9429
9430 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
9431 .code
9432 deny message = Too many bad recipients
9433 condition = \
9434 ${if and { \
9435 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
9436 { \
9437 < \
9438 {$recipients_count} \
9439 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
9440 } \
9441 }{yes}{no}}
9442 .endd
9443 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
9444 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
9445
9446
9447 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9448 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
9449 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
9450 example,
9451 .code
9452 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
9453 .endd
9454 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
9455 and then re-expands what it has found.
9456
9457
9458 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9459 .cindex "Unicode"
9460 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
9461 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
9462 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
9463 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
9464 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
9465 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
9466 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
9467 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
9468 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
9469
9470 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
9471 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
9472 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
9473 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
9474 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
9475 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
9476 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
9477
9478
9479 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9480 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9481 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9482 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
9483 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
9484 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9485 .code
9486 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9487 .endd
9488 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
9489 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
9490
9491
9492
9493 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
9494 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
9495 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
9496 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
9497 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
9498 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
9499
9500
9501 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9502 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9503 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9504 .cindex "lower casing"
9505 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9506 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
9507 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
9508 .code
9509 ${lc:$local_part}
9510 .endd
9511
9512 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9513 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9514 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9515 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
9516 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
9517 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
9518 .code
9519 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
9520 .endd
9521 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
9522 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
9523 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
9524
9525
9526 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9527 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
9528 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
9529 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
9530 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
9531 empty.
9532
9533
9534 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
9535 .cindex "masked IP address"
9536 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
9537 .cindex "CIDR notation"
9538 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
9539 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
9540 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
9541 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
9542 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
9543 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
9544 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
9545 .code
9546 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
9547 .endd
9548 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
9549 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
9550 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
9551 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
9552 .code
9553 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
9554 .endd
9555 returns the string
9556 .code
9557 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
9558 .endd
9559 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
9560
9561
9562 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9563 .cindex "MD5 hash"
9564 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
9565 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
9566 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
9567 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
9568
9569
9570 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9571 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9572 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9573 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
9574 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
9575 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9576 .code
9577 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9578 .endd
9579 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
9580
9581
9582 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9583 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
9584 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
9585 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
9586 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
9587 is an empty string or
9588 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
9589 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
9590 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
9591 respectively For example,
9592 .code
9593 ${quote:ab"*"cd}
9594 .endd
9595 becomes
9596 .code
9597 "ab\"*\"cd"
9598 .endd
9599 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
9600 variable or a message header.
9601
9602 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9603 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
9604 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
9605 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
9606 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
9607 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
9608 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
9609
9610
9611 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9612 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
9613 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
9614 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
9615 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
9616 .code
9617 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
9618 .endd
9619 returns
9620 .code
9621 two%20%5C2A%20two
9622 .endd
9623 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
9624 yields an unchanged string.
9625
9626
9627 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
9628 .cindex "random number"
9629 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
9630 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
9631 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
9632 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
9633 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
9634 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
9635 random().
9636
9637
9638 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
9639 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
9640 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
9641 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addreses the result is in
9642 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
9643 for DNS. For example,
9644 .code
9645 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4} and ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.3}
9646 .endd
9647 returns
9648 .code
9649 4.2.0.192 and 3.0.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
9650 .endd
9651
9652
9653 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9654 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9655 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
9656 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
9657 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
9658 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
9659 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
9660 &%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
9661 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
9662 characters
9663 .code
9664 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
9665 .endd
9666 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
9667 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
9668 characters.
9669
9670
9671 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9672 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9673 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
9674 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
9675 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
9676 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
9677 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
9678 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
9679
9680 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
9681 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
9682 to use this operator as well.
9683
9684
9685
9686 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9687 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
9688 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
9689 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
9690 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
9691 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
9692 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
9693
9694
9695 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9696 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
9697 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
9698 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
9699 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
9700 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
9701
9702
9703 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9704 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
9705 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
9706 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
9707 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
9708 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
9709 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
9710 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
9711 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
9712 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
9713 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
9714 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
9715 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
9716
9717 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
9718 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
9719 systems for files larger than 2GB.
9720
9721 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9722 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
9723 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
9724 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
9725 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
9726
9727
9728
9729 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9730 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
9731 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
9732 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
9733 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
9734 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
9735
9736
9737 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9738 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9739 .cindex "substring extraction"
9740 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
9741 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
9742 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
9743 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9744 .code
9745 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
9746 .endd
9747 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
9748 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
9749
9750 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9751 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
9752 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
9753 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
9754 seconds.
9755
9756 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9757 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
9758 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
9759 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
9760 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
9761 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
9762 &`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
9763
9764 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9765 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9766 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9767 .cindex "upper casing"
9768 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9769 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
9770 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
9771 .endlist
9772
9773
9774
9775
9776
9777
9778 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
9779 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
9780 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
9781 while expanding strings:
9782
9783 .vlist
9784 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
9785 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
9786 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
9787 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
9788 condition.
9789
9790 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9791 .cindex "numeric comparison"
9792 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
9793 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
9794 are:
9795 .display
9796 &`= `& equal
9797 &`== `& equal
9798 &`> `& greater
9799 &`>= `& greater or equal
9800 &`< `& less
9801 &`<= `& less or equal
9802 .endd
9803 For example:
9804 .code
9805 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
9806 .endd
9807 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
9808 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
9809 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"& or &"M"& (in either upper or
9810 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024 or 1024*1024, respectively.
9811 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
9812 zero.
9813
9814 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9815 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
9816 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
9817 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
9818 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
9819 (case-insensitively); also positive integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
9820 false if zero. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
9821 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
9822
9823 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
9824 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
9825 For example:
9826 .code
9827 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
9828 .endd
9829
9830 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9831 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
9832 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
9833 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
9834 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
9835 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
9836 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
9837 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
9838
9839 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
9840
9841 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9842 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
9843 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
9844 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
9845 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
9846 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
9847 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
9848 included in the binary.
9849
9850 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
9851 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
9852 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
9853 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
9854 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
9855 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
9856 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
9857 string in LDAP form is:
9858 .code
9859 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
9860 .endd
9861 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
9862 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
9863 .code
9864 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
9865 .endd
9866 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
9867 supported:
9868
9869 .ilist
9870 .cindex "MD5 hash"
9871 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
9872 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
9873 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
9874 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
9875 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
9876 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
9877 comparison fails.
9878
9879 .next
9880 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
9881 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
9882 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
9883 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
9884 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
9885 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
9886
9887 .next
9888 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
9889 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
9890 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
9891 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
9892 whatever its length.
9893
9894 .next
9895 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
9896 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
9897 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
9898 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
9899 .endlist
9900 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
9901 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
9902 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
9903 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
9904 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
9905 support &[crypt16()]&.
9906
9907 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
9908 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
9909 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
9910 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
9911 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
9912
9913 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
9914 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
9915 Exim is seen as very low priority.
9916
9917 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
9918 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
9919 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
9920 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
9921 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
9922
9923 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
9924 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
9925 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
9926 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
9927 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
9928 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
9929 .code
9930 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
9931 .endd
9932 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
9933 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
9934
9935 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
9936 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9937 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
9938 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
9939 exists in the message. For example,
9940 .code
9941 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
9942 .endd
9943 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
9944 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
9945
9946 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
9947 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9948 .cindex "string" "comparison"
9949 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
9950 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
9951 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
9952 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
9953 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
9954 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
9955
9956 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
9957 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
9958 .cindex "file" "existence test"
9959 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
9960 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
9961 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
9962 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
9963 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
9964
9965 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
9966 .cindex "delivery" "first"
9967 .cindex "first delivery"
9968 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
9969 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
9970 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
9971 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
9972
9973
9974 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
9975 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
9976 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
9977 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
9978 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
9979 .vindex "&$item$&"
9980 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
9981 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
9982 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
9983 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
9984 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
9985 .ilist
9986 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
9987 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
9988 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
9989 .next
9990 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
9991 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
9992 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
9993 .endlist
9994 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
9995 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
9996 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
9997 list separator is changed to a comma:
9998 .code
9999 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10000 .endd
10001 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10002 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10003
10004
10005 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10006 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10007 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10008 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10009 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10010 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10011 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10012 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10013 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10014 case-independent.
10015
10016 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10017 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10018 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10019 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10020 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10021 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10022 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10023 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10024 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10025 case-independent.
10026
10027 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10028 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10029 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10030 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10031 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10032 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10033 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10034 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10035 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10036 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10037 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10038
10039 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10040 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10041 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10042 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10043 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10044
10045 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10046 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10047 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10048 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10049 .code
10050 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10051 .endd
10052 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10053
10054 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10055 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10056 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10057 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10058 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10059 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10060 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10061 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10062 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10063 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10064 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10065 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10066 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10067 this can be used.
10068
10069
10070 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10071 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10072 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10073 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10074 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10075 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10076 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10077 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10078 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10079 case-independent.
10080
10081 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10082 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10083 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10084 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10085 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10086 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10087 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10088 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10089 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10090 case-independent.
10091
10092
10093 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10094 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10095 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10096 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10097 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10098 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10099 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10100 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10101 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10102 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10103 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10104 For example,
10105 .code
10106 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10107 .endd
10108 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10109 backslashes is also required.
10110
10111 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10112 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10113 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10114 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10115 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10116 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10117
10118 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10119 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10120 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10121 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10122 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10123 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10124 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10125 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10126
10127 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10128 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10129 See &*match_local_part*&.
10130
10131 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10132 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10133 See &*match_local_part*&.
10134
10135 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10136 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10137 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10138 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10139 address or an empty string. The second (after expansion) is a restricted host
10140 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10141 .code
10142 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10143 .endd
10144 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10145
10146 .ilist
10147 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10148 .next
10149 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10150 .next
10151 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10152 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10153 in a single test such as
10154 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10155 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10156 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10157 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10158 .code
10159 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10160 .endd
10161 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10162 .next
10163 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10164 .next
10165 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10166 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10167 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10168 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10169 masks. For example:
10170 .code
10171 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10172 .endd
10173 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10174 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10175 address mask, for example:
10176 .code
10177 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10178 .endd
10179 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10180 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10181 .code
10182 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10183 .endd
10184 .endlist ilist
10185
10186 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10187
10188 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10189 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10190 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10191 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10192 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10193 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10194 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10195 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10196 example is:
10197 .code
10198 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10199 .endd
10200 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10201 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10202 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10203 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10204 .code
10205 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10206 .endd
10207 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10208 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10209 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10210 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10211 caselessly.
10212
10213 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10214 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10215 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10216 matched using &%match_ip%&.
10217
10218 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10219 .cindex "PAM authentication"
10220 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10221 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10222 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10223 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10224 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10225 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10226 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10227 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10228 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10229 .code
10230 SUPPORT_PAM=yes
10231 .endd
10232 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10233 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10234
10235 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10236 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10237 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10238 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10239 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10240 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10241 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10242
10243 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10244 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10245 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10246 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10247 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10248 .code
10249 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10250 .endd
10251 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10252 .code
10253 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10254 .endd
10255 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10256 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10257 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10258 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10259 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10260 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10261 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10262 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10263
10264
10265 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10266 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10267 .cindex "Cyrus"
10268 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10269 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10270 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10271 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10272 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10273 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10274
10275 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10276 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10277 building Exim. For example:
10278 .code
10279 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10280 .endd
10281 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10282 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10283 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10284 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10285
10286 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
10287 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
10288 configuration, you might have this:
10289 .code
10290 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
10291 .endd
10292 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
10293 .code
10294 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
10295 .endd
10296 .vitem &*queue_running*&
10297 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
10298 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
10299 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
10300 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
10301 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
10302
10303
10304 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
10305 .cindex "Radius"
10306 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
10307 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
10308 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
10309 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
10310 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
10311 support.
10312
10313 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
10314 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
10315 this library, you need to set
10316 .code
10317 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
10318 .endd
10319 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
10320 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
10321 .code
10322 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
10323 .endd
10324 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
10325 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
10326 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
10327
10328 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
10329 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
10330 the authentication is successful. For example:
10331 .code
10332 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
10333 .endd
10334
10335
10336 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
10337 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
10338 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
10339 .cindex "Cyrus"
10340 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
10341 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
10342 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
10343 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
10344 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
10345 by a process that is not running as root.
10346
10347 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10348 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10349 building Exim. For example:
10350 .code
10351 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
10352 .endd
10353 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10354 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10355 from the Cyrus SASL library.
10356
10357 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
10358 two are mandatory. For example:
10359 .code
10360 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
10361 .endd
10362 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
10363 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
10364 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
10365 .endlist vlist
10366
10367
10368
10369 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
10370 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
10371 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
10372 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
10373 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
10374 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
10375 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
10376
10377
10378 .vlist
10379 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10380 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
10381 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
10382 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10383 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
10384 For example,
10385 .code
10386 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
10387 .endd
10388 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
10389 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
10390 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
10391
10392 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10393 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
10394 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
10395 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10396 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
10397 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
10398 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
10399 parsed but not evaluated.
10400 .endlist
10401 .ecindex IIDexpcond
10402
10403
10404
10405
10406 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
10407 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
10408 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
10409 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
10410 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
10411
10412 .vlist
10413 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
10414 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
10415 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
10416 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
10417 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
10418 However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
10419 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
10420 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
10421 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
10422 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
10423 matching condition.
10424
10425 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
10426 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
10427 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
10428 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
10429 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
10430 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
10431 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
10432 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
10433 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
10434 during subsequent delivery.
10435
10436 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
10437 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
10438 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
10439 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
10440 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
10441 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
10442 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
10443 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
10444 delivery.
10445
10446 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
10447 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
10448 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
10449 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
10450 be preserved by coding like this:
10451 .code
10452 warn !verify = sender
10453 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
10454 .endd
10455 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
10456 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
10457 failure.
10458
10459 .vitem &$address_data$&
10460 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
10461 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
10462 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
10463 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
10464 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
10465 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
10466 user filter files.
10467
10468 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
10469 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
10470 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
10471 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
10472 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
10473 from the child's routing.
10474
10475 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
10476 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
10477 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
10478 address.
10479
10480 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
10481 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
10482 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
10483
10484 .vitem &$address_file$&
10485 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
10486 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
10487 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
10488 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
10489 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
10490 .code
10491 /home/r2d2/savemail
10492 .endd
10493 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
10494 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
10495 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
10496 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
10497 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
10498 to the relevant file.
10499
10500 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
10501 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
10502 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
10503 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
10504
10505 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
10506 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
10507 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
10508 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
10509
10510 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
10511 .cindex "authentication" "id"
10512 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
10513 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
10514 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
10515 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
10516 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
10517 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
10518 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
10519 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
10520 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
10521 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
10522 command line option.
10523
10524
10525
10526
10527 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
10528 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
10529 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
10530 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
10531 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
10532 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
10533 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
10534 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
10535 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
10536 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
10537 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
10538
10539 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
10540 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
10541 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
10542 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
10543 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
10544
10545
10546 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
10547 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
10548 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
10549 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
10550 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
10551 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
10552 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
10553 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
10554 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
10555 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
10556 an undefined mechanism.
10557
10558 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
10559 .cindex "message body" "line count"
10560 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
10561 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
10562 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10563 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
10564
10565 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
10566 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
10567 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
10568 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
10569 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
10570 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10571 number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
10572
10573 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
10574 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
10575 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
10576 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
10577 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10578
10579 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
10580 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
10581 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
10582 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
10583 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10584
10585 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
10586 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
10587 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
10588 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10589 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
10590 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10591 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
10592
10593 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
10594 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
10595 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
10596 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10597 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
10598 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10599 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
10600
10601 .vitem &$compile_date$&
10602 .vindex "&$compile_date$&"
10603 The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
10604
10605 .vitem &$compile_number$&
10606 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
10607 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
10608 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
10609 compilations of the same version of the program.
10610
10611 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
10612 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
10613 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
10614 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
10615 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10616
10617 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
10618 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
10619 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10620 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10621 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10622
10623 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
10624 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
10625 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
10626 &$dnslist_value$&
10627 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
10628 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
10629 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
10630 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
10631 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
10632 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
10633 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
10634 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
10635 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
10636
10637 .vitem &$domain$&
10638 .vindex "&$domain$&"
10639 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
10640 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
10641 case for &$domain$&.
10642
10643 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
10644 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
10645 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
10646 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
10647
10648 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
10649 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
10650 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
10651 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
10652 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
10653 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
10654
10655 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
10656 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
10657 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
10658
10659 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
10660
10661 .ilist
10662 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
10663 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
10664 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
10665 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
10666 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
10667 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
10668 the &(smtp)& transport.
10669
10670 .next
10671 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
10672 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
10673 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
10674 rewrite domains by file lookup.
10675
10676 .next
10677 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
10678 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
10679 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
10680 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
10681 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
10682 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
10683
10684 .next
10685 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
10686 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
10687 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
10688 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
10689 .endlist
10690
10691
10692 .vitem &$domain_data$&
10693 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
10694 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
10695 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
10696 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
10697 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
10698 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
10699 used.
10700
10701 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
10702 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
10703 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
10704 to nothing.
10705
10706 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
10707 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
10708 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
10709
10710 .vitem &$exim_path$&
10711 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
10712 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
10713
10714 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
10715 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
10716 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
10717
10718 .vitem &$found_extension$&
10719 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
10720 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10721 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10722 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10723
10724 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
10725 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
10726 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
10727 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
10728 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
10729
10730 .vitem &$home$&
10731 .vindex "&$home$&"
10732 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
10733 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
10734 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
10735 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
10736 by a setting on the transport itself.
10737
10738 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
10739 of the environment variable HOME.
10740
10741 .vitem &$host$&
10742 .vindex "&$host$&"
10743 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
10744 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
10745 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
10746 to local and remote transports.
10747
10748 .cindex "transport" "filter"
10749 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
10750 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
10751 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
10752 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
10753 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
10754 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
10755 is connected.
10756
10757 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
10758 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
10759 client is connected.
10760
10761
10762 .vitem &$host_address$&
10763 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
10764 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
10765 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
10766 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
10767
10768 .vitem &$host_data$&
10769 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
10770 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
10771 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
10772 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
10773 .code
10774 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
10775 message = $host_data
10776 .endd
10777 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
10778 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
10779 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
10780 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
10781 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
10782 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
10783 variables is set to &"1"&.
10784
10785 .ilist
10786 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
10787 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
10788
10789 .next
10790 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
10791 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
10792 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
10793 .endlist ilist
10794
10795 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
10796 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
10797 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
10798 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
10799 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
10800 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
10801 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
10802 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
10803 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
10804 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
10805
10806 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
10807 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
10808 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
10809
10810
10811 .vitem &$inode$&
10812 .vindex "&$inode$&"
10813 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
10814 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
10815 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
10816 a unique name for the file.
10817
10818 .vitem &$interface_address$&
10819 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
10820 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
10821
10822 .vitem &$interface_port$&
10823 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
10824 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
10825
10826 .vitem &$item$&
10827 .vindex "&$item$&"
10828 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
10829 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
10830 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
10831 empty.
10832
10833 .vitem &$ldap_dn$&
10834 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
10835 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
10836 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
10837 lookup.
10838
10839 .vitem &$load_average$&
10840 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
10841 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
10842 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
10843 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
10844
10845 .vitem &$local_part$&
10846 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
10847 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
10848 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
10849 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
10850 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
10851
10852 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
10853 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
10854 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
10855 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
10856 once.
10857
10858 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
10859 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
10860 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
10861 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
10862 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
10863 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
10864
10865 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
10866 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
10867 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
10868 &$address_pipe$&).
10869
10870 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
10871 local part of the recipient address.
10872
10873 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
10874 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
10875 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
10876
10877 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
10878 the addresses
10879 .code
10880 "abc:xyz"@test.example
10881 abc\:xyz@test.example
10882 .endd
10883 the value of &$local_part$& is
10884 .code
10885 abc:xyz
10886 .endd
10887 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
10888 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
10889 have:
10890 .code
10891 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
10892 .endd
10893 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
10894 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
10895 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
10896
10897 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
10898 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
10899 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
10900 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
10901 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
10902 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
10903 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
10904
10905 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
10906 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
10907 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
10908 variable expands to nothing.
10909
10910 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
10911 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
10912 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
10913 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
10914 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
10915
10916 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
10917 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
10918 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
10919 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
10920 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
10921
10922 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
10923 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
10924 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
10925 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
10926
10927 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
10928 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
10929 See &$local_user_uid$&.
10930
10931 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
10932 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
10933 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
10934 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
10935 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
10936 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
10937 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
10938 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
10939
10940 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
10941 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
10942 This contains the expanded value of the
10943 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
10944 been read.
10945
10946 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
10947 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
10948 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
10949 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
10950 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
10951 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
10952
10953 .vitem &$log_space$&
10954 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
10955 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
10956 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
10957 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
10958 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
10959 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
10960
10961
10962 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
10963 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
10964 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
10965 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
10966 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
10967 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
10968 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
10969 variable is empty.
10970
10971 .vitem &$malware_name$&
10972 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
10973 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10974 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
10975 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
10976
10977 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
10978 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
10979 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
10980 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
10981 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
10982 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
10983 character(s).
10984
10985 .vitem &$message_age$&
10986 .cindex "message" "age of"
10987 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
10988 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
10989 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
10990 delivery attempt.
10991
10992 .vitem &$message_body$&
10993 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
10994 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
10995 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
10996 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
10997 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
10998 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
10999 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11000 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11001 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11002
11003 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11004 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11005 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11006 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11007 zeros are always converted into spaces.
11008
11009 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
11010 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11011 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11012 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11013 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11014 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11015 &$message_body$&.
11016
11017 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
11018 .cindex "body of message" "size"
11019 .cindex "message body" "size"
11020 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11021 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11022 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11023 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11024 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11025
11026 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11027 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11028 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11029 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11030 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11031 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11032 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11033 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11034
11035 .vitem &$message_headers$&
11036 .vindex &$message_headers$&
11037 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11038 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11039 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11040 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11041
11042 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11043 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11044 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11045 contents of header lines is done.
11046
11047 .vitem &$message_id$&
11048 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&, which is now deprecated.
11049
11050 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
11051 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11052 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11053 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11054 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11055 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11056 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11057 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11058 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11059 from the body is not counted. Here is an example of the use of this variable in
11060 a DATA ACL:
11061 .code
11062 deny message = Too many lines in message header
11063 condition = \
11064 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11065 .endd
11066 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11067 message has not yet been received.
11068
11069 .vitem &$message_size$&
11070 .cindex "size" "of message"
11071 .cindex "message" "size"
11072 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
11073 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11074 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11075 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11076 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11077 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11078 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11079 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11080 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11081
11082 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11083 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11084 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11085 value may not, of course, be truthful.
11086
11087 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11088 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11089 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11090 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11091
11092 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11093 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11094 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11095
11096 .vitem &$original_domain$&
11097 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11098 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11099 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11100 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11101 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11102 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11103 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11104 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11105 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11106
11107 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11108 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11109 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11110
11111 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
11112 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11113 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11114 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11115 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11116 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11117 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11118 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11119 the original address.
11120
11121 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11122 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11123 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11124 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11125 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11126
11127 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11128 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11129 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11130
11131 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
11132 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11133 .cindex "sender" "gid"
11134 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11135 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11136 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11137 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11138 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11139 normally the gid of the Exim user.
11140
11141 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
11142 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11143 .cindex "sender" "uid"
11144 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11145 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11146 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11147 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11148 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11149 user.
11150
11151 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
11152 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11153 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11154 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11155
11156 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11157 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11158 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11159 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11160
11161 .vitem &$pid$&
11162 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11163 .vindex "&$pid$&"
11164 This variable contains the current process id.
11165
11166 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11167 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11168 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11169 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11170 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11171 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11172 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11173 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11174 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11175 variable"& error if encountered.
11176
11177 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
11178 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
11179 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
11180 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
11181 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
11182 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
11183 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
11184
11185
11186 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
11187 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11188 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11189 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11190
11191 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
11192 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11193 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11194 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11195
11196 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
11197 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11198 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11199 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11200
11201 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
11202 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11203 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
11204
11205 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
11206 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
11207 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
11208 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
11209
11210 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
11211 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
11212 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11213 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
11214 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
11215
11216 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
11217 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
11218 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
11219 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11220 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11221 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
11222
11223 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
11224 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
11225 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11226 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11227 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
11228
11229 .vitem &$received_count$&
11230 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
11231 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
11232 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
11233 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
11234 delivering.
11235
11236 .vitem &$received_for$&
11237 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
11238 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
11239 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
11240 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
11241 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
11242
11243 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
11244 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
11245 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
11246 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
11247 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
11248 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
11249 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
11250 option.
11251
11252 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
11253 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
11254 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
11255 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
11256 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
11257 time.
11258
11259 &*Note:*& There are no equivalent variables for outgoing connections, because
11260 the values are unknown (unless they are explicitly set by options of the
11261 &(smtp)& transport).
11262
11263 .vitem &$received_port$&
11264 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
11265 See &$received_ip_address$&.
11266
11267 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
11268 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
11269 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
11270 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
11271 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
11272 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
11273 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
11274 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
11275 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
11276
11277 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
11278 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
11279 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
11280 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
11281 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
11282 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
11283
11284 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
11285 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
11286 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
11287
11288 .vitem &$received_time$&
11289 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
11290 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
11291 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11292
11293 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
11294 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
11295 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
11296 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
11297 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
11298 .display
11299 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11300 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
11301 .endd
11302 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11303 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11304 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11305 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11306
11307 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
11308 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
11309 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
11310 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
11311
11312 .ilist
11313 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
11314 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
11315
11316 .next
11317 &"route"&: Routing failed.
11318
11319 .next
11320 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
11321 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
11322 MAIL).
11323
11324 .next
11325 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
11326 .next
11327
11328 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
11329 .endlist
11330
11331 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
11332 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
11333
11334 .vitem &$recipients$&
11335 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
11336 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
11337 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
11338 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
11339 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
11340 cases:
11341
11342 .olist
11343 In a system filter file.
11344 .next
11345 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
11346 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
11347 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
11348 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
11349 .next
11350 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
11351 .endlist
11352
11353
11354 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
11355 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
11356 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
11357 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
11358 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
11359 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
11360
11361
11362 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
11363 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
11364 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
11365 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
11366
11367
11368 .vitem &$reply_address$&
11369 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
11370 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
11371 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
11372 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
11373 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
11374 decoding or character code translation takes place.
11375
11376 .vitem &$return_path$&
11377 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
11378 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
11379 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
11380 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
11381 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
11382 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
11383 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
11384 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
11385 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
11386 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
11387 envelope sender.
11388
11389 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
11390 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
11391 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
11392
11393 .vitem &$runrc$&
11394 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
11395 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
11396 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
11397 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
11398 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
11399 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
11400 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
11401 another.
11402
11403 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
11404 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
11405 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
11406 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
11407 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
11408 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
11409 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
11410 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
11411
11412 .vitem &$sender_address$&
11413 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
11414 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
11415 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
11416 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
11417 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
11418
11419 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
11420 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11421 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
11422 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11423 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
11424 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
11425 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
11426 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
11427
11428 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
11429 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
11430 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
11431
11432 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
11433 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
11434 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
11435
11436 .vitem &$sender_data$&
11437 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
11438 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
11439 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
11440 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
11441 this:
11442 .display
11443 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11444 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
11445 .endd
11446 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11447 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11448 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11449 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11450
11451 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
11452 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
11453 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
11454 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
11455 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
11456 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
11457 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
11458 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
11459 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
11460 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
11461 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
11462 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
11463 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
11464
11465 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
11466 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
11467 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
11468 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
11469 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
11470 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
11471
11472 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
11473 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
11474 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains that
11475 host's IP address. For locally submitted messages, it is empty.
11476
11477 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
11478 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
11479 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
11480 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
11481 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
11482 &$authenticated_id$&.
11483
11484 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
11485 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
11486 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11487 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
11488 other means, this variable is empty.
11489
11490 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11491 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
11492 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
11493 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
11494 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
11495 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
11496 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11497
11498 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11499 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
11500 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
11501 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
11502
11503 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
11504 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
11505 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11506 is set to &"1"&.
11507
11508 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
11509 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
11510 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
11511 following are true:
11512
11513 .ilist
11514 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
11515 .next
11516 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
11517 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
11518 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
11519 .next
11520 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
11521 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
11522 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
11523 .next
11524 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
11525 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
11526 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
11527 .next
11528 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
11529 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
11530 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11531 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
11532 .code
11533 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
11534 .endd
11535 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
11536 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
11537 .endlist
11538
11539
11540 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
11541 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
11542 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
11543 number that was used on the remote host.
11544
11545 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
11546 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
11547 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11548 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
11549 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
11550 called Exim.
11551
11552 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
11553 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
11554 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
11555 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
11556
11557 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
11558 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
11559 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
11560 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
11561 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
11562 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
11563 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
11564 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
11565 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
11566 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
11567 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
11568 the parentheses.
11569
11570 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
11571 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
11572 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
11573 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
11574 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
11575
11576 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
11577 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
11578 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
11579 about the failure. The details are the same as for
11580 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
11581
11582 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
11583 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
11584 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11585 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
11586 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
11587 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
11588 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
11589
11590 .vitem &$sending_port$&
11591 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
11592 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11593 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
11594 connections, see &$received_port$&.
11595
11596 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
11597 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
11598 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
11599 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
11600 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
11601 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
11602
11603 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
11604 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
11605 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
11606 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
11607 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
11608 .code
11609 MAIL FROM:<>
11610 MAIL FROM: <>
11611 .endd
11612 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
11613 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
11614 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
11615 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
11616
11617 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
11618 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
11619 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
11620 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
11621 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
11622 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
11623 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
11624
11625 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
11626 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
11627 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
11628 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
11629 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
11630 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
11631 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
11632 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
11633 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
11634 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
11635 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
11636
11637 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
11638 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
11639 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
11640 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
11641 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
11642 message is junk mail.
11643
11644 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
11645 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
11646 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
11647 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
11648
11649
11650 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
11651 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
11652 The name of Exim's spool directory.
11653
11654 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
11655 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
11656 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
11657 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
11658 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
11659 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
11660
11661 .vitem &$spool_space$&
11662 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
11663 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
11664 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
11665 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
11666 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
11667 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
11668 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
11669 .code
11670 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
11671 .endd
11672 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
11673
11674
11675 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
11676 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
11677 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
11678 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
11679 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
11680 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
11681
11682 .vitem &$tls_certificate_verified$&
11683 .vindex "&$tls_certificate_verified$&"
11684 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
11685 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
11686
11687 .vitem &$tls_cipher$&
11688 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
11689 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
11690 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
11691 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
11692 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
11693 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
11694 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
11695
11696 The &$tls_cipher$& variable retains its value during message delivery, except
11697 when an outward SMTP delivery takes place via the &(smtp)& transport. In this
11698 case, &$tls_cipher$& is cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
11699 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
11700 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
11701 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
11702
11703 .vitem &$tls_peerdn$&
11704 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
11705 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
11706 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
11707 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
11708 &$tls_peerdn$& during subsequent processing. Like &$tls_cipher$&, the
11709 value is retained during message delivery, except during outbound SMTP
11710 deliveries.
11711
11712 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
11713 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
11714 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
11715 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
11716
11717 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
11718 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
11719 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11720
11721 .vitem &$tod_full$&
11722 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
11723 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
11724 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
11725 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
11726 values for those that are behind (west).
11727
11728 .vitem &$tod_log$&
11729 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
11730 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
11731 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
11732
11733 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
11734 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
11735 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
11736 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
11737 flag.
11738
11739 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
11740 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
11741 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
11742 -0500.
11743
11744 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
11745 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
11746 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
11747 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
11748
11749 .vitem &$value$&
11750 .vindex "&$value$&"
11751 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
11752 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
11753 &*reduce*& expansion.
11754
11755 .vitem &$version_number$&
11756 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
11757 The version number of Exim.
11758
11759 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
11760 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
11761 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
11762 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
11763
11764 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
11765 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
11766 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
11767 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
11768 .endlist
11769 .ecindex IIDstrexp
11770
11771
11772
11773 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11774 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11775
11776 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
11777 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
11778 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
11779 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
11780 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
11781 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
11782 the line
11783 .code
11784 EXIM_PERL = perl.o
11785 .endd
11786 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
11787
11788
11789 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
11790 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
11791 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
11792 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
11793 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
11794 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
11795 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
11796 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
11797 a newly created Perl interpreter.
11798
11799 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
11800 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
11801 should usually be something like
11802 .code
11803 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
11804 .endd
11805 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
11806 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
11807 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
11808 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
11809 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
11810 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
11811 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
11812 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
11813 two ways:
11814
11815 .ilist
11816 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
11817 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
11818 a startup when Exim is entered.
11819 .next
11820 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
11821 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
11822 .endlist
11823
11824 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
11825 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
11826
11827
11828 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
11829 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
11830 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
11831 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
11832 forms:
11833 .code
11834 ${perl{foo}}
11835 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
11836 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
11837 .endd
11838 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
11839 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
11840 with an error message of the form
11841 .code
11842 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
11843 .endd
11844 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
11845 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
11846 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
11847 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
11848 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
11849 that was passed to &%die%&.
11850
11851
11852 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
11853 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
11854 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
11855 the Perl code
11856 .code
11857 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
11858 .endd
11859 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
11860 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
11861 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
11862
11863 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
11864 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
11865 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
11866 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
11867
11868 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
11869 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
11870 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
11871 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
11872 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
11873 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
11874 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
11875
11876
11877 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
11878 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
11879 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
11880 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
11881 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
11882 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
11883 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
11884 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
11885 avoided, but the output is lost.
11886
11887 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
11888 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
11889 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
11890 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
11891 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
11892 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
11893 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
11894 .code
11895 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
11896 .endd
11897 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
11898 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
11899 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
11900 as the first subroutine argument.
11901 .ecindex IIDperl
11902
11903
11904 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11905 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11906
11907 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
11908 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
11909 "Starting the daemon"
11910 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
11911 .cindex "interface" "listening"
11912 .cindex "network interface"
11913 .cindex "interface" "network"
11914 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
11915 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
11916 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
11917 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
11918 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
11919 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
11920 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
11921 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
11922 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
11923 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
11924 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
11925
11926 .olist
11927 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
11928 and ports to listen on.
11929 .next
11930 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
11931 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
11932 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
11933 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
11934 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
11935 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
11936 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
11937 as an error situation.
11938 .next
11939 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
11940 for the outgoing connection.
11941 .endlist
11942
11943
11944 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
11945 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
11946 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
11947 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
11948 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
11949
11950 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
11951 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
11952 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
11953 chapter describes how they operate.
11954
11955 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
11956 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
11957
11958
11959
11960 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
11961 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
11962 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
11963 following options:
11964
11965 .ilist
11966 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports. (For backward
11967 compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
11968 .next
11969 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
11970 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
11971 .endlist
11972
11973 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
11974 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
11975 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
11976 colons. For example:
11977 .code
11978 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
11979 192.168.23.65 ; \
11980 ::1 ; \
11981 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
11982 .endd
11983 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
11984 in &%local_interfaces%&:
11985
11986 .olist
11987 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
11988 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
11989 .code
11990 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
11991 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
11992 .endd
11993 .next
11994 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
11995 with a colon separator, for example:
11996 .code
11997 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
11998 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
11999 .endd
12000 .endlist
12001
12002 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
12003 default setting contains just one port:
12004 .code
12005 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12006 .endd
12007 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
12008 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
12009 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
12010 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
12011 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
12012
12013
12014
12015 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
12016 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
12017 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
12018 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
12019 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
12020 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12021 .code
12022 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
12023 .endd
12024 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
12025 .code
12026 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12027 .endd
12028 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
12029
12030
12031
12032 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
12033 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
12034 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
12035 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
12036 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
12037 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
12038 exim.
12039
12040 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
12041 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
12042 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
12043 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
12044 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12045 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
12046 .code
12047 -oX 1225
12048 .endd
12049 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
12050 whereas
12051 .code
12052 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
12053 .endd
12054 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
12055 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
12056 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
12057
12058
12059
12060 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
12061 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
12062 .cindex "smtps protocol"
12063 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
12064 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
12065 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
12066 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
12067 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
12068 list of port numbers, connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
12069 common use of this option is expected to be
12070 .code
12071 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
12072 .endd
12073 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
12074 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
12075 this way when a daemon is started.
12076
12077 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
12078 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
12079 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
12080 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
12081 connections via the daemon.)
12082
12083
12084
12085
12086 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
12087 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
12088 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
12089 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
12090 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
12091 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
12092 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
12093 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
12094 .code
12095 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
12096 .endd
12097 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
12098 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
12099 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
12100 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
12101 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
12102 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
12103 .code
12104 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
12105 .endd
12106 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
12107 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
12108 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
12109 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
12110 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
12111
12112 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
12113 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
12114 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
12115 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
12116 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
12117 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
12118 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
12119 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
12120 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
12121 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
12122 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
12123 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
12124
12125 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
12126 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
12127 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
12128 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
12129 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
12130
12131
12132
12133 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
12134 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
12135 .code
12136 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12137 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12138 .endd
12139 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
12140 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
12141 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
12142 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
12143
12144 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
12145 .code
12146 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
12147 .endd
12148 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
12149 .code
12150 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
12151 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
12152 .endd
12153 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
12154 IPv4 loopback address only:
12155 .code
12156 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
12157 .endd
12158 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
12159 .code
12160 local_interfaces = 192.168.34.67 : 192.168.34.67
12161 .endd
12162 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
12163
12164
12165
12166 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
12167 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
12168 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
12169 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
12170 treated as local.
12171
12172 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
12173 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
12174 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
12175 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
12176
12177 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
12178 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
12179 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
12180 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
12181 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
12182 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
12183 used for listening. Consider this example:
12184 .code
12185 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
12186 192.168.53.235 ; \
12187 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
12188
12189 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12190 .endd
12191 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
12192 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
12193 Exim is routing.
12194
12195 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
12196 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
12197 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
12198 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
12199 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
12200 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
12201 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
12202 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
12203
12204
12205
12206 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
12207 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
12208 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
12209 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
12210 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
12211 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
12212 details.
12213
12214
12215
12216
12217 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12218 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12219
12220 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
12221 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
12222 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
12223 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
12224
12225 .ilist
12226 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
12227 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
12228 .next
12229 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
12230 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
12231 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
12232 .next
12233 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
12234 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
12235 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
12236 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
12237 settings.
12238 .endlist
12239
12240 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
12241 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
12242 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
12243 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
12244 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
12245 listed in more than one group.
12246
12247 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
12248 .table2
12249 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
12250 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12251 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
12252 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
12253 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
12254 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
12255 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
12256 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
12257 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
12258 .endtable
12259
12260
12261 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
12262 .table2
12263 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
12264 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12265 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
12266 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
12267 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
12268 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
12269 .endtable
12270
12271
12272
12273 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
12274 .table2
12275 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
12276 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
12277 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
12278 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12279 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12280 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
12281 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
12282 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
12283 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
12284 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
12285 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
12286 .endtable
12287
12288
12289
12290 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
12291 .table2
12292 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
12293 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12294 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
12295 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
12296 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
12297 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
12298 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
12299 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
12300 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
12301 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
12302 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
12303 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
12304 .endtable
12305
12306
12307
12308 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
12309 .table2
12310 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
12311 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
12312 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
12313 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
12314 .endtable
12315
12316
12317
12318 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
12319 .table2
12320 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
12321 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
12322 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
12323 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
12324 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
12325 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
12326 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
12327 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
12328 .endtable
12329
12330
12331
12332 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
12333 .table2
12334 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
12335 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
12336 .endtable
12337
12338
12339
12340 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
12341 .table2
12342 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
12343 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
12344 .endtable
12345
12346
12347
12348 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
12349 .table2
12350 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
12351 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
12352 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
12353 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
12354 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
12355 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12356 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12357 .endtable
12358
12359
12360
12361 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
12362 .table2
12363 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12364 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
12365 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12366 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
12367 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
12368 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
12369 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12370 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12371 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12372 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12373 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12374 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12375 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12376 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12377 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12378 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12379 connection"
12380 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12381 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12382 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12383 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
12384 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12385 .endtable
12386
12387
12388
12389 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
12390 .table2
12391 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
12392 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
12393 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
12394 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
12395 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
12396 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
12397 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
12398 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
12399 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
12400 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
12401 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
12402 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
12403 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
12404 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
12405 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
12406 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
12407 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
12408 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
12409 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
12410 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12411 words""&"
12412 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
12413 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
12414 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12415 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12416 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
12417 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
12418 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
12419 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
12420 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
12421 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12422 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12423 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
12424 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
12425 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
12426 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
12427 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12428 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
12429 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
12430 .endtable
12431
12432
12433
12434 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
12435 .table2
12436 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
12437 item"
12438 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
12439 item"
12440 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
12441 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
12442 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
12443 .endtable
12444
12445
12446
12447 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
12448 .table2
12449 .row &%gnutls_require_kx%& "control GnuTLS key exchanges"
12450 .row &%gnutls_require_mac%& "control GnuTLS MAC algorithms"
12451 .row &%gnutls_require_protocols%& "control GnuTLS protocols"
12452 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
12453 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
12454 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12455 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
12456 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
12457 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
12458 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
12459 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
12460 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
12461 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
12462 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
12463 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
12464 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
12465 .endtable
12466
12467
12468
12469 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
12470 .table2
12471 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
12472 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
12473 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
12474 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
12475 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
12476 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
12477 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
12478 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
12479 .endtable
12480
12481
12482
12483 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
12484 .table2
12485 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12486 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12487 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
12488 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12489 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
12490 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
12491 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
12492 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
12493 .endtable
12494
12495
12496
12497
12498 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
12499 .table2
12500 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
12501 .endtable
12502
12503
12504
12505
12506
12507 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
12508 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
12509
12510 .table2
12511 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12512 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12513 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
12514 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
12515 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
12516 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
12517 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
12518 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12519 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12520 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12521 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12522 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12523 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12524 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12525 connection"
12526 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12527 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
12528 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
12529 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12530 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12531 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
12532 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
12533 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
12534 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
12535 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
12536 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
12537 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
12538 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
12539 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
12540 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12541 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
12542 .endtable
12543
12544
12545
12546 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
12547 .table2
12548 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
12549 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
12550 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
12551 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
12552 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
12553 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12554 .endtable
12555
12556
12557
12558 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
12559 .table2
12560 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
12561 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
12562 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
12563 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12564 words""&"
12565 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12566 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12567 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
12568 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
12569 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
12570 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
12571 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12572 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
12573 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
12574 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
12575 .endtable
12576
12577
12578
12579 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
12580 .table2
12581 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
12582 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
12583 directory"
12584 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
12585 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
12586 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
12587 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
12588 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
12589 .endtable
12590
12591
12592
12593 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
12594 .table2
12595 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12596 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
12597 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
12598 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
12599 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
12600 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
12601 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
12602 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
12603 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
12604 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
12605 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
12606 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
12607 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12608 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
12609 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
12610 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
12611 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
12612 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12613 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
12614 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
12615 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
12616 .endtable
12617
12618
12619
12620 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
12621 .table2
12622 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
12623 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
12624 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
12625 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
12626 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
12627 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
12628 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
12629 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
12630 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
12631 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
12632 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
12633 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
12634 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
12635 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
12636 .endtable
12637
12638
12639
12640 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
12641 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
12642 &dagger;.
12643
12644 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean false
12645 .cindex "8BITMIME"
12646 .cindex "8-bit characters"
12647 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
12648 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
12649 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
12650 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
12651 Consequently, this option is turned off by default.
12652
12653 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
12654 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
12655 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
12656 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
12657 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
12658 further details.
12659
12660 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
12661 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
12662 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
12663 SMTP messages.
12664
12665 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
12666 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
12667 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
12668 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
12669 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12670
12671 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
12672 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
12673 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
12674 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
12675 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12676
12677 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
12678 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
12679 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
12680 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12681
12682 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
12683 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
12684 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
12685 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
12686 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12687
12688 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
12689 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
12690 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
12691 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12692
12693 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
12694 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
12695 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
12696 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12697
12698 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
12699 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
12700 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
12701 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
12702 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12703
12704
12705 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
12706 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
12707 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
12708 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12709
12710 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
12711 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
12712 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
12713 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
12714 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
12715
12716 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
12717 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
12718 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
12719 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
12720 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
12721
12722 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
12723 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
12724 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
12725 further details.
12726
12727 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
12728 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
12729 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
12730 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12731
12732 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
12733 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
12734 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
12735 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12736
12737 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
12738 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
12739 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
12740 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12741
12742 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
12743 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
12744 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
12745 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12746
12747 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
12748 .cindex "admin user"
12749 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
12750 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
12751 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
12752 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
12753 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
12754 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
12755 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
12756
12757 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
12758 .cindex "domain literal"
12759 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
12760 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
12761 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
12762 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
12763
12764 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
12765 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
12766 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
12767 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
12768 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
12769 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
12770 the local host's IP addresses.
12771
12772
12773 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
12774 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
12775 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
12776 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
12777 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
12778 that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
12779 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
12780 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
12781 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
12782
12783 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
12784 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
12785 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
12786 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
12787 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
12788 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
12789 experiment if they wish.
12790
12791 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
12792 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
12793 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
12794 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
12795 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
12796 suitable setting is:
12797 .code
12798 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
12799 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
12800 .endd
12801 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
12802 .code
12803 dns_check_names_pattern =
12804 .endd
12805 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
12806
12807
12808 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
12809 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
12810 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
12811 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
12812 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
12813 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
12814 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
12815 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
12816 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
12817 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
12818 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
12819
12820 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
12821 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
12822 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
12823 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
12824 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
12825 which Exim advertises AUTH.
12826
12827 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
12828 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
12829 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
12830 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
12831 .code
12832 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{}{*}}
12833 .endd
12834 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12835 If &$tls_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
12836 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
12837 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
12838
12839
12840 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
12841 .cindex "thawing messages"
12842 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
12843 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
12844 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
12845 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
12846 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
12847 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
12848
12849 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
12850 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
12851 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
12852
12853 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
12854 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
12855 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
12856 .code
12857 sophie:/var/run/sophie
12858 .endd
12859 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
12860 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
12861
12862
12863
12864 .option bi_command main string unset
12865 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
12866 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
12867 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
12868 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
12869 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
12870
12871
12872 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
12873 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
12874 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
12875 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
12876 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
12877 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
12878
12879
12880 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
12881 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
12882 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
12883 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
12884
12885 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
12886 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
12887 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
12888 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
12889 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
12890 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
12891 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
12892 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
12893 point at which the error was detected are returned.
12894 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
12895
12896 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
12897 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
12898 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
12899 &%bounce_return_body%&.
12900
12901
12902 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
12903 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
12904 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
12905 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
12906 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
12907 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
12908 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
12909 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
12910 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
12911
12912 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
12913 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
12914 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
12915 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
12916 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
12917 messages.
12918
12919 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
12920 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
12921 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
12922 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
12923 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
12924 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
12925 connection. A typical setting might be:
12926 .code
12927 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
12928 .endd
12929 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
12930 .code
12931 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
12932 .endd
12933 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
12934 address.
12935
12936 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
12937 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
12938 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
12939 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
12940 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12941 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12942
12943
12944 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
12945 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
12946 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12947 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12948
12949
12950 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
12951 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
12952 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12953 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12954
12955
12956 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
12957 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
12958 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12959 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12960
12961
12962 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
12963 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
12964 callout verification. The default value is
12965 .code
12966 $primary_host_name-$tod_epoch-testing
12967 .endd
12968 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
12969
12970
12971 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
12972 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
12973
12974
12975 .option check_log_space main integer 0
12976 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
12977
12978 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
12979 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
12980 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
12981 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
12982 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
12983 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
12984 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
12985 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
12986 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
12987 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
12988
12989
12990 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
12991 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
12992
12993
12994 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
12995 .cindex "checking disk space"
12996 .cindex "disk space, checking"
12997 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
12998 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
12999 message is accepted.
13000
13001 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
13002 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
13003 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13004 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13005 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
13006 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
13007 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
13008 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
13009
13010
13011 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
13012 either value is greater than zero, for example:
13013 .code
13014 check_spool_space = 10M
13015 check_spool_inodes = 100
13016 .endd
13017 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
13018 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
13019 transit.
13020
13021 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
13022 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
13023 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
13024
13025 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
13026 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
13027 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
13028 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
13029 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
13030 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
13031
13032 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
13033 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
13034
13035 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
13036 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
13037 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
13038
13039 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
13040 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
13041 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13042 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
13043 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
13044 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
13045
13046 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
13047 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
13048 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
13049 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
13050 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
13051 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
13052 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
13053
13054 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
13055 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
13056
13057 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
13058 .cindex "warning of delay"
13059 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
13060 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
13061 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
13062 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
13063 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
13064 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
13065 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
13066 with
13067 .code
13068 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
13069 .endd
13070 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
13071 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
13072 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
13073 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
13074 .code
13075 delay_warning = 6h
13076 .endd
13077 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
13078 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
13079 .code
13080 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
13081 .endd
13082
13083 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
13084 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13085 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
13086 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
13087 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
13088 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
13089 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
13090 not sent. The default is:
13091 .code
13092 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
13093 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
13094 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
13095 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
13096 } {no}{yes}}
13097 .endd
13098 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
13099 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
13100 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
13101 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
13102
13103 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
13104 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
13105 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
13106 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
13107 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
13108 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
13109 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
13110 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
13111
13112 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
13113 .cindex "load average"
13114 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
13115 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
13116 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
13117 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
13118 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
13119
13120
13121 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
13122 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
13123 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
13124 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13125 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
13126 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
13127 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
13128 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13129
13130 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
13131 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
13132 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
13133 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
13134 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
13135 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
13136 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
13137 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
13138
13139 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
13140 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
13141 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
13142 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
13143
13144
13145 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
13146 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13147 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13148 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13149 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
13150 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13151 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13152
13153
13154 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
13155 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
13156 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
13157 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
13158 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
13159 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
13160 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
13161 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
13162 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
13163 by a setting such as this:
13164 .code
13165 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
13166 .endd
13167 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
13168 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
13169 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
13170 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
13171 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
13172 options are applied after this global option.
13173
13174 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
13175 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
13176 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
13177 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
13178 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
13179 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
13180 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
13181 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
13182 value of this option. The default pattern is
13183 .code
13184 dns_check_names_pattern = \
13185 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
13186 .endd
13187 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
13188 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
13189 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
13190 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
13191 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
13192 empty string.
13193
13194 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
13195 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
13196 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13197
13198 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
13199 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
13200 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
13201 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13202
13203 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
13204 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
13205 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
13206 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
13207 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
13208 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
13209 domain matches this list.
13210
13211 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
13212 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
13213 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
13214
13215
13216 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
13217 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13218 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
13219 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
13220 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
13221 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
13222 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
13223 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
13224 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
13225 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
13226 to set in them.
13227
13228
13229 .option dns_retry main integer 0
13230 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
13231
13232
13233 .option drop_cr main boolean false
13234 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
13235 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
13236 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
13237
13238 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
13239 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
13240 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
13241 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
13242 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
13243 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
13244 .code
13245 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
13246 .endd
13247 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
13248 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
13249
13250 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
13251 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
13252 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
13253 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13254 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
13255 messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
13256 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
13257 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
13258 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13259
13260
13261 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
13262 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
13263 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
13264 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
13265 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
13266 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
13267 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
13268 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
13269 must be enclosed in double quotes.
13270
13271 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
13272 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
13273 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
13274 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
13275 are examined. For example:
13276 .code
13277 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
13278 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
13279 postmaster@mydomain.example
13280 .endd
13281 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13282 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
13283 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
13284 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
13285 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
13286 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
13287 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
13288
13289
13290 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
13291 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
13292 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
13293 .display
13294 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
13295 .endd
13296 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
13297 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
13298 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
13299 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
13300 overrides the default.
13301
13302 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
13303 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
13304 and warning messages. For example:
13305 .code
13306 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
13307 .endd
13308 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
13309 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
13310 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
13311 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
13312 not used.
13313
13314
13315 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
13316 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
13317 .cindex "Exim group"
13318 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13319 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
13320 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
13321 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
13322 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
13323 security issues.
13324
13325
13326 .option exim_path main string "see below"
13327 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
13328 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
13329 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
13330 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
13331 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
13332 other place.
13333 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
13334 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
13335 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
13336 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
13337
13338
13339 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
13340 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
13341 .cindex "Exim user"
13342 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13343 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
13344 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
13345 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
13346
13347 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
13348 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
13349 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
13350 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
13351
13352
13353 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
13354 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
13355 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
13356 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
13357
13358
13359 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
13360 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
13361
13362 .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
13363 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
13364 .oindex "&%-t%&"
13365 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
13366 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
13367 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
13368 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
13369 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
13370 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
13371 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
13372 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
13373 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
13374 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
13375 addresses.
13376
13377
13378 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
13379 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
13380 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
13381 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
13382 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
13383 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
13384 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
13385 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
13386 retries.
13387
13388 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
13389 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
13390 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
13391 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
13392
13393
13394
13395 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
13396 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
13397 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
13398 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
13399 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
13400 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
13401 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
13402 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
13403 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
13404 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
13405 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
13406 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
13407 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
13408 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
13409 logging that you require.
13410
13411
13412 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
13413 .cindex "HP-UX"
13414 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
13415 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
13416 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
13417 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
13418 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
13419 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
13420 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
13421 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
13422
13423 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
13424 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
13425 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
13426 user's name.
13427
13428 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
13429 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
13430 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
13431 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
13432 .code
13433 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
13434 gecos_name = $1
13435 .endd
13436
13437 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
13438 See &%gecos_name%& above.
13439
13440
13441 .option gnutls_require_kx main string unset
13442 This option controls the key exchange mechanisms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
13443 server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
13444
13445 .option gnutls_require_mac main string unset
13446 This option controls the MAC algorithms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
13447 server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
13448
13449 .option gnutls_require_protocols main string unset
13450 This option controls the protocols when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
13451 server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
13452
13453 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
13454 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
13455 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
13456 implementations of TLS.
13457
13458 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
13459 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
13460 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
13461 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
13462 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
13463 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
13464
13465
13466
13467 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
13468 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
13469 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
13470 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
13471 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
13472 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
13473 sections are rejected.
13474
13475
13476 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
13477 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
13478 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
13479 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
13480 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
13481 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
13482 zero means &"no limit"&.
13483
13484
13485
13486
13487 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13488 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
13489 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
13490 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
13491 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
13492 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
13493 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
13494 if you want to do semantic checking.
13495 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
13496 set.
13497
13498
13499 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
13500 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
13501 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
13502 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
13503 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
13504 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
13505 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
13506 .code
13507 helo_allow_chars = _
13508 .endd
13509 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
13510
13511
13512 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
13513 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13514 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13515 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
13516 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
13517 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
13518 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
13519 do.
13520
13521
13522 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13523 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
13524 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
13525 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
13526 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
13527 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
13528 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
13529 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
13530 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
13531 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
13532 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
13533 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
13534
13535 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
13536 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
13537 EHLO command either:
13538
13539 .ilist
13540 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
13541 .next
13542 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13543 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13544 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
13545 calling host address, or
13546 .next
13547 when looked up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when
13548 available) yields the calling host address.
13549 .endlist
13550
13551 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
13552 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
13553 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
13554
13555 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13556 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
13557 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
13558 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
13559 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
13560 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
13561 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
13562 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
13563 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
13564 error.
13565
13566 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
13567 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
13568 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
13569 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
13570 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
13571 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
13572 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
13573 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
13574 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
13575
13576 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
13577 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
13578 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
13579 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
13580 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
13581
13582 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
13583 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
13584 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
13585 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
13586
13587
13588 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
13589 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
13590 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
13591 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
13592 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
13593 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
13594 default configuration file contains
13595 .code
13596 host_lookup = *
13597 .endd
13598 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
13599 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
13600
13601 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
13602 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
13603 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
13604
13605 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13606 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13607 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
13608 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
13609 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
13610 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
13611
13612
13613 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
13614 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
13615 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
13616 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
13617 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
13618 if you want.
13619
13620 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
13621 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
13622 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
13623 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
13624
13625
13626
13627 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
13628 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
13629 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
13630 as soon as the connection is made.
13631 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
13632 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
13633 connections immediately.
13634
13635 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
13636 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
13637 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
13638 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
13639 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
13640
13641
13642 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
13643 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
13644 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
13645 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
13646 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
13647 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
13648 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
13649 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
13650 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
13651 .code
13652 hosts_connection_nolog = :
13653 .endd
13654 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
13655
13656
13657
13658 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
13659 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
13660 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
13661 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
13662 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
13663 records
13664 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
13665 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
13666
13667 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
13668 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
13669 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
13670 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
13671 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
13672 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
13673 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
13674
13675
13676 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
13677 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
13678 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
13679 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
13680 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
13681
13682
13683
13684 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
13685 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
13686 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
13687 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
13688 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
13689 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
13690
13691 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
13692 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
13693 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
13694 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
13695 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
13696 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
13697 for frozen messages. For example,
13698 .code
13699 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
13700 .endd
13701 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
13702 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
13703 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
13704 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
13705 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
13706 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
13707
13708
13709 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13710 .cindex "&""From""& line"
13711 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
13712 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
13713 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
13714 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
13715 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
13716 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
13717 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
13718 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
13719
13720
13721 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
13722 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
13723
13724
13725 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
13726 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
13727 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
13728 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
13729 logged.
13730
13731
13732 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
13733 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
13734 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
13735 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
13736 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
13737 with LDAP support.
13738
13739
13740 .option ldap_version main integer unset
13741 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
13742 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
13743 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
13744 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
13745 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
13746 has been built with LDAP support.
13747
13748
13749
13750 .option local_from_check main boolean true
13751 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
13752 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
13753 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
13754 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
13755 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
13756 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
13757
13758 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
13759 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
13760 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
13761
13762 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
13763 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
13764 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
13765 and the default qualify domain.
13766
13767 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
13768 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
13769 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
13770 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
13771
13772 .cindex "envelope sender"
13773 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
13774 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
13775 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
13776
13777 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
13778 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
13779 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
13780
13781
13782
13783
13784 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
13785 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
13786 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
13787 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
13788 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
13789 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
13790 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
13791 example, if
13792 .code
13793 local_from_prefix = *-
13794 .endd
13795 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
13796 .code
13797 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
13798 .endd
13799 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
13800 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
13801 qualify domain.
13802
13803
13804 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
13805 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
13806
13807
13808 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
13809 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
13810 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
13811 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
13812 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
13813 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
13814 &%local_interfaces%& is
13815 .code
13816 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13817 .endd
13818 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
13819 .code
13820 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13821 .endd
13822
13823 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
13824 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
13825 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
13826 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
13827 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
13828 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
13829 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
13830 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
13831
13832
13833
13834 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
13835 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
13836 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
13837 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
13838 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
13839 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
13840 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
13841 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
13842
13843
13844
13845
13846 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
13847 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
13848 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
13849 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
13850 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
13851 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
13852 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
13853 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
13854 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
13855 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
13856 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
13857 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
13858 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
13859 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
13860 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
13861
13862
13863
13864 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
13865 .cindex "log" "file path for"
13866 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
13867 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
13868 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
13869 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time, they
13870 are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
13871 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
13872 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
13873 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
13874 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
13875 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
13876 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
13877 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
13878
13879
13880 .option log_selector main string unset
13881 .cindex "log" "selectors"
13882 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
13883 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
13884 minus characters. For example:
13885 .code
13886 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
13887 .endd
13888 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
13889 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
13890
13891
13892 .option log_timezone main boolean false
13893 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
13894 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13895 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13896 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
13897 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
13898 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
13899 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
13900 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
13901 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
13902 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
13903 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
13904 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
13905
13906
13907 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
13908 .cindex "too many open files"
13909 .cindex "open files, too many"
13910 .cindex "file" "too many open"
13911 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
13912 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
13913 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
13914 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
13915 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
13916 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
13917 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
13918 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
13919 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
13920 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
13921 &%lookup_open_max%&.
13922
13923
13924 .option max_username_length main integer 0
13925 .cindex "length of login name"
13926 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
13927 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
13928 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
13929 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
13930 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
13931 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
13932
13933
13934 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
13935 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
13936 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
13937 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
13938 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
13939 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
13940 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
13941 option is set true, this no longer happens.
13942
13943
13944 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
13945 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
13946 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
13947 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
13948 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
13949 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
13950 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
13951
13952
13953 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
13954 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
13955 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
13956 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
13957 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
13958 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
13959 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
13960 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
13961 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
13962 empty string, the option is ignored.
13963
13964
13965 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
13966 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
13967 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
13968 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
13969 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
13970 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
13971 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
13972 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
13973 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
13974 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
13975 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
13976 colons will become hyphens.
13977
13978
13979 .option message_logs main boolean true
13980 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
13981 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
13982 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
13983 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
13984 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
13985 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
13986 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
13987 which is not affected by this option.
13988
13989
13990 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
13991 .cindex "message" "size limit"
13992 .cindex "limit" "message size"
13993 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
13994 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
13995 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
13996 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
13997 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
13998 optionally followed by K or M.
13999
14000 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
14001 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
14002 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
14003 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
14004 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
14005
14006 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
14007 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
14008 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
14009 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
14010 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
14011 message that an individual transport can process.
14012
14013 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
14014 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
14015 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
14016 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
14017 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. Eg, with a
14018 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
14019 some problems may result.
14020
14021
14022 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
14023 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
14024 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
14025 .code
14026 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
14027 .endd
14028 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
14029 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
14030 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
14031 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
14032 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
14033
14034
14035 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
14036 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
14037 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
14038 contains a full description of this facility.
14039
14040
14041
14042 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
14043 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
14044 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
14045 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
14046 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
14047
14048
14049 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
14050 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
14051 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
14052 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
14053 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
14054 safety precaution.
14055
14056 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
14057 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
14058 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
14059 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
14060 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
14061
14062 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
14063 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
14064 example is
14065 .code
14066 never_users = root:daemon:bin
14067 .endd
14068 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
14069 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
14070 transport driver.
14071
14072
14073 .option openssl_options main "string list" +dont_insert_empty_fragments
14074 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
14075 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
14076 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
14077 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value. The default
14078 value is one option which happens to have been set historically. You can
14079 remove all options with:
14080 .code
14081 openssl_options = -all
14082 .endd
14083 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
14084 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
14085 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
14086 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
14087 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
14088 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
14089 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
14090
14091 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
14092 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
14093 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
14094 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at by invoking Exim
14095 with the &%-bV%& flag.
14096
14097 An example:
14098 .code
14099 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer
14100 .endd
14101
14102
14103 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
14104 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
14105 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
14106 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14107 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
14108
14109
14110 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14111 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
14112 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
14113 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
14114 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
14115 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
14116 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
14117 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
14118 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
14119 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
14120 an ACL.
14121
14122 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
14123 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
14124 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
14125 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
14126 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
14127 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
14128 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
14129
14130
14131 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
14132 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14133 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14134
14135
14136 .option perl_startup main string unset
14137 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14138 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14139
14140
14141 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
14142 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
14143 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
14144 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
14145 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
14146 PostgreSQL support.
14147
14148
14149 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
14150 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
14151 .cindex "pid file, path for"
14152 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
14153 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
14154 to the host name:
14155 .code
14156 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
14157 .endd
14158 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
14159 spool directory.
14160 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
14161 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
14162 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
14163
14164
14165 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14166 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
14167 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
14168 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
14169 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
14170 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
14171 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
14172 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
14173 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
14174
14175
14176 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
14177 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
14178 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
14179 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
14180 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
14181 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
14182 volume of mail. Use with care!
14183
14184
14185 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
14186 .cindex "name" "of local host"
14187 .cindex "host" "name of local"
14188 .cindex "local host" "name of"
14189 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
14190 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
14191 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
14192 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
14193 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
14194 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
14195
14196 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
14197 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
14198 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
14199 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
14200 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
14201 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
14202
14203
14204 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
14205 .cindex "printing characters"
14206 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14207 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
14208 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
14209 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
14210 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
14211 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
14212 characters.
14213
14214 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
14215 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
14216 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
14217 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
14218 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
14219 standards.
14220
14221
14222 .option process_log_path main string unset
14223 .cindex "process log path"
14224 .cindex "log" "process log"
14225 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
14226 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
14227 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
14228 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
14229 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
14230 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
14231 different spool directories.
14232
14233
14234 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
14235 .oindex "&%-M%&"
14236 .oindex "&%-R%&"
14237 .oindex "&%-q%&"
14238 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
14239 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
14240 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
14241
14242
14243 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
14244 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
14245 .cindex "address" "qualification"
14246 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
14247 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
14248 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
14249 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
14250 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
14251 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14252
14253 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
14254 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
14255 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
14256 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
14257 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
14258 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
14259 &%primary_hostname%& value.
14260
14261
14262 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
14263 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
14264 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
14265
14266
14267
14268 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14269 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
14270 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14271 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
14272 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
14273 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
14274 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
14275 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
14276
14277
14278 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
14279 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
14280 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
14281 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
14282 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
14283
14284
14285 .option queue_only main boolean false
14286 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14287 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
14288 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
14289 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
14290 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
14291 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
14292
14293 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
14294 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
14295 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
14296 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
14297
14298
14299 .option queue_only_file main string unset
14300 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14301 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
14302 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
14303 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
14304 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
14305 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
14306 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
14307 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
14308 .code
14309 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
14310 .endd
14311 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
14312 &_/some/file_& exists.
14313
14314
14315 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
14316 .cindex "load average"
14317 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14318 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
14319 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
14320 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
14321 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
14322 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
14323 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14324 false.
14325
14326 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
14327 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
14328 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
14329 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14330
14331
14332 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
14333 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
14334 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
14335 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
14336 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
14337 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
14338 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
14339 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
14340 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
14341 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14342 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
14343 re-evaluated for each message.
14344
14345
14346 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
14347 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14348 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
14349 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
14350 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
14351 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
14352
14353
14354 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
14355 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
14356 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
14357 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
14358 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
14359 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
14360 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
14361 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
14362 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
14363 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
14364 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
14365 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
14366 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
14367
14368
14369
14370 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
14371 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
14372 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
14373 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
14374 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
14375 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
14376 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
14377 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
14378 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
14379
14380 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
14381 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
14382 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
14383 the daemon's command line.
14384
14385 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14386 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14387 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
14388 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
14389 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
14390 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
14391 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
14392 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
14393 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
14394 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
14395 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
14396 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
14397 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
14398 &%queue_domains%&.
14399
14400
14401 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
14402 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
14403 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
14404 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
14405 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
14406 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
14407 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
14408
14409 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
14410 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
14411 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
14412 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
14413 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
14414 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
14415 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
14416 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
14417 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
14418 header lines. The default setting is:
14419
14420 .code
14421 received_header_text = Received: \
14422 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
14423 {${if def:sender_ident \
14424 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
14425 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
14426 by $primary_hostname \
14427 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
14428 ${if def:tls_cipher {($tls_cipher)\n\t}}\
14429 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
14430 ${if def:sender_address \
14431 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
14432 id $message_exim_id\
14433 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
14434 .endd
14435
14436 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
14437 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
14438 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
14439 header lines such as the following:
14440 .code
14441 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
14442 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
14443 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
14444 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
14445 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
14446 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
14447 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
14448 .endd
14449 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
14450 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
14451 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
14452 message was accepted.
14453
14454
14455 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
14456 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
14457 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
14458 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
14459 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
14460 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
14461 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
14462 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
14463
14464
14465 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14466 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
14467 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
14468 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
14469 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
14470 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
14471 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
14472 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
14473 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
14474 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
14475 option was not set.
14476
14477
14478 .option recipients_max main integer 0
14479 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
14480 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
14481 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
14482 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
14483 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
14484 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
14485 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
14486 done.
14487
14488 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
14489 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
14490 RCPT commands in a single message.
14491
14492
14493 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
14494 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
14495 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
14496 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
14497 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
14498 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
14499 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
14500
14501
14502 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
14503 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
14504 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
14505 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
14506 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
14507 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
14508 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
14509 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
14510 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
14511 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
14512 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
14513 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
14514 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
14515 tagged with its process id.
14516
14517 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
14518 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
14519 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
14520 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
14521 is received.
14522
14523 .cindex "number of deliveries"
14524 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
14525 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
14526 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
14527 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
14528 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
14529 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
14530 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
14531 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
14532 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
14533 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
14534
14535 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
14536 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
14537 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
14538 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
14539
14540
14541 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14542 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
14543 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
14544 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
14545 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
14546 .code
14547 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
14548 .endd
14549 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
14550 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
14551
14552
14553 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
14554 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
14555 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
14556 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
14557 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
14558 past failures.
14559
14560
14561 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
14562 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
14563 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
14564 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
14565 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
14566 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
14567 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
14568 the default value.
14569
14570
14571 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
14572 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
14573 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
14574 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
14575 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
14576 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
14577 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
14578 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
14579 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
14580 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
14581
14582
14583 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
14584 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
14585
14586
14587 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14588 .cindex "RFC 1413"
14589 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
14590 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches an item
14591 in the list.
14592
14593 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 5s
14594 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
14595 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
14596 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
14597 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
14598
14599
14600 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14601 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
14602 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
14603 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
14604 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
14605 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
14606 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
14607 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
14608 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
14609 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
14610
14611
14612 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
14613 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
14614 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
14615 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
14616 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
14617 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
14618 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
14619 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
14620 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
14621 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
14622 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
14623
14624
14625
14626 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
14627 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
14628 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
14629 .cindex "inetd"
14630 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
14631 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
14632 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
14633 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
14634 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
14635 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14636
14637 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
14638 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
14639 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
14640 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
14641
14642
14643 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
14644 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
14645 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
14646 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
14647 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
14648 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
14649 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
14650 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
14651
14652 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
14653 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
14654 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
14655 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
14656 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
14657 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
14658 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
14659 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
14660
14661
14662 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14663 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
14664 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
14665 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
14666 live with.
14667
14668
14669 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14670 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14671
14672 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 1000 &&&
14673 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
14674 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
14675 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
14676 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
14677 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
14678 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
14679 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
14680 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
14681 seen).
14682
14683
14684 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
14685 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
14686 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
14687 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
14688 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
14689 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
14690 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
14691 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
14692 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
14693 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
14694 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
14695
14696 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
14697 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
14698 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
14699 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
14700 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
14701 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
14702
14703
14704
14705 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
14706 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
14707 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14708 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
14709 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
14710 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
14711 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
14712 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
14713 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
14714 to all messages received in the same connection.
14715
14716 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
14717 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
14718 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
14719 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
14720
14721
14722 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14723 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14724
14725 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 10 &&&
14726 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
14727 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14728 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
14729 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
14730 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
14731 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
14732 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
14733 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
14734 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
14735 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
14736 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
14737 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
14738
14739
14740 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
14741 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
14742 .cindex "host" "reserved"
14743 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
14744 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
14745 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
14746 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
14747 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
14748 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
14749 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
14750 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
14751 individual host.
14752
14753 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
14754 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
14755 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
14756 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
14757
14758
14759 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
14760 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
14761 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
14762 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
14763 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
14764 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
14765 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
14766 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
14767 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
14768
14769 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
14770 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
14771 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
14772 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
14773
14774 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
14775 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
14776 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
14777 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
14778 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
14779 For example:
14780 .code
14781 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
14782 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
14783 .endd
14784
14785 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
14786 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
14787 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
14788 &%helo_data%& value.
14789
14790 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
14791 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
14792 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
14793 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
14794 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
14795 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
14796 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
14797 .code
14798 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
14799 $version_number $tod_full
14800 .endd
14801 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
14802 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
14803 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
14804 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
14805 multiline response).
14806
14807
14808 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
14809 .cindex "checking disk space"
14810 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14811 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14812 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
14813 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
14814 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
14815 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
14816 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
14817
14818
14819 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
14820 .cindex "connection backlog"
14821 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
14822 .cindex "backlog of connections"
14823 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
14824 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
14825 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
14826 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
14827 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
14828 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
14829 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
14830 attacks by SYN flooding.
14831
14832
14833 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
14834 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
14835 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
14836 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
14837 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
14838 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
14839 fewer, but they still exist.
14840
14841 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
14842 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
14843 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
14844 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
14845 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
14846 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
14847 does detect many instances.
14848
14849 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
14850 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
14851 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
14852 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
14853
14854
14855
14856 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
14857 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
14858 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14859 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
14860 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
14861 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
14862 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
14863 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
14864 example:
14865 .code
14866 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
14867 $sender_host_address
14868 .endd
14869 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
14870 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
14871 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
14872 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
14873 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
14874 the command.
14875
14876
14877 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
14878 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
14879 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
14880 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
14881 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
14882
14883
14884 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
14885 .cindex "load average"
14886 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
14887 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
14888 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
14889 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
14890 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
14891 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
14892
14893
14894
14895 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
14896 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
14897 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
14898 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
14899 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
14900 .code
14901 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
14902 .endd
14903 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
14904 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
14905 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
14906 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
14907 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
14908
14909 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
14910 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
14911 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
14912 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
14913 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
14914 not count towards the limit.
14915
14916
14917
14918 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
14919 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
14920 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
14921 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
14922 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
14923 that subvert web
14924 clients
14925 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
14926 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
14927
14928
14929
14930 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14931 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
14932 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
14933 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
14934 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
14935 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
14936 recipients.
14937
14938 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
14939 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
14940 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
14941 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
14942
14943 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
14944 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
14945 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
14946 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
14947 values:
14948
14949 .ilist
14950 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
14951 .next
14952 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
14953 fractional parts are allowed here.
14954 .next
14955 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
14956 .next
14957 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
14958 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
14959 .endlist
14960
14961 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
14962 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
14963 .code
14964 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
14965 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
14966 .endd
14967 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
14968 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
14969 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
14970 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
14971
14972
14973 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
14974 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
14975
14976
14977 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
14978 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
14979
14980
14981 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time 5m
14982 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
14983 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
14984 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
14985 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
14986 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
14987 the message is abandoned.
14988 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
14989 .code
14990 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
14991 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
14992 .endd
14993 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
14994 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
14995
14996
14997 .oindex "&%-os%&"
14998 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
14999 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
15000 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
15001 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
15002 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
15003
15004
15005 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15006 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
15007 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
15008
15009
15010 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
15011 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
15012 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
15013 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
15014 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
15015 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
15016 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
15017 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
15018 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
15019 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
15020 .code
15021 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
15022 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
15023 .endd
15024
15025 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
15026 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
15027 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
15028 The default value is
15029 .code
15030 127.0.0.1 783
15031 .endd
15032 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
15033
15034
15035
15036 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
15037 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
15038 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
15039 .cindex "directories, multiple"
15040 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
15041 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
15042 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
15043 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
15044 arrival of the message.
15045
15046 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
15047 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
15048 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
15049 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
15050 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
15051
15052 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
15053 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
15054 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
15055 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
15056 automatically deleted.
15057
15058 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
15059 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
15060 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
15061 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
15062 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
15063 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
15064 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
15065 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
15066 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
15067
15068
15069 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
15070 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
15071 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
15072 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
15073 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
15074 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
15075 &$primary_hostname$&.
15076
15077 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
15078 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
15079 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
15080 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
15081 as failures in the configuration file.
15082
15083 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
15084 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
15085
15086 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
15087 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
15088 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
15089 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
15090
15091 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
15092 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
15093 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
15094 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
15095 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
15096 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
15097
15098 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
15099 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
15100 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
15101 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
15102 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
15103 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
15104 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
15105
15106
15107 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
15108 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
15109 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
15110 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
15111 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
15112 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
15113 domain causes a syntax error.
15114 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
15115 syntax checking.
15116
15117
15118 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
15119 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
15120 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
15121 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
15122 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
15123 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
15124 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
15125 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
15126 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
15127 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
15128 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
15129 the LOG_ALERT priority.
15130
15131
15132 .option syslog_facility main string unset
15133 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
15134 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15135 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
15136 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
15137 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15138 details of Exim's logging.
15139
15140
15141
15142 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
15143 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
15144 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15145 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
15146 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
15147
15148
15149
15150 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
15151 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
15152 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
15153 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15154 details of Exim's logging.
15155
15156
15157 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
15158 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
15159 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
15160 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
15161 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
15162 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
15163 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
15164 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
15165 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
15166 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
15167 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
15168
15169
15170 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
15171 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
15172 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
15173 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
15174 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
15175 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15176
15177
15178 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
15179 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
15180 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
15181 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
15182 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15183
15184 .option system_filter_group main string unset
15185 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
15186 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
15187 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
15188 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
15189
15190 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
15191 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
15192 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
15193 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
15194 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
15195 contains the pipe command.
15196
15197
15198 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
15199 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
15200 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
15201 is used in a system filter.
15202
15203 .option system_filter_user main string unset
15204 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
15205 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
15206 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
15207 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
15208 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
15209 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
15210 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
15211 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
15212 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
15213
15214 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
15215 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
15216 transport option overrides.
15217
15218
15219 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
15220 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
15221 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
15222 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
15223 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
15224 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
15225 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
15226 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
15227 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
15228 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
15229 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
15230 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
15231 TCP_NODELAY.
15232
15233
15234 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
15235 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
15236 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
15237 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
15238 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
15239 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
15240 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
15241 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
15242 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
15243 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
15244
15245 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
15246 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
15247 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
15248
15249
15250 .option timezone main string unset
15251 .cindex "timezone, setting"
15252 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
15253 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
15254 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
15255 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
15256 .code
15257 timezone = UTC
15258 .endd
15259 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
15260 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
15261 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
15262 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
15263 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
15264 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
15265
15266
15267 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15268 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
15269 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
15270 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
15271 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
15272 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
15273 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
15274 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
15275
15276
15277 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
15278 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
15279 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
15280 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15281 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
15282 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
15283 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15284
15285 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
15286 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
15287 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
15288 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
15289
15290
15291 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
15292 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
15293 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
15294 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
15295 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
15296
15297
15298 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
15299 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
15300 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
15301 a file which contains the server's DH parameter values.
15302 This is used only for OpenSSL. When Exim is linked with GnuTLS, this option is
15303 ignored. See section &<<SECTopenvsgnu>>& for further details.
15304
15305
15306 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
15307 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
15308 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
15309 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
15310 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
15311
15312
15313
15314 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
15315 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
15316 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15317 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
15318 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
15319 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
15320 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15321
15322
15323 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
15324 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
15325 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
15326 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
15327 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
15328 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
15329 TLS session.
15330
15331
15332 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
15333 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
15334 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
15335 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
15336 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
15337 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
15338 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
15339 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
15340 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
15341 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
15342 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
15343
15344
15345 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15346 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15347 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15348 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
15349
15350
15351 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! unset
15352 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15353 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15354 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
15355 a file containing permitted certificates for clients that
15356 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. Alternatively, if you
15357 are using OpenSSL, you can set &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a
15358 directory containing certificate files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the
15359 option must be set to the name of a single file if you are using GnuTLS.
15360
15361
15362 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15363 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15364 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15365 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
15366 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
15367 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
15368 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
15369 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
15370
15371 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
15372 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
15373 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
15374 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
15375 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
15376 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
15377 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
15378
15379 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
15380 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
15381 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
15382 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
15383 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
15384 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
15385 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
15386 certificate"&.
15387
15388 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
15389 certificates.
15390
15391
15392 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
15393 .cindex "trusted groups"
15394 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
15395 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
15396 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
15397 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
15398 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
15399 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
15400 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
15401 are trusted.
15402
15403 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
15404 .cindex "trusted users"
15405 .cindex "user" "trusted"
15406 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
15407 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
15408 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
15409 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
15410 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
15411 Exim user are trusted.
15412
15413 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
15414 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
15415 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
15416 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
15417 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
15418 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
15419 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
15420 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
15421 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
15422 &%-F%& option.
15423
15424 .option unknown_username main string unset
15425 See &%unknown_login%&.
15426
15427 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
15428 .cindex "trusted users"
15429 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
15430 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
15431 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
15432 .cindex "envelope sender"
15433 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
15434 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
15435 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
15436 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
15437 is used) is ignored.
15438
15439 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
15440 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
15441 .code
15442 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
15443 .endd
15444 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
15445 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
15446 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
15447 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
15448 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
15449 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
15450 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
15451 followed by a hyphen
15452 by a setting like this:
15453 .code
15454 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
15455 .endd
15456 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
15457 restriction, you can use
15458 .code
15459 untrusted_set_sender = *
15460 .endd
15461 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
15462 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
15463 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
15464 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
15465 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
15466 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
15467 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
15468 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
15469
15470 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
15471 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
15472 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
15473 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
15474 sender address.
15475
15476
15477 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
15478 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15479 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15480 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
15481 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
15482 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
15483 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
15484 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
15485 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
15486 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
15487 .code
15488 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
15489 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
15490 .endd
15491 The pattern can be seen by running
15492 .code
15493 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
15494 .endd
15495 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
15496 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
15497 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
15498 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
15499 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
15500 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
15501
15502
15503 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
15504 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
15505
15506
15507 .option warn_message_file main string unset
15508 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
15509 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
15510 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
15511 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
15512 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
15513 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
15514 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
15515
15516
15517 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
15518 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
15519 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
15520 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
15521 .ecindex IIDconfima
15522 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
15523
15524
15525
15526
15527 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15528 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15529
15530 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
15531 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
15532 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
15533 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
15534 Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
15535
15536 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
15537 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
15538 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
15539 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
15540 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
15541
15542
15543
15544 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
15545 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
15546 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
15547 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
15548 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
15549 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
15550 delivery of the address to be deferred.
15551
15552 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
15553 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
15554 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
15555 routers, and the eventual transport.
15556
15557 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
15558 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
15559 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
15560 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
15561 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
15562
15563 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
15564 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
15565 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
15566 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
15567 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
15568
15569 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
15570 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
15571 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
15572 .code
15573 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
15574 .endd
15575 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
15576 .code
15577 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
15578 .endd
15579 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
15580 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
15581
15582 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
15583 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
15584 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
15585 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
15586 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
15587 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
15588 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
15589
15590
15591
15592 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
15593 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
15594 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
15595 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
15596 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
15597 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
15598 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
15599 routing.
15600
15601
15602
15603 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
15604 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
15605 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
15606 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
15607 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
15608 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
15609 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
15610 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
15611 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
15612 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
15613 you could put:
15614 .code
15615 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
15616 .endd
15617 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
15618 and
15619 .code
15620 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
15621 .endd
15622 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
15623 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
15624 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
15625 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
15626
15627
15628 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
15629 .cindex "case of local parts"
15630 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
15631 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
15632 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
15633 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
15634 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
15635 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
15636 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
15637 more details.
15638
15639 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
15640 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
15641 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
15642 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
15643 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
15644 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
15645 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
15646 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
15647 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
15648
15649 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
15650 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
15651 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
15652 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
15653
15654
15655
15656 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
15657 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
15658 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
15659 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
15660 .vindex "&$home$&"
15661 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
15662 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
15663 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
15664 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
15665 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
15666 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
15667 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
15668 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
15669 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
15670 the router is skipped.
15671
15672 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
15673 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
15674 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
15675 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
15676 setting to achieve this. For example:
15677 .code
15678 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
15679 .endd
15680 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
15681 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
15682 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
15683
15684
15685
15686 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
15687 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
15688 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
15689 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
15690 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
15691 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
15692 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
15693 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
15694
15695 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
15696 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
15697
15698 This option is unique in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
15699 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
15700
15701 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
15702 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
15703 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
15704 .code
15705 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
15706 .endd
15707 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
15708 .code
15709 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
15710 .endd
15711 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
15712 .code
15713 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
15714 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
15715 condition = foobar
15716 .endd
15717 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
15718 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
15719 be specified using &%condition%&.
15720
15721
15722
15723 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
15724 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
15725 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
15726 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
15727 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
15728 output, and Exim carries on processing.
15729 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
15730 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
15731 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
15732 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
15733 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
15734 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
15735
15736
15737
15738 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
15739 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
15740 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
15741 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
15742 transport option of the same name.
15743
15744
15745 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
15746 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
15747 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
15748 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
15749 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
15750 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
15751 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
15752 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
15753
15754
15755
15756 .option driver routers string unset
15757 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
15758 to be used.
15759
15760
15761
15762 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
15763 .cindex "envelope sender"
15764 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
15765 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
15766 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
15767 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
15768 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
15769 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
15770 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
15771
15772 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
15773 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
15774 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
15775 setting.
15776
15777 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
15778 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
15779 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
15780 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
15781
15782 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
15783 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
15784 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
15785 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
15786 settings:
15787 .code
15788 errors_to =
15789 errors_to = ""
15790 .endd
15791 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
15792 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
15793 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
15794 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
15795 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
15796
15797 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
15798 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
15799 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
15800 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
15801 setting &%return_path%&.
15802
15803 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
15804 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
15805 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
15806
15807
15808
15809 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
15810 .cindex "address" "testing"
15811 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
15812 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
15813 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
15814 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
15815 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
15816 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
15817 on for the system alias file.
15818 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
15819 are evaluated.
15820
15821 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
15822 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
15823 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
15824
15825
15826
15827 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
15828 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
15829 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
15830 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
15831
15832
15833
15834 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
15835 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
15836 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
15837
15838
15839
15840 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
15841 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
15842 verifying a sender, verification fails.
15843
15844
15845
15846 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
15847 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
15848 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
15849 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
15850 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
15851 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
15852 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
15853 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
15854 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
15855
15856 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
15857 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
15858 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
15859 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
15860 transport for further details.
15861
15862
15863 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
15864 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
15865 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
15866 .cindex "transport" "local"
15867 .cindex "router" "setting group"
15868 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
15869 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
15870 process.
15871 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
15872 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
15873 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
15874 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
15875 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
15876
15877
15878
15879 .option headers_add routers string&!! unset
15880 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
15881 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
15882 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
15883 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
15884 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
15885 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
15886 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
15887 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
15888 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
15889 &"see"& the added header lines.
15890
15891 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
15892 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If the expanded string is empty, or if
15893 the expansion is forced to fail, the option has no effect. Other expansion
15894 failures are treated as configuration errors.
15895
15896 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
15897 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
15898
15899 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
15900 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
15901 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
15902 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
15903 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
15904 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
15905 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
15906 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
15907 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
15908 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
15909
15910
15911
15912 .option headers_remove routers string&!! unset
15913 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
15914 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
15915 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
15916 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
15917 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
15918 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
15919 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
15920 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
15921 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
15922 &"see"& the original header lines.
15923
15924 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
15925 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If the expansion is forced to fail,
15926 the option has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
15927 errors.
15928
15929 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
15930 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
15931
15932 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
15933 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
15934 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
15935 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
15936
15937
15938 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
15939 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
15940 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
15941 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
15942 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
15943 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
15944 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
15945 like
15946 .code
15947 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
15948 .endd
15949 by setting
15950 .code
15951 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
15952 .endd
15953 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
15954 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
15955 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
15956 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
15957 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
15958 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
15959
15960 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
15961 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
15962 .code
15963 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
15964 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
15965 .endd
15966 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
15967 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
15968
15969 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
15970 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
15971 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
15972 domain that is being routed.
15973
15974 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
15975 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
15976 checked.
15977
15978 .option initgroups routers boolean false
15979 .cindex "additional groups"
15980 .cindex "groups" "additional"
15981 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
15982 .cindex "transport" "local"
15983 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
15984 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
15985 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
15986 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
15987 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
15988
15989
15990
15991 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
15992 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
15993 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
15994 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
15995 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
15996 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
15997 evaluated.
15998
15999 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
16000 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
16001 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
16002 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
16003 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
16004 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
16005 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
16006 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
16007 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
16008
16009 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
16010 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
16011 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
16012 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
16013 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
16014 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
16015 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
16016 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
16017 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
16018 the relevant transport.
16019
16020 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
16021 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
16022 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
16023 callout.
16024
16025 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
16026 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
16027 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
16028 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
16029 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
16030 .code
16031 real_localuser:
16032 driver = accept
16033 local_part_prefix = real-
16034 check_local_user
16035 transport = local_delivery
16036 .endd
16037 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
16038 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
16039 .code
16040 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
16041 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
16042 .endd
16043
16044 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
16045 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
16046 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
16047 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
16048
16049
16050 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
16051 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
16052
16053
16054
16055 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
16056 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
16057 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
16058 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
16059 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
16060 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
16061 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
16062 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
16063 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
16064 &%username-foo%&.
16065
16066
16067 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
16068 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
16069
16070
16071
16072 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
16073 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
16074 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
16075 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
16076 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16077 are evaluated, and
16078 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
16079 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
16080 example:
16081 .code
16082 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
16083 .endd
16084 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
16085 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
16086 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
16087 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
16088 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
16089 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
16090 each virtual domain:
16091 .code
16092 postmaster:
16093 driver = redirect
16094 local_parts = postmaster
16095 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
16096 .endd
16097
16098
16099 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
16100 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
16101 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
16102 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
16103 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
16104 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
16105 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
16106 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
16107 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
16108 redirect addresses.
16109
16110
16111
16112 .option more routers boolean&!! true
16113 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
16114 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
16115 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
16116 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
16117 delivery to be deferred.
16118
16119 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
16120 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
16121 .oindex "&%self%&"
16122 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
16123 means of the setting
16124 .code
16125 self = pass
16126 .endd
16127 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
16128 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
16129 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
16130
16131 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
16132 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
16133 controls what happens next.
16134
16135
16136 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
16137 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
16138 .cindex "router" "timeout"
16139 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
16140 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
16141 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
16142 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
16143 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
16144
16145 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
16146 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
16147 applies to all of them.
16148
16149
16150
16151 .option pass_router routers string unset
16152 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
16153 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
16154 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
16155 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
16156 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
16157 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
16158 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
16159 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
16160 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
16161 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
16162
16163
16164
16165 .option redirect_router routers string unset
16166 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
16167 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
16168 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
16169 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
16170 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
16171
16172 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
16173 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
16174 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
16175 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
16176
16177
16178
16179 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
16180 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
16181 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
16182 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
16183 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
16184 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
16185 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
16186
16187 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
16188 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
16189 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
16190 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
16191
16192 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
16193 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
16194 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
16195 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
16196 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
16197
16198 .cindex "NFS"
16199 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
16200 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
16201 unavailable.
16202
16203 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
16204 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
16205 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
16206 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
16207 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
16208 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
16209 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
16210 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
16211
16212 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
16213 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
16214 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
16215 operates as follows:
16216
16217 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
16218 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
16219 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
16220 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
16221 used. For example:
16222 .code
16223 require_files = mail:/some/file
16224 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
16225 .endd
16226 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
16227 &%require_files%& condition fails.
16228
16229 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
16230 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
16231 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
16232 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
16233
16234 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
16235 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
16236 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
16237 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
16238 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
16239
16240 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
16241 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
16242 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
16243 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
16244 check again in that process.
16245
16246 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
16247 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
16248 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
16249 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
16250 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
16251 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
16252 as if the file did not exist. For example:
16253 .code
16254 require_files = +/some/file
16255 .endd
16256 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
16257 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
16258 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
16259
16260
16261
16262 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
16263 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
16264 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
16265 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
16266 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
16267 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
16268 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
16269 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
16270 latter kind.
16271
16272 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
16273 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
16274 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
16275 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
16276 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
16277 same name.
16278
16279 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
16280 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
16281 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
16282
16283
16284
16285 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
16286 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
16287 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
16288 .vindex "&$home$&"
16289 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
16290 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
16291 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
16292 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
16293 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
16294 cause the router to defer.
16295
16296 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
16297 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
16298 place.
16299 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16300 are evaluated.)
16301 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
16302 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
16303
16304 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
16305 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
16306 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
16307 of these values that is set:
16308
16309 .ilist
16310 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
16311 .next
16312 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
16313 .next
16314 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
16315 .next
16316 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
16317 .endlist
16318
16319 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
16320 router, but not for the transport.
16321
16322
16323
16324 .option self routers string freeze
16325 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
16326 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
16327 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
16328 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
16329 and &(manualroute)& routers.
16330 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
16331 of remote hosts.
16332 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
16333 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
16334 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
16335 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
16336 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
16337
16338 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
16339 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
16340 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
16341 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
16342 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
16343 cases:
16344
16345 .vlist
16346 .vitem &%defer%&
16347 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
16348
16349 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
16350 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
16351 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
16352 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
16353
16354 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
16355 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
16356 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
16357 rewritten.
16358
16359 .vitem &%pass%&
16360 .oindex "&%more%&"
16361 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
16362 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
16363 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
16364 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
16365 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
16366 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
16367 combination
16368 .code
16369 self = pass
16370 no_more
16371 .endd
16372 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
16373 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
16374 be passed to the next router.
16375
16376 .vitem &%fail%&
16377 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
16378
16379 .vitem &%send%&
16380 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
16381 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
16382 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
16383 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
16384 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
16385 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
16386 .endlist
16387
16388
16389
16390 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
16391 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
16392 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
16393 address matches something on the list.
16394 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16395 are evaluated.
16396
16397 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
16398 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
16399 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
16400 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
16401 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
16402 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
16403 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
16404 matters.
16405
16406
16407 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
16408 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
16409 .cindex "packet radio"
16410 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
16411 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
16412 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
16413 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
16414 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
16415 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
16416 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
16417 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
16418
16419 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
16420 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
16421 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
16422 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
16423 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
16424 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
16425 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
16426 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
16427 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
16428 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
16429 .code
16430 translate_ip_address = \
16431 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
16432 {$value}fail}}
16433 .endd
16434 The file would contain lines like
16435 .code
16436 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
16437 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
16438 .endd
16439 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
16440 are doing.
16441
16442
16443
16444 .option transport routers string&!! unset
16445 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
16446 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
16447 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
16448 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
16449 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
16450 delivery is deferred.
16451
16452 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
16453 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
16454 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
16455
16456
16457
16458 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
16459 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
16460 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
16461 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
16462 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
16463 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
16464 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
16465 overridden by a setting on the transport.
16466 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
16467 logged, and delivery is deferred.
16468 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
16469 environment.
16470
16471
16472
16473
16474 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
16475 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
16476 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
16477 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
16478 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
16479 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
16480 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
16481 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
16482 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
16483 logged, and delivery is deferred.
16484
16485 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
16486 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
16487 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
16488 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
16489 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
16490
16491 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
16492 environment.
16493
16494
16495
16496
16497 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
16498 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
16499 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
16500 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
16501 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
16502 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
16503 delivery to be deferred.
16504
16505 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
16506 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
16507 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
16508 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
16509 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
16510 sometimes true and sometimes false).
16511
16512 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
16513 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
16514 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
16515 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
16516 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
16517 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
16518 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
16519 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
16520
16521 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
16522 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
16523 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
16524 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
16525 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
16526 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
16527 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
16528 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
16529 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
16530 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
16531
16532 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
16533 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
16534 subsequent routers.
16535
16536
16537 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
16538 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
16539 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16540 .cindex "transport" "local"
16541 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
16542 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
16543 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
16544 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
16545 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
16546 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
16547 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
16548 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
16549 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
16550 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
16551 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
16552 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16553
16554
16555
16556 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
16557 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
16558 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
16559
16560
16561 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
16562 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
16563 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
16564 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
16565 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address or
16566 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
16567 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
16568 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
16569 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
16570
16571 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
16572 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
16573 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
16574 user or group.
16575
16576
16577 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
16578 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
16579 addresses
16580 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
16581 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16582 are evaluated.
16583
16584
16585 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
16586 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
16587 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
16588 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16589 are evaluated.
16590 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
16591 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
16592
16593
16594
16595
16596
16597
16598 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16599 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16600
16601 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
16602 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
16603 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
16604 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
16605 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
16606 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
16607 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
16608 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
16609 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
16610 .code
16611 localusers:
16612 driver = accept
16613 domains = mydomain.example
16614 check_local_user
16615 transport = local_delivery
16616 .endd
16617 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
16618 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
16619 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
16620 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
16621
16622
16623
16624
16625
16626
16627 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16628 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16629
16630 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
16631 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
16632 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
16633 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
16634 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
16635 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
16636
16637 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
16638 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
16639 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
16640 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
16641 records.
16642
16643 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
16644 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
16645 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
16646 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
16647 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
16648 generic option, the router declines.
16649
16650 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
16651 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
16652 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
16653
16654 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
16655 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
16656 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
16657 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
16658 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
16659 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
16660
16661
16662 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
16663 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
16664 Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
16665 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
16666 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
16667 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
16668
16669 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
16670 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
16671 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
16672 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
16673 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
16674 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
16675 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
16676 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
16677 case routing fails.
16678
16679
16680
16681
16682 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
16683 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
16684 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
16685
16686 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
16687 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
16688 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
16689 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
16690 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
16691 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
16692 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
16693
16694
16695 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
16696 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
16697 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
16698 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
16699 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
16700 required. For example,
16701 .code
16702 check_srv = smtp
16703 .endd
16704 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
16705 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
16706 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
16707 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
16708 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
16709 normal way.
16710
16711 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
16712 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
16713 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
16714 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
16715 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
16716 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
16717
16718 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
16719 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
16720 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
16721 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
16722 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
16723 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
16724 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
16725 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
16726
16727 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
16728 when there is a DNS lookup error.
16729
16730
16731
16732 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
16733 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
16734 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
16735 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
16736 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
16737 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
16738 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
16739 setting:
16740 .code
16741 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
16742 .endd
16743 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
16744 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
16745 the address record.
16746
16747
16748 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
16749 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
16750 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
16751 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
16752
16753
16754
16755
16756 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
16757 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16758 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
16759 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
16760 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
16761 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
16762 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
16763 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
16764 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
16765 &'resolv.conf'&.
16766
16767
16768
16769 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
16770 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
16771 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
16772 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
16773 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
16774 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
16775 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
16776 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
16777 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
16778 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
16779 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
16780
16781 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
16782 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
16783 sense.
16784
16785 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
16786 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
16787 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
16788 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
16789 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
16790 header rewriting.
16791
16792
16793 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
16794 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
16795 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
16796 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
16797 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
16798 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
16799 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
16800 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
16801
16802 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
16803 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
16804 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
16805 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
16806 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
16807 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
16808 without processing them independently,
16809 provided the following conditions are met:
16810
16811 .ilist
16812 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
16813 &%headers_remove%&.
16814 .next
16815 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
16816 the domain.
16817 .endlist
16818
16819
16820
16821
16822 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
16823 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16824 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
16825 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
16826 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
16827 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
16828 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
16829 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
16830 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
16831 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
16832
16833 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
16834 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
16835 local wildcard.
16836
16837
16838
16839 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
16840 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
16841 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
16842 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
16843
16844
16845
16846
16847 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
16848 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
16849 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
16850 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
16851 if
16852 .code
16853 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
16854 .endd
16855 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
16856 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
16857 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
16858 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
16859 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
16860 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
16861
16862
16863 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
16864 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
16865 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
16866 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
16867 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
16868
16869 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
16870 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
16871 such as that implied by
16872 .code
16873 domains = @mx_any
16874 .endd
16875 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
16876 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
16877 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
16878 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
16879
16880
16881
16882
16883
16884
16885
16886
16887
16888 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16890
16891 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
16892 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
16893 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
16894 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
16895 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
16896 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
16897 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
16898 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
16899 router handles the address
16900 .code
16901 root@[192.168.1.1]
16902 .endd
16903 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
16904 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
16905 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
16906 .code
16907 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
16908 .endd
16909 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
16910 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
16911
16912 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
16913 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
16914 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
16915 &%self%& option determines what happens.
16916
16917 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
16918 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
16919 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
16920 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
16921
16922
16923
16924 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16925 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16926
16927 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
16928 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
16929 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
16930 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
16931 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
16932 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
16933 must set
16934 .code
16935 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
16936 .endd
16937 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
16938
16939 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
16940 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
16941 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
16942 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
16943 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
16944 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
16945 must not be specified for it.
16946
16947 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
16948 .option hosts iplookup string unset
16949 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
16950 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
16951 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
16952 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
16953 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
16954
16955
16956 .option optional iplookup boolean false
16957 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
16958 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
16959 delivery to the address is deferred.
16960
16961
16962 .option port iplookup integer 0
16963 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
16964 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
16965 call.
16966
16967
16968 .option protocol iplookup string udp
16969 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
16970 protocols is to be used.
16971
16972
16973 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
16974 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
16975 default value is:
16976 .code
16977 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
16978 .endd
16979 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
16980 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
16981
16982
16983 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
16984 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
16985 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
16986 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
16987 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
16988 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
16989 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
16990 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
16991
16992
16993 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
16994 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
16995 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
16996 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
16997 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
16998 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
16999 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
17000 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
17001 following could be used:
17002 .code
17003 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
17004 reroute = $local_part@$1
17005 .endd
17006
17007 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
17008 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
17009 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
17010 call. It does not apply to UDP.
17011
17012
17013
17014
17015 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17016 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17017
17018 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
17019 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
17020 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
17021 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
17022 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
17023 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
17024 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
17025 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
17026 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
17027 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
17028
17029 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
17030 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
17031 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
17032 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
17033 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
17034 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
17035 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
17036
17037 .vindex "&$host$&"
17038 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
17039 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
17040 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
17041 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
17042 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
17043 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
17044 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
17045 text string.
17046
17047 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
17048 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
17049 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
17050 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
17051 below, following the list of private options.
17052
17053
17054 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
17055
17056 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
17057 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
17058
17059 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
17060 See &%host_find_failed%&.
17061
17062 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
17063 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
17064 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
17065 of the following values:
17066 .code
17067 decline
17068 defer
17069 fail
17070 freeze
17071 ignore
17072 pass
17073 .endd
17074 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
17075 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
17076 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
17077 &%pass_router%&),
17078 .oindex "&%more%&"
17079 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
17080 router only if &%more%& is true.
17081
17082 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
17083 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
17084 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
17085 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
17086
17087 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
17088 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
17089 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
17090
17091
17092 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
17093 .cindex "randomized host list"
17094 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
17095 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
17096 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
17097 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
17098 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
17099 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
17100 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
17101 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
17102
17103 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
17104 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
17105 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
17106 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
17107 .code
17108 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
17109 .endd
17110 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
17111 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
17112 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
17113 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
17114 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
17115
17116
17117 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
17118 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
17119 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
17120 example:
17121 .code
17122 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
17123 .endd
17124 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
17125 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
17126 deferred.
17127
17128
17129 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
17130 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
17131 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
17132 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
17133
17134
17135 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
17136 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
17137 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
17138 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
17139 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
17140 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
17141 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
17142 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
17143
17144 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
17145 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
17146 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
17147 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
17148 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
17149 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
17150 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
17151 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
17152
17153
17154
17155
17156 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
17157 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
17158 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
17159 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
17160 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17161 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
17162 .display
17163 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
17164 .endd
17165 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
17166 no options:
17167 .code
17168 route_list = \
17169 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
17170 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17171 .endd
17172 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
17173 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
17174 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
17175 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
17176 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
17177 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
17178 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
17179 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
17180 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
17181 in a &%route_list%&).
17182
17183 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
17184 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
17185 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
17186 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
17187
17188
17189
17190 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
17191 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
17192 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
17193 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
17194 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
17195 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
17196 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
17197 like this:
17198 .code
17199 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
17200 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17201 .endd
17202 This data can be accessed by setting
17203 .code
17204 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
17205 .endd
17206 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
17207 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
17208 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
17209 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
17210 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
17211
17212
17213
17214
17215 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
17216 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
17217 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
17218 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
17219 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
17220 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
17221 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17222
17223 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
17224 variables are set during its expansion:
17225
17226 .ilist
17227 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17228 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
17229 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
17230 .code
17231 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
17232 .endd
17233 .next
17234 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
17235 .next
17236 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
17237
17238 .next
17239 .vindex "&$value$&"
17240 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
17241 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
17242 .code
17243 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
17244 .endd
17245 .endlist
17246
17247 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
17248 semicolon is the default route list separator.
17249
17250
17251
17252 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
17253 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
17254 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
17255 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
17256 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
17257 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
17258
17259 .ilist
17260 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
17261 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
17262 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
17263 .code
17264 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
17265 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
17266 .endd
17267 .next
17268 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
17269 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
17270 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
17271 number follows. For example:
17272 .code
17273 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
17274 .endd
17275 .endlist
17276
17277 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
17278 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
17279 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
17280 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
17281 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
17282 transport.
17283
17284 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
17285 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
17286 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
17287 records in the DNS. For example:
17288 .code
17289 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
17290 .endd
17291 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
17292 example:
17293 .code
17294 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
17295 .endd
17296 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
17297 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
17298 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
17299 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
17300 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
17301 happens is controlled by the
17302 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17303 &%self%& option of the router.
17304
17305 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
17306 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
17307 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
17308 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
17309 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
17310 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
17311 defined by MX preferences.
17312
17313 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
17314 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
17315 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
17316
17317 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
17318 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
17319 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
17320 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
17321
17322 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
17323 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
17324 router.
17325
17326 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
17327 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
17328 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
17329
17330 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
17331 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
17332
17333
17334
17335 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
17336 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
17337 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
17338 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
17339 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
17340 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
17341 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
17342
17343 .ilist
17344 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
17345 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
17346 .next
17347 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
17348 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
17349 .next
17350 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
17351 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
17352 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
17353 .next
17354 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
17355 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
17356 timeout), delivery is deferred.
17357 .endlist
17358
17359 For example:
17360 .code
17361 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
17362 domain2 host4:host5
17363 .endd
17364 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
17365 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
17366 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
17367 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
17368 call.
17369
17370 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
17371 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
17372 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
17373 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
17374 function called.
17375
17376
17377
17378 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
17379 &%host_find_failed%& option.
17380
17381 .vindex "&$host$&"
17382 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
17383 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
17384
17385
17386
17387 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
17388 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
17389 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
17390
17391 .ilist
17392 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
17393 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
17394 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
17395 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
17396 .code
17397 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
17398 .endd
17399 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
17400 your first router something like this:
17401 .code
17402 smart_route:
17403 driver = manualroute
17404 domains = !+local_domains
17405 transport = remote_smtp
17406 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
17407 .endd
17408 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
17409 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
17410 they are tried in order
17411 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
17412 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
17413 .code
17414 smart_route:
17415 driver = manualroute
17416 transport = remote_smtp
17417 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
17418 .endd
17419 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
17420 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
17421 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
17422 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
17423 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
17424 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
17425 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
17426 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
17427
17428 .next
17429 .cindex "mail hub example"
17430 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
17431 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
17432 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
17433 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
17434 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
17435 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
17436 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
17437 lookup is easier to manage.
17438
17439 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
17440 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
17441 example:
17442 .code
17443 hub_route:
17444 driver = manualroute
17445 transport = remote_smtp
17446 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
17447 .endd
17448 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
17449 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
17450 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
17451 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
17452 domain can be used to find the host:
17453 .code
17454 through_firewall:
17455 driver = manualroute
17456 transport = remote_smtp
17457 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
17458 .endd
17459 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
17460 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
17461 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
17462 next router.
17463
17464 .next
17465 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
17466 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
17467 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
17468 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
17469 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
17470 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
17471 .code
17472 save_in_file:
17473 driver = manualroute
17474 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
17475 route_list = saved.domain.example
17476 .endd
17477 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
17478 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
17479 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
17480 .code
17481 save_in_file:
17482 driver = manualroute
17483 route_list = \
17484 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
17485 *.saved.domain2.example \
17486 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
17487 batch_pipe
17488 .endd
17489 .vindex "&$domain$&"
17490 .vindex "&$host$&"
17491 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
17492 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
17493 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
17494 the address if the lookup fails.
17495
17496 .next
17497 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
17498 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
17499 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
17500 one way it can be done:
17501 .code
17502 # Transport
17503 uucp:
17504 driver = pipe
17505 user = nobody
17506 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
17507 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
17508 return_fail_output = true
17509
17510 # Router
17511 uucphost:
17512 transport = uucp
17513 driver = manualroute
17514 route_data = \
17515 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
17516 .endd
17517 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
17518 .code
17519 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
17520 .endd
17521 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
17522 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
17523 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
17524 .endlist
17525 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
17526 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
17527
17528
17529
17530
17531
17532
17533
17534
17535 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17536 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17537
17538 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
17539 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
17540 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
17541 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
17542 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
17543 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
17544 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
17545 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
17546 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
17547 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
17548 options:
17549 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
17550
17551 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
17552 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
17553 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
17554 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
17555 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
17556
17557
17558 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
17559 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
17560 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
17561 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
17562 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
17563 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
17564
17565
17566 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
17567 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
17568 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
17569 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
17570 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
17571 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
17572 not set, a value for the gid also.
17573
17574 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
17575 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
17576 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
17577 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
17578 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
17579 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
17580 gid.
17581
17582
17583 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
17584 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
17585 before running the command.
17586
17587
17588 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
17589 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
17590 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
17591 timeout.
17592
17593
17594 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
17595 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
17596 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
17597 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
17598 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
17599
17600 .ilist
17601 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
17602 below).
17603 .next
17604 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
17605 &%no_more%& is set.
17606 .next
17607 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
17608 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
17609 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
17610 included in the SMTP response.
17611 .next
17612 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
17613 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
17614 included in any SMTP response.
17615 .next
17616 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
17617 .next
17618 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
17619 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
17620 .next
17621 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
17622 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
17623 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
17624 .endlist
17625
17626 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
17627 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
17628 the page):
17629 .code
17630 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
17631 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
17632 .endd
17633 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
17634 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
17635 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
17636 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
17637
17638 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
17639 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
17640 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
17641 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
17642 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
17643
17644 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
17645 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
17646 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
17647 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
17648 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
17649
17650 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17651 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
17652 variable. For example, this return line
17653 .code
17654 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
17655 .endd
17656 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
17657 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
17658 .ecindex IIDquerou1
17659 .ecindex IIDquerou2
17660
17661
17662
17663
17664 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17665 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17666
17667 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
17668 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
17669 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
17670 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
17671 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
17672 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
17673 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
17674 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
17675 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
17676 redirected in several different ways:
17677
17678 .ilist
17679 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
17680 independently.
17681 .next
17682 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
17683 .next
17684 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
17685 .next
17686 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
17687 .next
17688 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
17689 .next
17690 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
17691 .next
17692 It can be discarded.
17693 .endlist
17694
17695 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
17696 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
17697 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
17698 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
17699
17700
17701
17702 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
17703 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
17704 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
17705 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
17706 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
17707 aliases, in a configuration like this:
17708 .code
17709 system_aliases:
17710 driver = redirect
17711 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
17712 .endd
17713 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
17714 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
17715 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
17716 cause delivery to be deferred.
17717
17718 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
17719 &_.forward_& files, like this:
17720 .code
17721 userforward:
17722 driver = redirect
17723 check_local_user
17724 file = $home/.forward
17725 no_verify
17726 .endd
17727 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
17728 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
17729 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
17730 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
17731 comments.
17732
17733
17734
17735 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
17736 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
17737 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
17738 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
17739
17740 .ilist
17741 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
17742 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
17743 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
17744 practice the router may not be able to operate.
17745 .next
17746 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
17747 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
17748 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
17749 saves some resources.
17750 .endlist
17751
17752
17753
17754
17755
17756
17757 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
17758 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
17759 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
17760 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
17761 can be interpreted in two different ways:
17762
17763 .ilist
17764 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
17765 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
17766 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
17767 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
17768 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
17769 document is intended for use by end users.
17770 .next
17771 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
17772 described in the next section.
17773 .endlist
17774
17775 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
17776 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
17777 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
17778 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
17779 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
17780
17781
17782
17783 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
17784 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
17785 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
17786 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
17787 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
17788 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
17789 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
17790 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
17791 commas or newlines.
17792 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
17793 quotes.
17794
17795 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
17796 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
17797 next newline character is ignored.
17798
17799 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
17800 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
17801 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
17802 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
17803 removed.
17804
17805 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17806 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
17807 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
17808 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
17809 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
17810 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
17811 setting:
17812 .code
17813 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
17814 .endd
17815
17816
17817 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
17818 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
17819 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
17820 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
17821 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
17822 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
17823 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
17824 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
17825 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
17826 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
17827 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
17828
17829 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
17830 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
17831 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
17832 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
17833 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
17834 .code
17835 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
17836 .endd
17837 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
17838 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
17839 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
17840 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
17841 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
17842 synonymously.
17843
17844 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
17845 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
17846 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
17847 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
17848 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
17849
17850 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
17851 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
17852 contains:
17853 .code
17854 Sam.Reman: spqr
17855 .endd
17856 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
17857 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
17858 this forward file:
17859 .code
17860 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
17861 .endd
17862 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
17863 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
17864 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
17865 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
17866 should really contain
17867 .code
17868 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
17869 .endd
17870 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
17871 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
17872 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
17873
17874
17875
17876 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
17877 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
17878 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
17879
17880 .ilist
17881 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
17882 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
17883 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
17884 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
17885 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
17886 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
17887 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
17888
17889 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
17890 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
17891 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
17892 in double quotes, for example:
17893 .code
17894 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
17895 .endd
17896 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
17897 quote just the command. An item such as
17898 .code
17899 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
17900 .endd
17901 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
17902
17903 .next
17904 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
17905 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
17906 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
17907 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
17908 .code
17909 /home/world/minbari
17910 .endd
17911 is treated as a file name, but
17912 .code
17913 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
17914 .endd
17915 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
17916 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
17917 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
17918 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
17919
17920 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
17921 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
17922
17923 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
17924 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
17925 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
17926 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
17927
17928 .next
17929 .cindex "included address list"
17930 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
17931 If an item is of the form
17932 .code
17933 :include:<path name>
17934 .endd
17935 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
17936 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
17937 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
17938 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
17939 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
17940 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
17941 .code
17942 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
17943 .endd
17944 It must be given as
17945 .code
17946 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
17947 .endd
17948 .next
17949 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
17950 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
17951 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
17952 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
17953 .cindex "black hole"
17954 .cindex "abandoning mail"
17955 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
17956 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing
17957 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
17958
17959 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
17960 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
17961 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
17962 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
17963 &_/dev/null_&.
17964
17965 .next
17966 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
17967 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
17968 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
17969 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
17970 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
17971 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
17972 redirection items of the form
17973 .code
17974 :defer:
17975 :fail:
17976 .endd
17977 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
17978 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
17979 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
17980 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
17981 .code
17982 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
17983 .endd
17984 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
17985 of a
17986 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
17987 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
17988 default.
17989 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
17990 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
17991 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
17992
17993 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
17994 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
17995 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
17996 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
17997 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
17998 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
17999 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
18000 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
18001 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
18002 ignored.
18003
18004 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
18005 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
18006 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
18007 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
18008
18009 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
18010 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
18011 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
18012 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
18013 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
18014
18015 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
18016 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
18017 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
18018 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
18019 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
18020 rules still apply.
18021
18022 .next
18023 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
18024 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
18025 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
18026 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
18027 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
18028 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
18029 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
18030 .endlist
18031
18032
18033 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
18034 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
18035 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
18036 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
18037 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
18038 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
18039 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
18040 aliasing scheme of the type
18041 .code
18042 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
18043 localpart1: pipe
18044 localpart2: pipe
18045 .endd
18046 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
18047 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
18048 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
18049 such as
18050 .code
18051 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
18052 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
18053 .endd
18054 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
18055 the pipes are distinct.
18056
18057
18058
18059 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
18060 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
18061 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
18062 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
18063 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
18064 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
18065 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
18066 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
18067 can be used to avoid this.
18068
18069
18070 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
18071 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
18072 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
18073 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
18074 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
18075 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
18076 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
18077
18078
18079
18080 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
18081
18082 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
18083 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
18084
18085
18086 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
18087 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
18088 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
18089
18090
18091 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
18092 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
18093 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
18094 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
18095
18096
18097 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
18098 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
18099 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
18100 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
18101 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
18102 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
18103 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
18104
18105 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
18106 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
18107
18108
18109 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
18110 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
18111 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
18112 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
18113 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
18114
18115
18116
18117 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
18118 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
18119 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
18120 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
18121 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
18122 let ordinary users do.
18123
18124
18125
18126 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
18127 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
18128 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
18129 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
18130 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
18131 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
18132
18133 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
18134 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
18135 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
18136 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
18137 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
18138 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
18139 .code
18140 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
18141 .endd
18142 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
18143 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
18144 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
18145 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
18146 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
18147 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
18148 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
18149 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
18150
18151
18152 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
18153 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
18154 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
18155 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
18156 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
18157 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
18158 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
18159 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
18160
18161
18162
18163 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
18164 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
18165 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
18166 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
18167 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
18168 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
18169
18170
18171 .option data redirect string&!! unset
18172 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
18173 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
18174 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
18175 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
18176 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
18177
18178 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
18179 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
18180 terminated with newline characters. For example:
18181 .code
18182 data = #Exim filter\n\
18183 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
18184 .endd
18185 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
18186 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
18187 choice into a newline.
18188
18189
18190 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
18191 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
18192 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18193 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18194 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
18195
18196
18197 .option file redirect string&!! unset
18198 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
18199 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
18200 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
18201 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
18202 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
18203 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
18204 entirely of comments), the router declines.
18205
18206 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
18207 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
18208 runs a check on the containing directory,
18209 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
18210 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
18211 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
18212 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
18213 not, the router declines.
18214
18215
18216 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
18217 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
18218 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
18219 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18220 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18221 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
18222 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
18223
18224
18225 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
18226 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
18227 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
18228 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
18229 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
18230
18231
18232 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
18233 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
18234 redirection list.
18235
18236
18237 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
18238 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
18239 &%allow_filter%& is true.
18240
18241
18242
18243
18244 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
18245 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
18246 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
18247 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
18248 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
18249 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
18250 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
18251 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
18252 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
18253
18254
18255 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
18256 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
18257 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18258 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
18259 functions.
18260
18261 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
18262 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
18263 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18264 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
18265
18266 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
18267 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
18268 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
18269 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
18270 &_.forward_& files).
18271
18272
18273 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
18274 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18275 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
18276
18277
18278 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
18279 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
18280 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
18281 of the embedded Perl support.
18282
18283
18284 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
18285 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18286 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
18287
18288
18289 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
18290 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18291 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
18292
18293
18294 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
18295 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
18296 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
18297 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
18298 &%one_time%& is set.
18299
18300
18301 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
18302 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18303 to make use of &%run%& items.
18304
18305
18306 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
18307 If this option is true, items of the form
18308 .code
18309 :include:<path name>
18310 .endd
18311 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
18312
18313
18314 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
18315 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
18316 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
18317 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
18318 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
18319
18320
18321 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
18322 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
18323 &%allow_filter%& is true.
18324
18325
18326 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
18327 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
18328 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
18329 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
18330 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
18331
18332
18333
18334
18335 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
18336 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
18337 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
18338 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
18339 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
18340 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
18341 bounce may well quote the generated address.
18342
18343
18344 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
18345 .cindex "EACCES"
18346 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
18347 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
18348 file did not exist.
18349
18350
18351 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
18352 .cindex "ENOTDIR"
18353 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
18354 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
18355 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
18356
18357 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
18358 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
18359 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
18360 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
18361 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
18362 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
18363 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
18364 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
18365
18366
18367
18368 .option include_directory redirect string unset
18369 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
18370 redirection list must start with this directory.
18371
18372
18373 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
18374 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
18375 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
18376
18377
18378 .option one_time redirect boolean false
18379 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
18380 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
18381 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
18382 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
18383 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
18384 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
18385 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
18386 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
18387 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
18388 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
18389 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
18390 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
18391 before they subscribed.
18392
18393 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
18394 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
18395 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
18396 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
18397 attempt.
18398
18399 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
18400 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
18401 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
18402 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
18403
18404 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
18405 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
18406 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
18407
18408 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
18409 &%one_time%&.
18410
18411 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
18412 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
18413 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
18414 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
18415 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
18416 expansion.
18417
18418
18419 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
18420 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
18421 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
18422 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
18423 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
18424 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
18425 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
18426 See &%check_owner%& above.
18427
18428
18429 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
18430 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
18431 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
18432 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
18433
18434
18435 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
18436 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
18437 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
18438 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
18439 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
18440 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
18441 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
18442
18443
18444 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
18445 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
18446 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
18447 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
18448 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
18449 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
18450 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
18451 &$qualify_recipient$&.
18452
18453 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
18454 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
18455 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
18456 addresses.
18457
18458 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
18459 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
18460 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
18461 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
18462 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
18463 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
18464 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
18465 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
18466 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
18467 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
18468
18469
18470 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
18471 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
18472 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
18473 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
18474 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
18475 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
18476
18477
18478 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
18479 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
18480 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
18481 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
18482 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
18483 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
18484
18485
18486 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
18487 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
18488 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
18489 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
18490 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
18491
18492
18493 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
18494 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
18495 :subaddress part of an address.
18496
18497 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
18498 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
18499 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
18500 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
18501
18502
18503 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
18504 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
18505 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
18506 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
18507 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
18508 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
18509 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
18510
18511
18512
18513 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
18514 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
18515 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
18516 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
18517 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
18518 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
18519 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
18520 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
18521 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
18522 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
18523 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
18524 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
18525 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
18526 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
18527 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
18528 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
18529
18530 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
18531 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
18532 the following routers.
18533
18534 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
18535 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
18536 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
18537 so it is passed to the following routers.
18538
18539 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
18540 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
18541 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
18542 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
18543
18544 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
18545 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
18546 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
18547 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
18548 .code
18549 userforward:
18550 driver = redirect
18551 allow_filter
18552 check_local_user
18553 file = $home/.forward
18554 file_transport = address_file
18555 pipe_transport = address_pipe
18556 reply_transport = address_reply
18557 no_verify
18558 skip_syntax_errors
18559 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
18560 syntax_errors_text = \
18561 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
18562 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
18563 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
18564 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
18565 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
18566 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
18567 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
18568 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
18569 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
18570 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
18571 .endd
18572 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
18573 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
18574 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
18575 .code
18576 real_localuser:
18577 driver = accept
18578 check_local_user
18579 local_part_prefix = real-
18580 transport = local_delivery
18581 .endd
18582 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18583 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18584 .code
18585 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18586 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18587 .endd
18588
18589
18590 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
18591 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
18592
18593
18594 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
18595 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
18596 .ecindex IIDredrou1
18597 .ecindex IIDredrou2
18598
18599
18600
18601
18602
18603
18604 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18605 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18606
18607 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
18608 "Environment for local transports"
18609 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
18610 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
18611 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
18612 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
18613 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
18614 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
18615 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
18616
18617 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
18618 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
18619 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
18620 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
18621
18622 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
18623 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
18624 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
18625 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
18626 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
18627
18628
18629
18630 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
18631 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
18632 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
18633 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
18634 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
18635 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
18636 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
18637 time.
18638
18639 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
18640 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
18641 .code
18642 my_transport:
18643 driver = pipe
18644 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
18645 .endd
18646 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
18647 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
18648 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
18649 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
18650
18651
18652
18653
18654 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
18655 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18656 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
18657 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
18658 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
18659 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
18660 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
18661 group (set by the transport). For example:
18662 .code
18663 # Routers ...
18664 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
18665 local_users:
18666 driver = accept
18667 check_local_user
18668 transport = group_delivery
18669
18670 # Transports ...
18671 # This transport overrides the group
18672 group_delivery:
18673 driver = appendfile
18674 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
18675 group = mail
18676 .endd
18677 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
18678 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
18679 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
18680 set.
18681
18682 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
18683 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
18684 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
18685 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
18686 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
18687 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
18688
18689 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
18690 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
18691 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
18692 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
18693 original gid is also used.
18694
18695 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
18696 following that is set is used:
18697
18698 .ilist
18699 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
18700 .next
18701 A &%group%& setting of the router;
18702 .next
18703 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
18704 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
18705 .next
18706 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
18707 .next
18708 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
18709 the uid is the creator's uid;
18710 .next
18711 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
18712 .endlist
18713
18714 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
18715 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
18716 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
18717 The first of the following that is set is used:
18718
18719 .ilist
18720 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
18721 .next
18722 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
18723 .next
18724 A &%user%& setting of the router;
18725 .next
18726 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
18727 .next
18728 The Exim uid.
18729 .endlist
18730
18731 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
18732 &%never_users%& list.
18733
18734
18735
18736
18737
18738 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
18739 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
18740 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18741 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
18742 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
18743 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
18744 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
18745 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
18746 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
18747 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
18748
18749 .ilist
18750 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18751 .next
18752 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18753 .next
18754 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18755 .next
18756 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18757 .endlist
18758
18759 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
18760
18761 .ilist
18762 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
18763 .next
18764 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
18765 .endlist
18766
18767
18768 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
18769 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
18770 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
18771
18772
18773
18774 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
18775 .vindex "&$domain$&"
18776 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18777 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
18778 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
18779 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
18780 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
18781 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
18782 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
18783 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
18784 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
18785 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
18786 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
18787 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
18788
18789
18790
18791
18792
18793
18794
18795 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18796 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18797
18798 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
18799 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
18800 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
18801 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
18802 The following generic options apply to all transports:
18803
18804
18805 .option body_only transports boolean false
18806 .cindex "transport" "body only"
18807 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
18808 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
18809 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
18810 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
18811 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
18812 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
18813 automatically suppress them.
18814
18815
18816 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
18817 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
18818 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
18819 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
18820 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18821 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18822
18823
18824 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
18825 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
18826 deliveries by the transport or for any
18827 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
18828 what you are doing.
18829
18830
18831 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
18832 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
18833 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
18834 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
18835 transport is run.
18836 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
18837 output, and Exim carries on processing.
18838 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
18839 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
18840 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
18841 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
18842 one.
18843
18844
18845 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
18846 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
18847 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
18848 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
18849 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
18850 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
18851 safely be resent to other recipients.
18852
18853
18854 .option driver transports string unset
18855 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
18856 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
18857
18858
18859 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
18860 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
18861 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
18862 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
18863 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
18864 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
18865 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
18866 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
18867 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
18868 resent to other recipients.
18869
18870
18871 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
18872 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
18873 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
18874 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
18875 &%user%& (see below).
18876
18877
18878 .option headers_add transports string&!! unset
18879 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
18880 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
18881 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded and added to the header
18882 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
18883 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
18884 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
18885 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
18886 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
18887
18888
18889
18890 .option headers_only transports boolean false
18891 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
18892 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
18893 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
18894 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
18895 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
18896 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
18897 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
18898
18899
18900 .option headers_remove transports string&!! unset
18901 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
18902 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
18903 This option specifies a string that is expanded into a list of header names;
18904 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
18905 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
18906 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
18907 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
18908 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
18909
18910
18911
18912 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
18913 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
18914 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
18915 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
18916 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
18917 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
18918 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
18919 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
18920 example,
18921 .code
18922 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
18923 x@y w@z
18924 .endd
18925 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
18926 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
18927 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
18928 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
18929 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
18930 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
18931 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
18932 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
18933 change envelope recipients at this time.
18934
18935
18936 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
18937 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
18938 .vindex "&$home$&"
18939 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
18940 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
18941 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
18942 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
18943 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
18944 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
18945 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
18946 deferred.
18947
18948
18949 .option initgroups transports boolean false
18950 .cindex "additional groups"
18951 .cindex "groups" "additional"
18952 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
18953 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
18954 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
18955 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
18956
18957
18958 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
18959 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
18960 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
18961 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
18962 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
18963 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
18964 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
18965 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
18966 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
18967 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
18968 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
18969 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
18970 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
18971 delivered.
18972
18973
18974
18975 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
18976 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
18977 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
18978 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
18979 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
18980 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
18981 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
18982 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
18983 that contains
18984 .code
18985 local_part_prefix = *-
18986 .endd
18987 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
18988 is delivered with
18989 .code
18990 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
18991 .endd
18992 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
18993 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
18994 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
18995 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
18996 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
18997
18998
18999 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
19000 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
19001 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
19002 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
19003 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
19004 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
19005 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
19006 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
19007 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
19008
19009 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
19010 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
19011 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
19012 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
19013
19014 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
19015 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
19016 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
19017
19018
19019 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
19020 .cindex "envelope sender"
19021 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
19022 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
19023 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
19024 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
19025 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
19026 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
19027 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
19028 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
19029 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
19030
19031 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
19032 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
19033
19034 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
19035 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
19036 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
19037 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
19038 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
19039 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
19040 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
19041
19042 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
19043 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
19044 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
19045 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
19046 &%errors_to%& in a router.
19047
19048
19049
19050 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
19051 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
19052 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
19053 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
19054 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
19055 have easy access to it.
19056
19057 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
19058 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
19059 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
19060 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
19061 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
19062 recipients.
19063
19064
19065 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
19066 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
19067
19068
19069 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
19070 .cindex "shadow transport"
19071 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
19072 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
19073 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
19074
19075 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
19076 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
19077 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
19078 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
19079 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
19080 cause a log line to be written.
19081
19082 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
19083 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
19084 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
19085 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
19086 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
19087 of the form
19088 .code
19089 ST=<shadow transport name>
19090 .endd
19091 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
19092 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
19093 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
19094 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
19095 headers that some sites insist on.
19096
19097
19098 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
19099 .cindex "transport" "filter"
19100 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
19101 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
19102 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
19103 individual users or via a system filter.
19104
19105 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
19106 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
19107 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
19108 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
19109 command must be specified as an absolute path.
19110
19111 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
19112 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
19113 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
19114 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
19115 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
19116 &(pipe)& transports.
19117
19118 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
19119 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
19120 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
19121 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
19122 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
19123
19124 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
19125 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
19126 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
19127 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
19128
19129 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
19130 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
19131 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
19132 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
19133 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
19134 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
19135
19136 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
19137 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
19138 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
19139 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
19140 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
19141 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
19142 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
19143 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
19144
19145 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19146 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
19147 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
19148 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
19149 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
19150 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
19151 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
19152 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
19153 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
19154 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
19155
19156 .vindex "&$host$&"
19157 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19158 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
19159 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
19160 which the message is being sent. For example:
19161 .code
19162 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
19163 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
19164 .endd
19165
19166 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
19167 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
19168 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
19169 .ilist
19170 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
19171 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
19172 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
19173 example:
19174 .code
19175 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
19176 .endd
19177 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
19178 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
19179 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
19180 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
19181 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
19182 Exim tried to expand the first one.
19183 .next
19184 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
19185 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
19186 arguments. Consider this example:
19187 .code
19188 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19189 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19190 .endd
19191 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
19192 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
19193 .code
19194 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19195 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19196 .endd
19197 .endlist
19198
19199 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
19200 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
19201 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
19202 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
19203 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
19204 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
19205 bounced from a transport filter.
19206
19207 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
19208 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
19209 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
19210
19211
19212 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
19213 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
19214 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it a applies a timeout
19215 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
19216 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
19217 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
19218 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
19219 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
19220 becomes a temporary error.
19221
19222
19223 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
19224 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19225 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
19226 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
19227 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
19228 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
19229 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
19230 option is not set.
19231
19232 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
19233 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
19234 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
19235
19236 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
19237 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
19238 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
19239 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
19240 retry data.
19241 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
19242 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
19243 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
19244
19245
19246
19247
19248
19249
19250 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19251 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19252
19253 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
19254 "Address batching"
19255 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
19256 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
19257 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
19258 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
19259 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
19260 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
19261 copy of the message is delivered each time.
19262
19263 .cindex "batched local delivery"
19264 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
19265 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
19266 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
19267 local transport, for example:
19268
19269 .ilist
19270 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
19271 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
19272 recipients saves space.
19273 .next
19274 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
19275 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
19276 .next
19277 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
19278 to a scanner program or
19279 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
19280 acceptable.
19281 .endlist
19282
19283 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
19284 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
19285 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
19286
19287 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
19288 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
19289 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
19290 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
19291 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
19292 to certain conditions:
19293
19294 .ilist
19295 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19296 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
19297 batching is possible.
19298 .next
19299 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19300 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
19301 addresses with the same domain are batched.
19302 .next
19303 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
19304 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
19305 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
19306 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
19307 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
19308 from taking place.
19309 .next
19310 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
19311 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
19312 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
19313 be the same.
19314 .endlist
19315
19316 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
19317 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
19318 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
19319 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
19320 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
19321 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
19322 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
19323 .code
19324 check_string = "."
19325 escape_string = ".."
19326 .endd
19327 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
19328 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
19329 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
19330
19331 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
19332 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
19333 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
19334 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
19335 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
19336 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
19337
19338 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
19339 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19340 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
19341 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
19342 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
19343 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
19344 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
19345 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
19346 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
19347
19348
19349
19350
19351 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19352 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19353
19354 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
19355 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
19356 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
19357 .cindex "directory creation"
19358 .cindex "creating directories"
19359 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
19360 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
19361 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
19362 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
19363 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
19364 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
19365 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
19366 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
19367 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
19368 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
19369
19370 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
19371 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
19372 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
19373 included.
19374
19375 .cindex "quota" "system"
19376 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
19377 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
19378 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
19379
19380 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
19381 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
19382 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
19383 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
19384
19385 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
19386 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
19387 private options.
19388
19389 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
19390 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
19391 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
19392 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
19393 option).
19394
19395
19396
19397 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
19398 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
19399 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
19400 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
19401 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
19402
19403 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
19404 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19405 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
19406 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
19407 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
19408 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
19409 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
19410 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
19411 operation. There are two cases:
19412
19413 .ilist
19414 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
19415 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
19416 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
19417 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
19418 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
19419 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
19420 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
19421 .next
19422 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
19423 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
19424 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
19425 .endlist
19426
19427
19428 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
19429 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
19430 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
19431 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
19432 form:
19433 .code
19434 save folder23
19435 .endd
19436 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
19437 .code
19438 require "fileinto";
19439 fileinto "folder23";
19440 .endd
19441 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
19442 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
19443 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
19444 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
19445 way of handling this requirement:
19446 .code
19447 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
19448 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
19449 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
19450 {$address_file} \
19451 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
19452 }} \
19453 }
19454 .endd
19455 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
19456 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
19457 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
19458
19459 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
19460 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
19461 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
19462 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
19463 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
19464 path to the transport.
19465
19466 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
19467 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
19468
19469
19470
19471
19472 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
19473 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
19474
19475
19476
19477 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
19478 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
19479 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
19480 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
19481 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
19482 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
19483 delivery is deferred.
19484
19485
19486 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
19487 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
19488 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
19489 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
19490 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
19491 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
19492 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
19493 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
19494
19495
19496 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
19497 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
19498 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
19499 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
19500 file.
19501
19502
19503 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
19504 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
19505
19506
19507 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
19508 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
19509 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
19510 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
19511 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
19512
19513
19514 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
19515 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
19516 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
19517 process is running.
19518
19519
19520 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
19521 .cindex "&""From""& line"
19522 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
19523 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
19524 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
19525 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
19526 contains is significant.
19527
19528 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
19529 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
19530 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
19531 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
19532 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
19533
19534 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
19535 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
19536 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
19537 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
19538 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
19539 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
19540 .code
19541 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19542 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
19543 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19544 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19545 .endd
19546 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
19547 .cindex "directory creation"
19548 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
19549 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
19550 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
19551
19552 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
19553 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
19554 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
19555 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
19556 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
19557
19558
19559
19560 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
19561 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
19562 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
19563 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
19564 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
19565 beneath.
19566
19567 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
19568 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
19569 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
19570 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
19571 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
19572 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
19573 &%file_must_exist%&.
19574
19575
19576 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
19577 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
19578 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
19579 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
19580
19581 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
19582 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
19583 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
19584 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
19585 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
19586
19587
19588 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
19589 .cindex "base62"
19590 .vindex "&$inode$&"
19591 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
19592 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
19593 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
19594 .code
19595 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
19596 .endd
19597 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
19598 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
19599 option.
19600
19601
19602 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
19603 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
19604 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
19605
19606
19607 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
19608 See &%check_string%& above.
19609
19610
19611 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
19612 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
19613 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
19614 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
19615 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
19616 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
19617 &%file%&.
19618
19619 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
19620 .cindex "locking files"
19621 .cindex "lock files"
19622 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
19623 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
19624
19625 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
19626 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
19627 examples:
19628 .code
19629 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
19630 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
19631 file = $home/inbox
19632 .endd
19633 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
19634 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
19635 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
19636 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
19637 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
19638 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
19639
19640
19641
19642 .option file_format appendfile string unset
19643 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
19644 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
19645 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
19646 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
19647 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
19648 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
19649 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
19650 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
19651 this added to it:
19652 .code
19653 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
19654 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
19655 .endd
19656 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
19657 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
19658 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
19659 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
19660 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
19661 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
19662 delivery is deferred.
19663
19664
19665 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
19666 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
19667 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
19668 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
19669
19670
19671 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
19672 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
19673 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
19674 .cindex "locking files"
19675 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
19676 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
19677 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
19678 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
19679 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
19680 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
19681 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
19682 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
19683
19684 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
19685 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
19686 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
19687 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
19688
19689 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
19690 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
19691 retries is
19692 .code
19693 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
19694 .endd
19695 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
19696 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
19697 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
19698
19699 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
19700 local deliveries because of errors of the form
19701 .code
19702 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
19703 .endd
19704
19705 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
19706 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
19707 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
19708 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
19709
19710
19711 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
19712 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
19713 for details of locking.
19714
19715
19716 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
19717 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
19718 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
19719
19720
19721 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
19722 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
19723 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
19724
19725
19726 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
19727 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
19728 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
19729 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
19730 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
19731
19732
19733 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
19734 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
19735 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
19736 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
19737 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
19738 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
19739 external source that maintains the data.
19740
19741
19742 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
19743 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
19744 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
19745 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
19746 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
19747 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
19748 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
19749 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
19750
19751
19752
19753 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
19754 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
19755 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
19756 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
19757 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
19758 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
19759 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
19760 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
19761 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
19762 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
19763
19764
19765 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
19766 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
19767 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
19768 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
19769 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
19770 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
19771 calculation. The default value is:
19772 .code
19773 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
19774 .endd
19775 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
19776 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
19777 &_Trash_&
19778 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
19779 .code
19780 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
19781 .endd
19782 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
19783 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
19784 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
19785 directly into that directory.
19786
19787
19788 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
19789 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
19790 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
19791
19792
19793 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
19794 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
19795 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
19796
19797
19798 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile boolean false
19799 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
19800 Setting this option true enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
19801 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
19802 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
19803 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
19804 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
19805
19806 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
19807 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
19808 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
19809 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
19810 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
19811 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
19812 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
19813 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
19814 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
19815 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
19816
19817
19818 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
19819 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
19820 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
19821 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
19822 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
19823 below for further details.
19824
19825
19826 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
19827 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
19828 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
19829
19830
19831 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
19832 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
19833 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
19834
19835
19836 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
19837 .cindex "locking files"
19838 .cindex "file" "locking"
19839 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
19840 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
19841 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
19842 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
19843 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
19844 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
19845 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
19846
19847 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
19848 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
19849 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
19850 combination:
19851 .code
19852 mbx_format = true
19853 message_prefix =
19854 message_suffix =
19855 .endd
19856 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
19857 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
19858 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
19859 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
19860 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
19861 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
19862 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
19863 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
19864
19865 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
19866 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
19867 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
19868 append messages to it.
19869
19870
19871 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
19872 .cindex "&""From""& line"
19873 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
19874 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
19875 in which case it is:
19876 .code
19877 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
19878 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
19879 .endd
19880 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
19881 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
19882
19883 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
19884 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
19885 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
19886 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
19887 setting
19888 .code
19889 message_suffix =
19890 .endd
19891 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
19892 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
19893
19894 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
19895 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
19896 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
19897 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
19898 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
19899 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
19900 value, and this option is ignored.
19901
19902
19903 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
19904 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
19905 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
19906 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
19907 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
19908
19909
19910 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
19911 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
19912 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
19913 on users about incoming mail.
19914
19915
19916 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
19917 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
19918 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
19919 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
19920 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
19921 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
19922 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
19923 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
19924 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
19925
19926 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
19927 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
19928 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
19929
19930 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
19931 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
19932 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
19933 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
19934 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
19935 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
19936
19937 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
19938 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
19939 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
19940 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
19941 be handled.
19942
19943 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
19944
19945 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
19946 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
19947 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
19948 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
19949 system quota failures.
19950
19951 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
19952 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
19953 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
19954 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
19955 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
19956 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
19957 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
19958 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
19959 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
19960 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
19961
19962
19963 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
19964 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
19965 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
19966 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
19967 delivery directory.
19968
19969
19970 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
19971 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
19972 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
19973 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
19974 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
19975 &"no quota"&.
19976
19977
19978 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
19979 See &%quota%& above.
19980
19981
19982 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
19983 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
19984 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
19985 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
19986 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
19987 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
19988 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
19989
19990 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
19991 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
19992 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
19993 the file length to the file name. For example:
19994 .code
19995 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
19996 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
19997 .endd
19998 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
19999 number of lines in the message.
20000
20001 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
20002 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
20003 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
20004
20005
20006
20007 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
20008 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
20009 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
20010 .code
20011 quota_warn_message = "\
20012 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
20013 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
20014 This message is automatically created \
20015 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
20016 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
20017 a warning threshold that is\n\
20018 set by the system administrator.\n"
20019 .endd
20020
20021
20022 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
20023 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
20024 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
20025 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20026 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
20027 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
20028 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
20029 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
20030 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
20031 sign. For example:
20032 .code
20033 quota = 10M
20034 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
20035 .endd
20036 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
20037 percent sign is ignored.
20038
20039 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
20040 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
20041 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
20042 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
20043 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
20044 &'From:'& line, the default is:
20045 .code
20046 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
20047 .endd
20048 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
20049 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
20050 option.
20051
20052 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
20053 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
20054 percentage.
20055
20056
20057 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
20058 .cindex "envelope sender"
20059 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
20060 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
20061 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
20062 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
20063 for details of batch SMTP.
20064
20065
20066 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
20067 .cindex "carriage return"
20068 .cindex "linefeed"
20069 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
20070 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
20071 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
20072 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
20073
20074 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
20075 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
20076 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
20077 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
20078 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
20079 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
20080
20081
20082 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
20083 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
20084 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
20085 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
20086 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
20087 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
20088
20089
20090 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
20091 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
20092 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
20093 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
20094 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
20095
20096 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
20097 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
20098 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
20099 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
20100
20101 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
20102 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
20103 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
20104 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
20105 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
20106 error.
20107
20108 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
20109 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
20110
20111
20112 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
20113 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
20114 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
20115 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
20116 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
20117 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
20118 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
20119
20120 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20121 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
20122 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
20123 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
20124 file corruption.
20125
20126 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
20127 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
20128 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
20129
20130
20131 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
20132 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
20133 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
20134 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
20135 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
20136 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
20137 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
20138 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
20139 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
20140
20141 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
20142 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
20143 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
20144 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
20145
20146
20147
20148
20149 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
20150 .cindex "appending to a file"
20151 .cindex "file" "appending"
20152 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
20153
20154 .ilist
20155 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
20156 return is given.
20157
20158 .next
20159 .cindex "directory creation"
20160 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
20161 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
20162 &%directory_mode%& option.
20163
20164 .next
20165 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
20166 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
20167 transport.
20168
20169 .next
20170 .cindex "file" "locking"
20171 .cindex "locking files"
20172 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20173 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
20174 reliably over NFS, as follows:
20175
20176 .olist
20177 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
20178 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
20179 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
20180 .next
20181 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
20182 .next
20183 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
20184 Unlink the hitching post name.
20185 .next
20186 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
20187 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
20188 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
20189 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
20190 .next
20191 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
20192 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
20193 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
20194 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
20195 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
20196 it before trying again.
20197 .endlist olist
20198
20199 .next
20200 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
20201 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
20202 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
20203
20204 .next
20205 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
20206 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
20207 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
20208 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
20209 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
20210 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
20211 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
20212 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
20213 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
20214 checked.
20215
20216 .next
20217 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
20218 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
20219 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
20220 delivery is deferred.
20221
20222 .next
20223 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
20224 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
20225 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
20226 permissions.
20227
20228 .next
20229 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
20230 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
20231 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
20232
20233 .next
20234 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
20235 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
20236 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
20237
20238 .next
20239 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
20240 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
20241 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
20242 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
20243 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
20244 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
20245 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
20246 that prevents link following.
20247
20248 .next
20249 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
20250 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
20251 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
20252 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
20253 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
20254
20255 .next
20256 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
20257
20258 .next
20259 .cindex "file" "locking"
20260 .cindex "locking files"
20261 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
20262 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
20263 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
20264 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
20265 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
20266 .code
20267 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
20268 .endd
20269 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
20270 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
20271 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
20272
20273 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
20274 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
20275 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
20276
20277 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
20278 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
20279 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
20280 delivery is deferred.
20281
20282 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
20283 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
20284 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
20285 immediately. It retries up to
20286 .code
20287 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
20288 .endd
20289 times (rounded up).
20290 .endlist
20291
20292 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
20293 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
20294
20295
20296 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
20297 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
20298 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20299 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
20300 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
20301 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
20302 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
20303 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
20304 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
20305 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
20306
20307 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
20308 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
20309 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
20310 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
20311 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
20312 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
20313 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
20314
20315 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
20316 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
20317 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
20318 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
20319
20320
20321 .cindex "maildir format"
20322 .cindex "mailstore format"
20323 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
20324 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
20325 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
20326 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
20327 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
20328
20329 .cindex "directory creation"
20330 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
20331 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
20332 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
20333 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
20334 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
20335 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
20336 deferred.
20337
20338
20339
20340 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
20341 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
20342 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
20343 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
20344 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
20345 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
20346 &_new_& subdirectory.
20347
20348 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
20349 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
20350 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
20351 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
20352 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
20353 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
20354 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
20355
20356 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
20357 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
20358 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
20359 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
20360 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
20361 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
20362 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
20363 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
20364
20365 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
20366 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
20367 folders. Consider this example:
20368 .code
20369 maildir_format = true
20370 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
20371 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
20372 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
20373 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
20374 .endd
20375 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
20376 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
20377 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
20378 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
20379 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
20380 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
20381
20382 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
20383 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
20384 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
20385 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
20386 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
20387
20388 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
20389 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
20390 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
20391
20392 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
20393 .cindex "maildir++"
20394 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
20395 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
20396 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
20397 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
20398 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
20399 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
20400 amount of space used.
20401
20402 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
20403 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
20404 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
20405 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
20406 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
20407 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
20408
20409
20410
20411
20412 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
20413 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
20414 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
20415 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
20416 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
20417 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
20418
20419 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
20420 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
20421 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
20422 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
20423 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
20424 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
20425 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
20426 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
20427 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
20428 colon is inserted.
20429
20430
20431
20432 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
20433 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
20434 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
20435 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
20436 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
20437 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
20438 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
20439 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
20440 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
20441
20442 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
20443 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
20444 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
20445 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
20446 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
20447 need to know the quota.
20448
20449 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
20450 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
20451
20452 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
20453 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
20454 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
20455 details.
20456
20457
20458 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
20459 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
20460 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
20461 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
20462 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
20463 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
20464 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
20465 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
20466
20467 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
20468 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
20469 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
20470 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
20471 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
20472 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
20473
20474 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
20475 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
20476 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
20477 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
20478 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
20479 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
20480
20481 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
20482 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
20483 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
20484 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
20485
20486
20487 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
20488 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
20489 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
20490 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
20491 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
20492 .code
20493 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
20494 .endd
20495 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
20496 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
20497 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
20498 .ecindex IIDapptra1
20499 .ecindex IIDapptra2
20500
20501
20502
20503
20504
20505
20506 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20507 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20508
20509 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
20510 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
20511 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
20512 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
20513 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
20514 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
20515 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
20516 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
20517
20518 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
20519 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
20520 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
20521 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
20522 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
20523
20524
20525 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
20526 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
20527 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
20528 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
20529 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
20530
20531 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
20532 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
20533 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
20534 transport is run as a consequence of a
20535 &%mail%&
20536 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
20537 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
20538 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
20539 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
20540 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
20541 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
20542
20543 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
20544 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
20545 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
20546 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
20547
20548 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
20549 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
20550 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
20551 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
20552 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
20553 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
20554 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
20555
20556 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
20557 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
20558 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
20559 the transport defers.
20560 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
20561 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
20562
20563 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
20564 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
20565 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
20566 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
20567
20568 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
20569 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
20570 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
20571 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
20572 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
20573 problems. They are just discarded.
20574
20575
20576
20577 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
20578 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
20579
20580 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
20581 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
20582 message when the message is specified by the transport.
20583
20584
20585 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
20586 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
20587 when the message is specified by the transport.
20588
20589
20590 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
20591 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
20592 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
20593 string comes first.
20594
20595
20596 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
20597 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
20598 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
20599
20600
20601 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
20602 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
20603 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
20604
20605
20606 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
20607 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
20608 specified by the transport.
20609
20610
20611 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
20612 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
20613 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
20614 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
20615
20616
20617 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
20618 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
20619 the message is specified by the transport.
20620
20621
20622 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
20623 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
20624 used.
20625
20626
20627 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
20628 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
20629 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
20630 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
20631 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
20632
20633
20634
20635 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
20636 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
20637 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
20638 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
20639
20640 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
20641 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
20642 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
20643 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
20644 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
20645 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
20646 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
20647 infinity.
20648
20649 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
20650 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
20651 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
20652 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
20653 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
20654
20655 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
20656 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
20657 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
20658 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
20659 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
20660 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
20661
20662
20663 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
20664 See &%once%& above.
20665
20666
20667 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
20668 See &%once%& above.
20669 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
20670
20671
20672 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
20673 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
20674 specified by the transport.
20675
20676
20677 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
20678 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
20679 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
20680 configuration option.
20681
20682
20683 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
20684 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
20685 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
20686 automatic responses. For example:
20687 .code
20688 subject = Re: $h_subject:
20689 .endd
20690 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
20691 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
20692 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
20693 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
20694 small.
20695
20696
20697
20698 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
20699 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
20700 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
20701 the text comes first.
20702
20703
20704 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
20705 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
20706 when the message is specified by the transport.
20707 .ecindex IIDauttra1
20708 .ecindex IIDauttra2
20709
20710
20711
20712
20713 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20714 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20715
20716 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
20717 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
20718 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
20719 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
20720 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
20721 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
20722 specified command
20723 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
20724 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
20725 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
20726 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
20727 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
20728 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
20729 .code
20730 TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
20731 .endd
20732 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
20733 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
20734 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
20735 as follows:
20736
20737 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
20738 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20739
20740
20741 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
20742 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
20743 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
20744 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
20745 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20746
20747
20748 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
20749 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
20750 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
20751 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
20752 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
20753 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
20754 LMTP protocol.
20755
20756 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
20757 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
20758 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
20759 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
20760 in its response to the LHLO command.
20761
20762 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
20763 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
20764 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
20765 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
20766
20767
20768 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
20769 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
20770 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
20771 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
20772 LMTP transport:
20773 .code
20774 lmtp:
20775 driver = lmtp
20776 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
20777 batch_max = 20
20778 user = exim
20779 .endd
20780 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
20781 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
20782
20783
20784
20785 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20786 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20787
20788 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
20789 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
20790 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
20791 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
20792 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
20793 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
20794 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
20795 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
20796 following ways:
20797
20798 .ilist
20799 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20800 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
20801 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
20802 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
20803 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
20804 .next
20805 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20806 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
20807 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
20808 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
20809 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
20810 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
20811 that are routed to the transport.
20812 .next
20813 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20814 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
20815 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
20816 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If only
20817 one address is being transported (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or
20818 only one address was redirected to this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains
20819 the local part that was redirected.
20820 .endlist
20821
20822
20823 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
20824 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
20825 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
20826
20827 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
20828 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
20829 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
20830 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
20831 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
20832 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
20833 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
20834
20835
20836 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
20837 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
20838 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
20839 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
20840 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
20841
20842
20843
20844
20845 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
20846 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
20847 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
20848 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
20849 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
20850 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
20851 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
20852 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
20853 &"local delivery failed"&.
20854
20855 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
20856 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
20857 value is the return code minus 128.
20858
20859 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
20860 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
20861 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
20862 a non-existent command may be the problem.
20863
20864 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
20865 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
20866 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
20867 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
20868 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
20869 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
20870 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
20871 &%temp_errors%&.
20872
20873
20874
20875 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
20876 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
20877 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
20878 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
20879 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
20880 run.
20881
20882 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
20883 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
20884 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
20885 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
20886
20887 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
20888 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
20889 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
20890 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
20891 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
20892 .code
20893 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
20894 .endd
20895 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
20896 arguments. You have to write
20897 .code
20898 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
20899 .endd
20900 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
20901 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
20902 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
20903 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
20904 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
20905 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
20906 example:
20907 .code
20908 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
20909 .endd
20910
20911 .cindex "transport" "filter"
20912 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
20913 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20914 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
20915 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
20916 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
20917 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
20918 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
20919 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
20920 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
20921
20922 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
20923 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
20924 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
20925 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
20926 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
20927 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
20928 control what is done with it.
20929
20930 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
20931 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
20932 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
20933 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
20934 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
20935 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
20936 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
20937 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
20938 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
20939 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
20940 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
20941
20942
20943
20944 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
20945 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
20946 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
20947 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
20948 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
20949 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
20950 environment.
20951 .display
20952 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
20953 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
20954 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
20955 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
20956 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
20957 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
20958 &`LOGNAME `& see below
20959 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
20960 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
20961 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
20962 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
20963 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
20964 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
20965 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
20966 &`USER `& see below
20967 .endd
20968 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
20969 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
20970 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
20971 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
20972 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
20973 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
20974 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
20975
20976 .cindex "HOST"
20977 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
20978 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
20979 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
20980 the router.
20981
20982 .cindex "HOME"
20983 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
20984 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
20985 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
20986 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
20987
20988
20989 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
20990 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
20991
20992
20993
20994 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
20995 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
20996 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
20997 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
20998 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
20999 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
21000 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
21001 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
21002 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
21003 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
21004 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
21005 example, if
21006 .code
21007 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
21008 .endd
21009 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
21010 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
21011 &%use_shell%& is set.
21012
21013
21014 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
21015 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21016
21017
21018 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
21019 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
21020 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21021
21022
21023 .option check_string pipe string unset
21024 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
21025 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
21026 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
21027 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
21028 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
21029 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
21030 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
21031 ignored.
21032
21033
21034 .option command pipe string&!! unset
21035 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
21036 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
21037 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
21038 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
21039 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
21040 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
21041
21042
21043 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
21044 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
21045 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
21046 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
21047 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
21048 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
21049 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
21050
21051
21052 .option escape_string pipe string unset
21053 See &%check_string%& above.
21054
21055
21056 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
21057 .cindex "exec failure"
21058 .cindex "failure of exec"
21059 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
21060 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
21061 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
21062 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
21063 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
21064
21065
21066 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
21067 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
21068 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
21069 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
21070 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
21071 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
21072
21073 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
21074 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
21075
21076 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
21077 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
21078 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
21079 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
21080 and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
21081
21082
21083 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
21084 If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
21085 return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
21086 &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
21087 written to the main log. This option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive.
21088 Only one of them may be set.
21089
21090
21091
21092 .option log_output pipe boolean false
21093 If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
21094 output is written to the main log, whatever the return code. This option and
21095 &%log_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
21096
21097
21098
21099 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
21100 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
21101 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
21102 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
21103 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
21104 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
21105 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
21106 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
21107
21108
21109 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
21110 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21111 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
21112 .code
21113 message_prefix = \
21114 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
21115 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
21116 .endd
21117 .cindex "Cyrus"
21118 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
21119 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21120 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
21121 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
21122 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
21123 setting
21124 .code
21125 message_prefix =
21126 .endd
21127 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21128 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21129
21130
21131 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
21132 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21133 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
21134 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
21135 .code
21136 message_suffix =
21137 .endd
21138 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21139 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21140
21141
21142 .option path pipe string "see below"
21143 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
21144 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
21145 .code
21146 /bin:/usr/bin
21147 .endd
21148 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
21149 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
21150 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
21151
21152
21153 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
21154 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
21155 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
21156 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
21157 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
21158 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
21159 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
21160 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
21161 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
21162
21163
21164 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
21165 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21166 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
21167 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
21168 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
21169 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
21170 accept the message is used.
21171
21172
21173 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
21174 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
21175 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
21176 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
21177 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
21178 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
21179
21180
21181 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
21182 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
21183 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
21184 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
21185 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
21186 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
21187 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
21188
21189
21190
21191 .option return_output pipe boolean false
21192 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
21193 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
21194 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
21195 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
21196 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
21197 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
21198 of them may be set.
21199
21200
21201
21202 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
21203 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
21204 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
21205 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
21206 and &%return_output%& is not set,
21207 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
21208 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
21209 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
21210 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
21211 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
21212 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
21213 and 73, respectively.
21214
21215
21216 .option timeout pipe time 1h
21217 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
21218 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
21219 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
21220 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
21221 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
21222 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
21223
21224 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
21225 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
21226 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
21227 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
21228 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
21229 delivery to be deferred.
21230
21231 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
21232 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
21233
21234
21235 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
21236 .cindex "envelope sender"
21237 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
21238 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
21239 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
21240 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
21241 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
21242
21243 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
21244 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
21245 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
21246 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
21247 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
21248 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
21249 class database.
21250
21251
21252 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
21253 .cindex "carriage return"
21254 .cindex "linefeed"
21255 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21256 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21257 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
21258 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21259
21260 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
21261 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
21262 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
21263 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
21264 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21265
21266
21267 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
21268 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21269 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
21270 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
21271 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
21272 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
21273 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
21274 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
21275 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
21276 its &%-c%& option.
21277
21278
21279
21280 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
21281 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
21282 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
21283 .cindex "external local delivery"
21284 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
21285 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
21286 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
21287 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
21288 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
21289 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
21290 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
21291 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
21292 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
21293 configuration for &%procmail%&:
21294 .code
21295 # transport
21296 procmail_pipe:
21297 driver = pipe
21298 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
21299 return_path_add
21300 delivery_date_add
21301 envelope_to_add
21302 check_string = "From "
21303 escape_string = ">From "
21304 umask = 077
21305 user = $local_part
21306 group = mail
21307
21308 # router
21309 procmail:
21310 driver = accept
21311 check_local_user
21312 transport = procmail_pipe
21313 .endd
21314 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
21315 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
21316 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
21317 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
21318 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
21319 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
21320
21321 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
21322 .code
21323 IFS=" "
21324 .endd
21325 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
21326 use a shell to run pipe commands.
21327
21328 .cindex "Cyrus"
21329 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
21330 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
21331 .code
21332 # transport
21333 local_delivery_cyrus:
21334 driver = pipe
21335 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
21336 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
21337 user = cyrus
21338 group = mail
21339 return_output
21340 log_output
21341 message_prefix =
21342 message_suffix =
21343
21344 # router
21345 local_user_cyrus:
21346 driver = accept
21347 check_local_user
21348 local_part_suffix = .*
21349 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
21350 .endd
21351 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
21352 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
21353 sender.
21354 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
21355 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
21356
21357
21358 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21359 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21360
21361 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
21362 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
21363 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
21364 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
21365 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
21366 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
21367 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
21368 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
21369
21370
21371 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
21372 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
21373 two ways:
21374
21375 .ilist
21376 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
21377 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
21378 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
21379 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
21380 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
21381 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
21382 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
21383 .next
21384 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
21385 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
21386 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
21387 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
21388 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
21389 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
21390 process.
21391 .endlist
21392
21393
21394 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
21395 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
21396 no further messages are sent over that connection.
21397
21398
21399
21400 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
21401 .vindex "&$host$&"
21402 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21403 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
21404 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
21405 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
21406 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
21407 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
21408 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
21409 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
21410
21411
21412 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
21413 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
21414 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
21415 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_cipher$&
21416 and &$tls_peerdn$& are the values that were set when the message was received.
21417 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
21418 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these two
21419 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
21420 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
21421 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
21422 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
21423
21424
21425 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
21426 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
21427 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
21428
21429
21430 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
21431 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
21432 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
21433 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
21434 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
21435 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
21436 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
21437 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
21438
21439 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
21440 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
21441 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
21442 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
21443 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
21444 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
21445 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
21446 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
21447 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
21448
21449
21450 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
21451 .cindex "Cyrus"
21452 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
21453 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
21454 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
21455 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
21456 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
21457 ignored.
21458
21459 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
21460 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
21461 &$tls_cipher$&, and &$tls_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
21462 particular connection.
21463
21464 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
21465 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
21466 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
21467 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
21468
21469 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
21470 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
21471 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
21472 .code
21473 authenticated_sender = $local_part
21474 .endd
21475 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
21476 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
21477
21478 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
21479 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
21480 value.
21481
21482
21483 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
21484 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
21485 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
21486 authenticated as a client.
21487
21488
21489 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
21490 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
21491 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
21492 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
21493
21494
21495 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
21496 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
21497 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
21498 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
21499 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
21500 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
21501 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
21502
21503
21504 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
21505 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
21506 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
21507 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
21508 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
21509 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
21510 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
21511 option.
21512
21513
21514 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
21515 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
21516 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
21517 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
21518
21519
21520 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
21521 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
21522 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
21523 cutoff times.
21524
21525 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
21526 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
21527 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
21528 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
21529 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
21530 unhappy at this prospect, so...
21531
21532 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
21533 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
21534 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
21535 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
21536 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
21537 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
21538 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
21539 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
21540 to them.
21541
21542
21543 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
21544 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
21545 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
21546 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
21547 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
21548
21549
21550 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
21551 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
21552 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
21553 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
21554 details.
21555
21556
21557
21558 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
21559 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
21560 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
21561 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
21562 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
21563 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
21564 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
21565 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
21566
21567 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
21568 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
21569 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
21570 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
21571 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
21572 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
21573
21574 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
21575 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
21576 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
21577 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
21578 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
21579
21580 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
21581 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
21582 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
21583 copy of the message is sent.
21584
21585 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
21586 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
21587 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
21588 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
21589 fails"& facility.
21590
21591
21592 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
21593 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
21594 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
21595 zero.
21596
21597 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
21598 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
21599 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
21600 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
21601 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
21602 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
21603
21604 .option gnutls_require_kx smtp string unset
21605 This option controls the key exchange mechanisms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
21606 client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
21607
21608 .option gnutls_require_mac smtp string unset
21609 This option controls the MAC algorithms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
21610 client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
21611
21612 .option gnutls_require_protocols smtp string unset
21613 This option controls the protocols when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
21614 client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
21615
21616 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
21617 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
21618 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
21619 implementations of TLS.
21620
21621 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
21622 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
21623 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
21624 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
21625 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
21626 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
21627 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
21628 option is:
21629 .code
21630 $primary_hostname
21631 .endd
21632 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
21633 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
21634 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
21635 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
21636 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
21637 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
21638 interface address, you could use this:
21639 .code
21640 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
21641 {$primary_hostname}}
21642 .endd
21643 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
21644 callouts.
21645
21646 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
21647 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
21648 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
21649 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
21650 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
21651 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
21652
21653 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
21654 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
21655 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
21656 &%hosts_override%& is set.
21657
21658 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
21659 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
21660 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
21661 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
21662 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
21663 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
21664 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
21665
21666 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
21667 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
21668 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
21669 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
21670 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
21671 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
21672 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
21673 address are used.
21674
21675 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
21676 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
21677
21678
21679 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
21680 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
21681 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
21682 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
21683 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
21684 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
21685 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
21686 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
21687 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
21688 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
21689
21690
21691 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
21692 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
21693 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
21694 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
21695
21696
21697 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
21698 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
21699 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
21700 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21701
21702
21703 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
21704 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
21705 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
21706 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
21707 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
21708 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
21709 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
21710 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
21711
21712
21713 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
21714 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
21715 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
21716 why it exists.
21717
21718
21719
21720 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
21721 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
21722 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
21723 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
21724 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
21725 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
21726 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
21727 explanation of when this might be needed.
21728
21729
21730 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
21731 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
21732 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
21733 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
21734 &%fallback_hosts%&.
21735
21736
21737 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
21738 .cindex "randomized host list"
21739 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
21740 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
21741 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
21742 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
21743 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
21744 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
21745 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
21746 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
21747
21748 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
21749 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
21750 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
21751 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
21752 .code
21753 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
21754 .endd
21755 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
21756 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
21757 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
21758
21759 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
21760 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
21761 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
21762 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
21763 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
21764 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
21765 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
21766 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
21767 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
21768
21769
21770 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
21771 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
21772 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
21773 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21774 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
21775 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
21776
21777 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
21778 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
21779 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
21780 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
21781 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
21782 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
21783 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
21784
21785 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
21786 .cindex "bind IP address"
21787 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
21788 .vindex "&$host$&"
21789 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21790 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
21791 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
21792 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
21793 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
21794 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
21795 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
21796 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
21797 unknown.
21798
21799 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
21800 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
21801 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
21802 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
21803 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
21804 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
21805 .code
21806 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
21807 .endd
21808 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
21809 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
21810 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
21811 interface to use if the host has more than one.
21812
21813
21814 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
21815 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
21816 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
21817 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
21818 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
21819 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
21820 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
21821 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
21822 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
21823 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
21824 unreachable hosts.
21825
21826
21827 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
21828 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
21829 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
21830 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
21831 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
21832
21833 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
21834 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
21835 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
21836 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
21837 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
21838 permits this.
21839
21840
21841 .option multi_domain smtp boolean true
21842 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21843 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
21844 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
21845 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
21846 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
21847 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
21848 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
21849
21850
21851 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
21852 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
21853 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
21854 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
21855 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
21856 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
21857 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
21858 variable that contains an outgoing port.
21859
21860 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
21861 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
21862 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
21863 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
21864 is deferred.
21865
21866
21867
21868 .option protocol smtp string smtp
21869 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
21870 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
21871 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
21872 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
21873 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
21874 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
21875
21876
21877 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean true
21878 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
21879 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
21880 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
21881 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
21882 addresses is not affected.
21883
21884 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
21885 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
21886 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
21887 Exim to use only the host name. This should normally be done on a separate
21888 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, set up specially to handle the dialup
21889 hosts.
21890
21891
21892 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
21893 .cindex "serializing connections"
21894 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
21895 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
21896 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
21897 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
21898 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
21899 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
21900 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
21901
21902 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
21903 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
21904 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
21905 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
21906 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21907 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21908
21909 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
21910 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21911 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21912 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21913 are used for ETRN serialization.
21914
21915
21916 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
21917 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21918 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
21919 .cindex "size" "of message"
21920 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21921 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21922 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
21923 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
21924 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
21925 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
21926 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
21927 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
21928
21929 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
21930 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
21931
21932
21933 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
21934 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
21935 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
21936 .vindex "&$host$&"
21937 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21938 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
21939 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
21940 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
21941 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
21942 details of TLS.
21943
21944 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
21945 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
21946 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
21947 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
21948 client.
21949
21950
21951 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
21952 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
21953 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
21954 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
21955 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
21956
21957
21958 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
21959 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
21960 .vindex "&$host$&"
21961 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21962 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
21963 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
21964 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
21965 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
21966 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
21967 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
21968 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21969
21970
21971 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
21972 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
21973 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
21974 .vindex "&$host$&"
21975 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21976 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
21977 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
21978 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
21979 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
21980 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
21981 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
21982 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
21983 ciphers is a preference order.
21984
21985
21986
21987 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
21988 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
21989 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
21990 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
21991 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
21992 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
21993 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
21994 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
21995 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
21996 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
21997 in clear.
21998
21999
22000 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! unset
22001 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
22002 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
22003 .vindex "&$host$&"
22004 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22005 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file containing
22006 permitted server certificates, for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
22007 Alternatively, if you are using OpenSSL, you can set
22008 &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a directory containing certificate
22009 files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the option must be set to the name of a
22010 single file if you are using GnuTLS. The values of &$host$& and
22011 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22012 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22013
22014
22015
22016
22017 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
22018 "SECTvalhosmax"
22019 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
22020 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
22021 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
22022 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
22023 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
22024
22025
22026 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
22027 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
22028 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
22029 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
22030 retrying.
22031
22032 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
22033 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
22034 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
22035
22036 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
22037 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
22038 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
22039 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
22040 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
22041
22042 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
22043 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
22044 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
22045 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
22046 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
22047 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
22048 see below for an exception).
22049
22050 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
22051 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
22052 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
22053 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
22054 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
22055
22056 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
22057 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
22058 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
22059 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
22060 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
22061 reached their retry times.
22062
22063 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
22064 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
22065 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
22066 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
22067 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
22068 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
22069 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
22070 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
22071 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
22072 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
22073 reached.
22074
22075 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
22076 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
22077 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
22078 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
22079 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
22080 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
22081
22082 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
22083 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
22084 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
22085 possible IP addresses have been tried.
22086 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
22087 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
22088
22089
22090
22091
22092
22093 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22094 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22095
22096 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
22097 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
22098 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
22099 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
22100 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
22101 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
22102
22103 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
22104 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
22105 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
22106 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
22107 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
22108 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
22109 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
22110
22111 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
22112 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
22113 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
22114 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
22115
22116
22117 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
22118 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
22119 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
22120 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
22121
22122 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
22123 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
22124 facility; you do not have to use it.
22125
22126 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
22127 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
22128 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
22129 address to which it applies.
22130
22131 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
22132 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
22133 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
22134 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
22135 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
22136 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
22137 rules.
22138
22139 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
22140 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
22141 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
22142 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
22143
22144
22145 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
22146 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
22147 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
22148 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
22149 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
22150 discouraged.
22151
22152 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
22153 illustrated by these examples:
22154
22155 .ilist
22156 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
22157 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
22158 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
22159 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
22160 .next
22161 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
22162 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
22163 .endlist
22164
22165
22166
22167 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
22168 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
22169 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
22170 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
22171 message's processing.
22172
22173 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22174 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
22175 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
22176 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
22177 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
22178 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
22179 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
22180 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
22181 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
22182
22183 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22184 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22185 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
22186 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
22187 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
22188 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
22189 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
22190 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
22191 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
22192 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
22193
22194 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
22195 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
22196 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
22197 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
22198 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
22199 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
22200
22201 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
22202 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
22203 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
22204
22205 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
22206 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
22207 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
22208 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
22209 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
22210 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
22211 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
22212 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
22213 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
22214
22215 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
22216 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
22217 transport time.
22218
22219
22220
22221
22222 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
22223 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
22224 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
22225 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
22226 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
22227 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
22228 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
22229 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
22230 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
22231 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
22232 .code
22233 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
22234 .endd
22235 might produce the output
22236 .code
22237 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22238 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22239 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22240 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22241 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22242 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22243 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22244 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22245 .endd
22246 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
22247 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
22248 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
22249 set for a particular transport.
22250
22251
22252 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
22253 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
22254 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
22255 rules in the form
22256 .display
22257 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
22258 .endd
22259 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
22260 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
22261 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
22262 any colons must be doubled, of course).
22263
22264 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
22265 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
22266 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
22267 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
22268 ignored.
22269
22270 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
22271 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
22272 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
22273
22274 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
22275 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
22276 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
22277 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
22278 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
22279 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
22280 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
22281
22282 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22283 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22284 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
22285 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
22286 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
22287 .code
22288 *@* ${lookup ...
22289 .endd
22290 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
22291 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
22292
22293
22294 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
22295 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
22296 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
22297 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
22298 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
22299 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
22300 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
22301 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
22302 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
22303
22304 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
22305 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
22306 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
22307
22308 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
22309 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
22310 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
22311 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
22312 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
22313 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
22314 of pattern they are set as follows:
22315
22316 .ilist
22317 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
22318 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
22319 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
22320 pattern
22321 .code
22322 *queen@*.fict.example
22323 .endd
22324 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
22325 .code
22326 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
22327 $1 = hearts-
22328 $2 = wonderland
22329 .endd
22330 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
22331 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
22332
22333 .next
22334 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
22335 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
22336 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
22337 rewriting rule of the form
22338 .display
22339 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
22340 .endd
22341 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
22342 .code
22343 $1 = foo
22344 $2 = bar
22345 $3 = baz.example
22346 .endd
22347 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
22348 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
22349 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
22350 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
22351 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
22352 .endlist
22353
22354
22355 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
22356 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
22357 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
22358 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
22359 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
22360 .code
22361 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
22362 .endd
22363 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
22364 &'From:'& headers.
22365
22366 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22367 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22368 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
22369 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
22370 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
22371 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
22372 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
22373 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
22374 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
22375 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
22376 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
22377 entry written to the panic log.
22378
22379
22380
22381 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
22382 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
22383
22384 .ilist
22385 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
22386 c, f, h, r, s, t.
22387 .next
22388 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
22389 .next
22390 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
22391 .endlist
22392
22393 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
22394 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
22395
22396
22397
22398 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
22399 "SECID154"
22400 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
22401 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
22402 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
22403 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
22404 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
22405 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
22406 .display
22407 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
22408 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
22409 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
22410 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
22411 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
22412 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
22413 &`h`& rewrite all headers
22414 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
22415 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
22416 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
22417 .endd
22418 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
22419 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
22420 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
22421
22422 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
22423 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
22424
22425
22426 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
22427 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
22428 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
22429 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
22430 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
22431 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
22432 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
22433 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
22434 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
22435
22436 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22437 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22438 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
22439 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
22440 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
22441 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
22442 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
22443 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
22444
22445
22446 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
22447 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
22448 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
22449 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
22450
22451 .ilist
22452 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
22453 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
22454 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
22455 .next
22456 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
22457 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
22458 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
22459 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
22460 .next
22461 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
22462 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
22463 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
22464 .next
22465 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
22466 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
22467 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
22468 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
22469 .code
22470 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
22471 .endd
22472 into
22473 .code
22474 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
22475 .endd
22476 .cindex "RFC 2047"
22477 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
22478 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
22479 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
22480 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
22481 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
22482 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
22483 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
22484 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
22485
22486 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
22487 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
22488 .endlist
22489
22490
22491 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
22492 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
22493 .code
22494 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
22495 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
22496 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
22497 .endd
22498 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
22499 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
22500 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
22501 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
22502 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
22503 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
22504 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
22505 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
22506
22507 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
22508 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
22509 .code
22510 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
22511 .endd
22512 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
22513 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
22514
22515 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
22516 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
22517 messages that originate outside the local host:
22518 .code
22519 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
22520 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
22521 .endd
22522 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
22523 space.
22524
22525 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
22526 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
22527 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
22528 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
22529 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
22530 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
22531 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
22532 components. For example, the rule
22533 .code
22534 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
22535 .endd
22536 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
22537 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
22538 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
22539 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
22540 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
22541 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
22542 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
22543 .ecindex IIDaddrew
22544
22545
22546
22547
22548
22549 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22550 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22551
22552 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
22553 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
22554 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
22555 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
22556 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
22557 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
22558 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
22559 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
22560 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
22561 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
22562 address, domain and error.
22563
22564 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
22565 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
22566 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
22567 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
22568 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
22569 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
22570 log selector is set, the message
22571 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
22572 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
22573 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
22574 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
22575
22576 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
22577 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
22578 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
22579 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
22580 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
22581 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
22582 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
22583 domain are maintained independently.
22584
22585 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
22586 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
22587 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
22588 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
22589 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
22590 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
22591 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
22592 the local address is reached.
22593
22594 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
22595 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
22596 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
22597 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
22598 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
22599
22600 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
22601 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
22602 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
22603 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
22604 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
22605 messages that it should now be retaining.
22606
22607
22608
22609 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
22610 .cindex "retry" "rules"
22611 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
22612 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
22613 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
22614 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
22615 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
22616 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
22617 message's sender, respectively.
22618
22619
22620 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
22621 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
22622 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
22623 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
22624 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
22625 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
22626 example,
22627 .code
22628 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22629 .endd
22630 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
22631 whereas
22632 .code
22633 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22634 .endd
22635 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
22636 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
22637 part.
22638
22639 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
22640 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a routing rule pattern, it
22641 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
22642 expressions work in address lists.
22643 .display
22644 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
22645 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
22646 .endd
22647
22648
22649 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
22650 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
22651 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
22652 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
22653 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
22654 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
22655 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
22656 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
22657 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
22658
22659 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
22660 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
22661 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
22662 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
22663 local transports).
22664
22665 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
22666 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
22667 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
22668 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
22669 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
22670 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
22671 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
22672 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
22673 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
22674 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
22675 commands.
22676
22677
22678
22679 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
22680 "SECID160"
22681 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
22682 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
22683 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
22684 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
22685 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
22686 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
22687 .code
22688 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
22689 MX 6 p.q.r.example
22690 MX 7 m.n.o.example
22691 .endd
22692 and the retry rules are
22693 .code
22694 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
22695 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
22696 .endd
22697 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
22698 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
22699 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
22700 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
22701 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
22702 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
22703
22704 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
22705 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
22706 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
22707 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
22708
22709 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
22710 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
22711 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
22712 .code
22713 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
22714 .endd
22715 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
22716 textual form of the IP address.
22717
22718 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
22719 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
22720 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
22721 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
22722
22723 .vlist
22724 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
22725 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
22726 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
22727
22728 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
22729 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
22730 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
22731
22732 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
22733 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
22734
22735 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
22736 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
22737 .endlist
22738
22739 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
22740 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
22741 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
22742 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
22743 retry rule of this form:
22744 .code
22745 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
22746 .endd
22747 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
22748 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
22749
22750 .vlist
22751 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
22752 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
22753 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
22754 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
22755
22756 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
22757 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
22758
22759 .vitem &%refused_A%&
22760 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
22761
22762 .vitem &%refused%&
22763 A connection was refused.
22764
22765 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
22766 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
22767
22768 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
22769 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
22770
22771 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
22772 A connection attempt timed out.
22773
22774 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
22775 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
22776 obtained from an MX record.
22777
22778 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
22779 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
22780 obtained from an MX record.
22781
22782 .vitem &%timeout%&
22783 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
22784
22785 .vitem &%tls_required%&
22786 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
22787 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
22788 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
22789
22790 .vitem &%quota%&
22791 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
22792 transport.
22793
22794 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
22795 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
22796 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
22797 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
22798 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
22799 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
22800 for four days.
22801 .endlist
22802
22803 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
22804 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
22805 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
22806 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
22807 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
22808 heuristic rules:
22809
22810 .ilist
22811 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
22812 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
22813 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
22814 .next
22815 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
22816 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
22817 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
22818 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
22819 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
22820 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
22821 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
22822 .next
22823 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
22824 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
22825 .endlist
22826
22827 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
22828 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
22829 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
22830 error).
22831
22832
22833
22834 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
22835 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
22836 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
22837 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
22838 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
22839 form:
22840 .display
22841 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
22842 .endd
22843 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
22844 .code
22845 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
22846 .endd
22847 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
22848 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
22849 For example:
22850 .code
22851 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
22852 .endd
22853 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
22854 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
22855 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
22856 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
22857 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
22858
22859 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
22860 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
22861 .code
22862 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
22863 .endd
22864 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
22865 list is never matched.
22866
22867
22868
22869
22870
22871 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
22872 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
22873 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
22874 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
22875 .display
22876 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
22877 .endd
22878 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
22879 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
22880 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
22881 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
22882 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
22883
22884 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
22885 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
22886 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
22887 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
22888 The available algorithms are:
22889
22890 .ilist
22891 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
22892 the interval.
22893 .next
22894 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
22895 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
22896 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
22897 .next
22898 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
22899 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
22900 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
22901 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
22902 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
22903 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
22904 queue processing times.
22905 .endlist
22906
22907 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
22908 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
22909 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
22910 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
22911 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
22912 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
22913 interval is found. The main configuration variable
22914 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
22915 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
22916 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
22917 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
22918 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
22919
22920 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
22921 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
22922 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
22923 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
22924 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
22925 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
22926 time.
22927
22928 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
22929 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
22930 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
22931 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
22932 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
22933 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
22934 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
22935 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
22936 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
22937 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
22938 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
22939 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
22940
22941 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
22942 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
22943 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
22944 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
22945 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
22946 deliveries that have been deferred.
22947
22948
22949 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
22950 Here are some example retry rules:
22951 .code
22952 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
22953 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
22954 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
22955 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22956 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
22957 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
22958 .endd
22959 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
22960 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
22961 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
22962 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
22963 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
22964 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
22965 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
22966 days.
22967
22968 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
22969 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
22970 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
22971 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
22972 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
22973
22974 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
22975 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
22976 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
22977 were not obtained from an MX record.
22978
22979 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
22980 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
22981 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
22982 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
22983 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
22984
22985
22986
22987 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
22988 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
22989 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
22990 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
22991 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
22992 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
22993 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
22994 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
22995 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
22996 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
22997 failing for the first time.
22998
22999 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
23000 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
23001 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
23002 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
23003
23004 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
23005 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
23006 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
23007
23008
23009
23010
23011 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
23012 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
23013 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
23014 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
23015 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
23016 default retry rule:
23017 .code
23018 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
23019 .endd
23020 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
23021 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
23022 failure for the recipient address that counts.
23023
23024 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
23025 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
23026 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
23027 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
23028 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
23029
23030 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
23031 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
23032 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
23033
23034 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
23035 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
23036 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
23037 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
23038 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
23039 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
23040 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
23041 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
23042
23043 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
23044 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
23045 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
23046 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
23047 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
23048 notice.
23049
23050 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23051 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
23052 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23053 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
23054 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
23055 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
23056 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
23057 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
23058 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
23059 true.
23060
23061 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
23062 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
23063 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
23064 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
23065 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
23066 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
23067 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
23068 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
23069 reached.
23070
23071 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
23072 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
23073 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
23074 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
23075 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
23076 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
23077 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
23078 time out the address.
23079
23080 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
23081 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
23082 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
23083 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
23084 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
23085 considered immediately.
23086 .ecindex IIDretconf1
23087 .ecindex IIDregconf2
23088
23089
23090
23091
23092
23093
23094 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23095 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23096
23097 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
23098 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
23099 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
23100 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
23101 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
23102 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
23103 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
23104 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
23105 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
23106 other.
23107
23108 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
23109 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
23110
23111 .ilist
23112 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
23113 the client's EHLO command.
23114 .next
23115 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
23116 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
23117 .next
23118 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
23119 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
23120 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
23121 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
23122 with the AUTH command.
23123 .next
23124 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
23125 .next
23126 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
23127 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
23128 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
23129 connection.
23130 .next
23131 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
23132 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
23133 unauthenticated connection.
23134 .endlist
23135
23136 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
23137 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
23138 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
23139 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
23140 .display
23141 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
23142 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
23143 &`Connected to server.example.`&
23144 &`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
23145 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
23146 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
23147 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
23148 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
23149 &`250-PIPELINING`&
23150 &`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
23151 &`250 HELP`&
23152 .endd
23153 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
23154 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
23155 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
23156 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
23157 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
23158 included by setting
23159 .code
23160 AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
23161 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
23162 AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
23163 AUTH_SPA=yes
23164 .endd
23165 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
23166 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
23167 the Cyrus SASL authentication library. The third can be configured to support
23168 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
23169 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The fourth authenticator
23170 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
23171
23172 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
23173 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
23174 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
23175 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
23176 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
23177 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
23178 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
23179
23180 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
23181 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
23182 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
23183 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
23184 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
23185 both sets of options, is required. For example:
23186 .code
23187 cram:
23188 driver = cram_md5
23189 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23190 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
23191 client_name = ph10
23192 client_secret = secret2
23193 .endd
23194 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
23195 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
23196
23197 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
23198 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
23199 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
23200 in Exim.
23201
23202
23203
23204 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
23205 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
23206 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
23207
23208 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23209 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
23210 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
23211 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
23212 encrypted by a setting such as:
23213 .code
23214 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_cipher}{}}
23215 .endd
23216 (Older documentation incorrectly states that &$tls_cipher$& contains the cipher
23217 used for incoming messages. In fact, during SMTP delivery, it contains the
23218 cipher used for the delivery.)
23219
23220
23221 .option driver authenticators string unset
23222 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
23223 authenticators is to be used.
23224
23225
23226 .option public_name authenticators string unset
23227 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
23228 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
23229 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
23230 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
23231 defaults to the driver's instance name.
23232
23233
23234 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23235 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
23236 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
23237 mechanism is not advertised.
23238 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
23239 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
23240 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
23241
23242
23243 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23244 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
23245 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
23246 for details.
23247
23248 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
23249 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
23250 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
23251 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
23252 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
23253 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
23254 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
23255 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
23256 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
23257 the error text.
23258
23259
23260 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
23261 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
23262 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
23263 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
23264 out the values of variables.
23265 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
23266 output, and Exim carries on processing.
23267
23268
23269 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
23270 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23271 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
23272 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
23273 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
23274 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
23275 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
23276 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
23277 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
23278
23279
23280 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23281 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
23282 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
23283 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
23284 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
23285 remembered for later use.
23286 How it is used is described in the following section.
23287
23288
23289
23290
23291
23292 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
23293 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
23294 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
23295 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
23296 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
23297 message:
23298
23299 .ilist
23300 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
23301 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
23302 .next
23303 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
23304 .next
23305 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
23306 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
23307 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
23308 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
23309 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
23310 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
23311 given for the MAIL command.
23312 .next
23313 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
23314 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
23315 authenticated.
23316 .next
23317 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
23318 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
23319 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
23320 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
23321 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
23322 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
23323 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
23324 message.
23325 .endlist
23326
23327
23328 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
23329 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
23330 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
23331 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
23332
23333 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23334 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
23335 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
23336 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
23337 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
23338 ACL is run.
23339
23340
23341
23342 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
23343 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
23344 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
23345 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
23346 conditions:
23347
23348 .ilist
23349 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
23350 .next
23351 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
23352 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
23353 .endlist
23354
23355 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
23356 the mechanisms are advertised.
23357
23358 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
23359 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
23360 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
23361 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
23362 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
23363 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
23364 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
23365 .code
23366 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
23367 .endd
23368 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
23369
23370 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
23371 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
23372 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
23373 such as:
23374 .code
23375 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
23376 .endd
23377 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
23378 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
23379 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
23380
23381 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
23382 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
23383 command. This is the case if
23384
23385 .ilist
23386 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
23387 .next
23388 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
23389 .next
23390 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
23391 server authenticators.
23392 .endlist
23393
23394
23395 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
23396 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
23397 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
23398
23399 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
23400 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
23401 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
23402 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
23403 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
23404 rejected with a 504 error.
23405
23406 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
23407 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
23408 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
23409 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
23410 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
23411 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
23412 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
23413 no successful authentication.
23414
23415
23416
23417
23418 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
23419 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
23420 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
23421 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
23422 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
23423 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
23424 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
23425 script:
23426 .code
23427 use MIME::Base64;
23428 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
23429 .endd
23430 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
23431 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
23432 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
23433 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
23434 command line to run this script on such data might be
23435 .code
23436 encode '\0user\0password'
23437 .endd
23438 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
23439 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
23440 whose code value is zero.
23441
23442 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
23443 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
23444 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
23445 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
23446
23447 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
23448 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
23449 example, a command such as
23450 .code
23451 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
23452 .endd
23453 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
23454
23455 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
23456 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
23457 .code
23458 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
23459 .endd
23460 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
23461 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
23462 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
23463 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
23464
23465
23466
23467 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
23468 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
23469 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
23470 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
23471 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
23472 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
23473
23474 .ilist
23475 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
23476 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
23477 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
23478 of the authenticator.
23479 .next
23480 .vindex "&$host$&"
23481 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23482 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
23483 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
23484 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
23485 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
23486 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
23487 delivery to be deferred.
23488 .next
23489 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
23490 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
23491 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
23492 usual way.
23493 .next
23494 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
23495 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
23496 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
23497 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
23498 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
23499 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
23500 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
23501 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
23502 deliver the message unauthenticated.
23503 .endlist
23504
23505 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
23506 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
23507 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
23508 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
23509 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
23510 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
23511 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
23512 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
23513 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
23514 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
23515 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
23516 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
23517 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
23518
23519
23520
23521
23522
23523
23524 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23525 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23526
23527 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
23528 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
23529 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
23530 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
23531 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
23532 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
23533 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
23534 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
23535 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
23536 connections as you do for login accounts.
23537
23538 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
23539 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
23540 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
23541
23542 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23543 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
23544 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
23545
23546 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
23547 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
23548 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
23549 given.
23550
23551 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
23552 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23553 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23554 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
23555 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23556 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
23557 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23558
23559 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
23560 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
23561 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
23562 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
23563 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
23564 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
23565 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
23566
23567 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
23568 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
23569 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
23570 string expansions that also use them for other things.
23571
23572 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
23573 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
23574 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
23575
23576 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23577 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
23578 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
23579 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
23580 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
23581 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
23582 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
23583 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
23584 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
23585 string as the error text.
23586
23587 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
23588 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
23589 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
23590
23591
23592
23593 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
23594 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
23595 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
23596 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23597 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
23598 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
23599 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
23600 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
23601
23602 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
23603 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
23604 configured as follows:
23605 .code
23606 fixed_plain:
23607 driver = plaintext
23608 public_name = PLAIN
23609 server_prompts = :
23610 server_condition = \
23611 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
23612 server_set_id = $auth2
23613 .endd
23614 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
23615 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
23616 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
23617 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
23618
23619 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
23620 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
23621 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
23622 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
23623 .code
23624 250-AUTH PLAIN
23625 .endd
23626 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
23627 .code
23628 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
23629 .endd
23630 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
23631 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
23632 .code
23633 AUTH PLAIN
23634 .endd
23635 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
23636 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
23637
23638 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
23639 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
23640 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
23641 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
23642 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
23643
23644 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
23645 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
23646 authenticating clients it could make sense.
23647
23648 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
23649 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
23650 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
23651 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
23652 This is an incorrect example:
23653 .code
23654 server_condition = \
23655 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
23656 .endd
23657 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
23658 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
23659 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
23660 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
23661 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
23662 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
23663 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
23664 .code
23665 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
23666 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
23667 .endd
23668 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
23669 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
23670 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
23671 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
23672 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
23673
23674
23675 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
23676 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
23677 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
23678 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
23679 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
23680 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
23681 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
23682 .code
23683 fixed_login:
23684 driver = plaintext
23685 public_name = LOGIN
23686 server_prompts = User Name : Password
23687 server_condition = \
23688 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
23689 server_set_id = $auth1
23690 .endd
23691 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
23692 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
23693 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
23694 strings are used to obtain two data items.
23695
23696 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
23697 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
23698 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
23699 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
23700 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
23701 .code
23702 login:
23703 driver = plaintext
23704 public_name = LOGIN
23705 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
23706 server_condition = ${if and{{
23707 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
23708 ldapauth{user="cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
23709 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
23710 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
23711 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
23712 .endd
23713 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
23714 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
23715 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
23716 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
23717 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
23718 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
23719 uninterpreted string.
23720
23721
23722 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
23723 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
23724 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
23725 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
23726 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
23727 &<<SECTexpcond>>&.
23728
23729
23730
23731
23732 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
23733 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
23734 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
23735
23736 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
23737 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
23738 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
23739 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
23740 usual.
23741
23742 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
23743 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
23744 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
23745 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
23746 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
23747 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
23748 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
23749 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
23750 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
23751 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
23752 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
23753 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
23754
23755 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
23756 splitting takes priority and happens first.
23757
23758 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
23759 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
23760 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
23761 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
23762 the string.
23763
23764 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
23765 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
23766 .code
23767 fixed_plain:
23768 driver = plaintext
23769 public_name = PLAIN
23770 client_send = ^username^mysecret
23771 .endd
23772 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
23773 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
23774 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
23775 .code
23776 fixed_login:
23777 driver = plaintext
23778 public_name = LOGIN
23779 client_send = : username : mysecret
23780 .endd
23781 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
23782 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
23783 prompts.
23784 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
23785 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
23786
23787
23788
23789
23790 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23791 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23792
23793 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
23794 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
23795 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
23796 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
23797 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
23798 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
23799 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
23800 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
23801 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
23802 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
23803 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
23804 available in plain text at either end.
23805
23806
23807 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
23808 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
23809 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
23810 authenticator as a server:
23811
23812 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
23813 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
23814 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
23815 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
23816 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
23817 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
23818 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
23819 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
23820 returned to the client.
23821
23822 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
23823 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
23824 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
23825 numeric variables for other things.
23826
23827 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
23828 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
23829 user name, authentication fails.
23830 .code
23831 fixed_cram:
23832 driver = cram_md5
23833 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23834 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
23835 server_set_id = $auth1
23836 .endd
23837 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23838 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
23839 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
23840 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
23841 .code
23842 lookup_cram:
23843 driver = cram_md5
23844 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23845 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
23846 {$value}fail}
23847 server_set_id = $auth1
23848 .endd
23849 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
23850 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
23851
23852
23853 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
23854 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
23855 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
23856
23857
23858
23859 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
23860 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
23861 computing the response to the server's challenge.
23862
23863
23864 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
23865 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
23866 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
23867
23868
23869 .vindex "&$host$&"
23870 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23871 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
23872 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
23873 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
23874 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
23875 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
23876 send the message to the current server.
23877
23878 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
23879 strings, is:
23880 .code
23881 fixed_cram:
23882 driver = cram_md5
23883 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23884 client_name = ph10
23885 client_secret = secret
23886 .endd
23887 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
23888 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
23889
23890
23891
23892 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23893 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23894
23895 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
23896 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
23897 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
23898 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
23899 .cindex "Kerberos"
23900 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
23901 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
23902
23903 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
23904 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
23905 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
23906 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
23907 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
23908
23909 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
23910 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
23911 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
23912 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
23913
23914 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
23915 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
23916 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
23917 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
23918 depending on the driver you are using.
23919
23920 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
23921 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
23922 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
23923 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
23924 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
23925 implementation. For example, for Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
23926 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
23927 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
23928 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
23929
23930
23931 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
23932 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
23933 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
23934 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
23935 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
23936 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
23937 things.
23938
23939
23940 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
23941 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
23942 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
23943 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
23944
23945
23946 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
23947 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
23948 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
23949 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
23950 example:
23951 .code
23952 sasl:
23953 driver = cyrus_sasl
23954 public_name = X-ANYTHING
23955 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
23956 server_set_id = $auth1
23957 .endd
23958
23959 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string unset
23960 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
23961
23962
23963 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
23964 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
23965
23966
23967 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
23968 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
23969 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
23970 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
23971 .code
23972 sasl_cram_md5:
23973 driver = cyrus_sasl
23974 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23975 server_set_id = $auth1
23976
23977 sasl_plain:
23978 driver = cyrus_sasl
23979 public_name = PLAIN
23980 server_set_id = $auth2
23981 .endd
23982 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
23983 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
23984 but it is present in many binary distributions.
23985 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
23986 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
23987
23988
23989
23990
23991 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23992 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23993 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
23994 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
23995 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
23996 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
23997 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
23998 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
23999 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
24000 authenticator only. There is only one option:
24001
24002 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
24003
24004 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
24005 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
24006 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
24007 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
24008 .code
24009 dovecot_plain:
24010 driver = dovecot
24011 public_name = PLAIN
24012 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
24013 server_set_id = $auth2
24014
24015 dovecot_ntlm:
24016 driver = dovecot
24017 public_name = NTLM
24018 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
24019 server_set_id = $auth1
24020 .endd
24021 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
24022 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
24023 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
24024 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
24025 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
24026 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
24027 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
24028 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
24029
24030
24031 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24032 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24033
24034 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
24035 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
24036 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
24037 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
24038 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
24039 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
24040 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
24041 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
24042 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
24043 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
24044 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
24045 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
24046 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
24047 follows:
24048
24049 .ilist
24050 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
24051 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
24052 .next
24053 The server sends back a challenge.
24054 .next
24055 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
24056 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
24057 .endlist
24058
24059 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
24060
24061
24062
24063 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
24064 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
24065 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
24066
24067 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
24068 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
24069 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
24070 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
24071 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
24072 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
24073 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
24074 for other things. For example:
24075 .code
24076 spa:
24077 driver = spa
24078 public_name = NTLM
24079 server_password = \
24080 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
24081 .endd
24082 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
24083 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
24084
24085
24086
24087
24088
24089 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
24090 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
24091 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
24092
24093
24094
24095 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
24096 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
24097
24098
24099 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
24100 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
24101
24102
24103 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
24104 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
24105 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
24106 &'msn.com'&:
24107 .code
24108 msn:
24109 driver = spa
24110 public_name = MSN
24111 client_username = msn/msn_username
24112 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
24113 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
24114 .endd
24115 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
24116 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
24117
24118
24119
24120
24121
24122 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24123 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24124
24125 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
24126 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
24127 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
24128 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
24129 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
24130 .cindex "OpenSSL"
24131 .cindex "GnuTLS"
24132 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
24133 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
24134 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
24135 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
24136 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
24137 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
24138 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
24139 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
24140 certificates are used.
24141
24142 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
24143 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
24144 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
24145 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
24146 between them is encrypted.
24147
24148 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
24149 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
24150 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
24151 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
24152 encryption state.
24153
24154 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
24155 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
24156 in order to get TLS to work.
24157
24158
24159
24160 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
24161 "SECID284"
24162 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
24163 .cindex "smtps protocol"
24164 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
24165 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
24166 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
24167 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
24168 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
24169 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
24170 allocated for this purpose.
24171
24172 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
24173 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
24174 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
24175 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
24176 .code
24177 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
24178 .endd
24179 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
24180 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
24181 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
24182 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
24183 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
24184 defined elsewhere.
24185
24186 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
24187 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
24188
24189
24190
24191
24192
24193
24194 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
24195 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
24196 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
24197 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
24198 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
24199 .code
24200 USE_GNUTLS=yes
24201 .endd
24202 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
24203 .code
24204 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
24205 .endd
24206 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
24207 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
24208
24209 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
24210
24211 .ilist
24212 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must contain the name of a file, not the
24213 name of a directory (for OpenSSL it can be either).
24214 .next
24215 The &%tls_dhparam%& option is ignored, because early versions of GnuTLS had no
24216 facility for varying its Diffie-Hellman parameters. I understand that this has
24217 changed, but Exim has not been updated to provide this facility.
24218 .next
24219 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
24220 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
24221 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
24222 affects the value of the &$tls_peerdn$& variable.
24223 .next
24224 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
24225 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS uses underscores, for example: RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is
24226 more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present in a cipher list. To make
24227 life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens for OpenSSL and hyphens to
24228 underscores for GnuTLS when processing lists of cipher suites in the
24229 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
24230 option).
24231 .next
24232 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
24233 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
24234 .endlist
24235
24236
24237 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECID181"
24238 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
24239 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
24240 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
24241 &_gnutls-params_&. The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
24242 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
24243 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
24244 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
24245 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
24246 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
24247 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
24248
24249 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
24250 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
24251 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
24252 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
24253 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
24254 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
24255 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
24256 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
24257
24258 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
24259 in &_gnutls-params_& in PEM format, which means that they can be generated
24260 externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
24261
24262 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
24263 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
24264 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
24265 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
24266 .code
24267 # rm -f new-params
24268 # touch new-params
24269 # chown exim:exim new-params
24270 # chmod 0400 new-params
24271 # certtool --generate-privkey --bits 512 >new-params
24272 # echo "" >>new-params
24273 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 1024 >> new-params
24274 # mv new-params gnutls-params
24275 .endd
24276 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
24277 stalling is removed.
24278
24279
24280 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
24281 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
24282 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
24283 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
24284 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
24285 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
24286 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
24287 directly to this function call. The following quotation from the OpenSSL
24288 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
24289
24290 .ilist
24291 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
24292 .next
24293 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
24294 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
24295 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
24296 SSL v3 algorithms.
24297 .next
24298 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
24299 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
24300 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
24301 algorithms.
24302 .endlist
24303
24304 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
24305 &`-`& or &`+`&.
24306 .ilist
24307 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
24308 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
24309 stated.
24310 .next
24311 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
24312 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
24313 .next
24314 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
24315 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
24316 .endlist
24317
24318 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
24319 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
24320 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
24321 not be moved to the end of the list.
24322 .endlist
24323
24324
24325
24326 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
24327 "SECTreqciphgnu"
24328 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
24329 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
24330 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
24331 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
24332 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
24333 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
24334 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to specify separate lists of permitted key
24335 exchange methods, main cipher algorithms, MAC algorithms, and protocols.
24336 Unfortunately, these lists are numerical, and the library does not have a
24337 function for turning names into numbers. Consequently, lists of recognized
24338 names have to be built into the application. The permitted key exchange
24339 methods, ciphers, and MAC algorithms may be used in any combination to form a
24340 cipher suite. This is unlike OpenSSL, where complete cipher suite names are
24341 passed to its control function.
24342
24343 For compatibility with OpenSSL, the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option can be set
24344 to complete cipher suite names such as RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA, but for GnuTLS this
24345 option controls only the cipher algorithms. Exim searches each item in the
24346 list for the name of an available algorithm. For example, if the list
24347 contains RSA_AES_SHA, then AES is recognized, and the behaviour is exactly
24348 the same as if just AES were given.
24349
24350 .oindex "&%gnutls_require_kx%&"
24351 .oindex "&%gnutls_require_mac%&"
24352 .oindex "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&"
24353 There are additional options called &%gnutls_require_kx%&,
24354 &%gnutls_require_mac%&, and &%gnutls_require_protocols%& that can be used to
24355 restrict the key exchange methods, MAC algorithms, and protocols, respectively.
24356 These options are ignored if OpenSSL is in use.
24357
24358 All four options are available as global options, controlling how Exim
24359 behaves as a server, and also as options of the &(smtp)& transport, controlling
24360 how Exim behaves as a client. All the values are string expanded. After
24361 expansion, the values must be colon-separated lists, though the separator
24362 can be changed in the usual way.
24363
24364 Each of the four lists starts out with a default set of algorithms. If the
24365 first item in a list does &'not'& start with an exclamation mark, all the
24366 default items are deleted. In this case, only those that are explicitly
24367 specified can be used. If the first item in a list &'does'& start with an
24368 exclamation mark, the defaults are left on the list.
24369
24370 Then, any item that starts with an exclamation mark causes the relevant
24371 entry to be removed from the list, and any item that does not start with an
24372 exclamation mark causes a new entry to be added to the list. Unrecognized
24373 items in the list are ignored. Thus:
24374 .code
24375 tls_require_ciphers = !ARCFOUR
24376 .endd
24377 allows all the defaults except ARCFOUR, whereas
24378 .code
24379 tls_require_ciphers = AES : 3DES
24380 .endd
24381 allows only cipher suites that use AES or 3DES.
24382
24383 For &%tls_require_ciphers%& the recognized names are AES_256, AES_128, AES
24384 (both of the preceding), 3DES, ARCFOUR_128, ARCFOUR_40, and ARCFOUR (both of
24385 the preceding). The default list does not contain all of these; it just has
24386 AES_256, AES_128, 3DES, and ARCFOUR_128.
24387
24388 For &%gnutls_require_kx%&, the recognized names are DHE_RSA, RSA (which
24389 includes DHE_RSA), DHE_DSS, and DHE (which includes both DHE_RSA and
24390 DHE_DSS). The default list contains RSA, DHE_DSS, DHE_RSA.
24391
24392 For &%gnutls_require_mac%&, the recognized names are SHA (synonym SHA1), and
24393 MD5. The default list contains SHA, MD5.
24394
24395 For &%gnutls_require_protocols%&, the recognized names are TLS1 and SSL3.
24396 The default list contains TLS1, SSL3.
24397
24398 In a server, the order of items in these lists is unimportant. The server
24399 advertises the availability of all the relevant cipher suites. However, in a
24400 client, the order in the &%tls_require_ciphers%& list specifies a preference
24401 order for the cipher algorithms. The first one in the client's list that is
24402 also advertised by the server is tried first. The default order is as listed
24403 above.
24404
24405
24406
24407 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
24408 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
24409 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
24410 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
24411 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
24412 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
24413 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
24414 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
24415
24416 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
24417 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
24418 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
24419 with the error
24420 .code
24421 554 Security failure
24422 .endd
24423 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
24424 rejected with a 554 error code.
24425
24426 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
24427 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
24428 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
24429 without some further configuration at the server end.
24430
24431 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
24432 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
24433 .code
24434 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
24435 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
24436 .endd
24437 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
24438 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
24439 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
24440 that goes with it. These files need to be readable by the Exim user, and must
24441 always be given as full path names. They can be the same file if both the
24442 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
24443 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
24444 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
24445 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
24446 the server's certificate.
24447
24448 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
24449 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
24450 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
24451
24452 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
24453 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
24454 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
24455 transport.
24456
24457 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
24458 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
24459 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
24460 .code
24461 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
24462 .endd
24463 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
24464 with the parameters contained in the file. This increases the set of cipher
24465 suites that the server supports. See the command
24466 .code
24467 openssl dhparam
24468 .endd
24469 for a way of generating this data. At present, &%tls_dhparam%& is used only
24470 when Exim is linked with OpenSSL. It is ignored if GnuTLS is being used.
24471
24472 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
24473 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
24474 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
24475 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
24476 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
24477
24478 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
24479 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
24480 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
24481 The variable &$tls_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
24482 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
24483 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
24484 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
24485 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
24486 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
24487 (For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_cipher$& is reset &-- see section
24488 &<<SECID185>>&.)
24489
24490 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
24491 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
24492 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
24493 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
24494 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
24495 documentation for more details.
24496
24497
24498 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
24499 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
24500 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
24501 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
24502 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
24503 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
24504 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
24505 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
24506 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
24507 expected certificates. These must be available in a file or,
24508 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, identified by
24509 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
24510
24511 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
24512 directory is used
24513 (OpenSSL only),
24514 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
24515 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
24516 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
24517 .code
24518 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
24519 .endd
24520 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
24521
24522 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
24523 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
24524 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
24525 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
24526 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
24527 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
24528 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
24529 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
24530 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
24531 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
24532
24533 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
24534 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
24535 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
24536 &$tls_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
24537
24538 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
24539 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
24540 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
24541 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
24542 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
24543 certificate is supplied, &$tls_peerdn$& is empty.
24544
24545
24546 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
24547 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
24548 .cindex "revocation list"
24549 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
24550 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
24551 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
24552 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
24553 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
24554 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
24555 CRL in PEM format.
24556
24557
24558 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
24559 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
24560 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
24561 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
24562 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
24563 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
24564 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
24565 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
24566 within the &(smtp)& transport.
24567
24568 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
24569 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
24570 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
24571 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
24572 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
24573
24574 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
24575 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
24576 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
24577 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
24578 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
24579 usual way.
24580
24581 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
24582 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
24583 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
24584 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
24585 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
24586 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
24587 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
24588 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
24589 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
24590 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
24591 unencrypted.
24592
24593 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
24594 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
24595 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
24596 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
24597
24598 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
24599 must name a file or,
24600 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, that contains a collection of
24601 expected server certificates. The client verifies the server's certificate
24602 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
24603 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
24604
24605 If
24606 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
24607 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
24608 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
24609 alternative hosts, if any.
24610
24611 &*Note*&:
24612 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
24613 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
24614 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
24615 client.
24616
24617 .vindex "&$host$&"
24618 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24619 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
24620 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
24621 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
24622 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
24623
24624 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
24625 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
24626 Before an SMTP connection is established, the &$tls_cipher$& and &$tls_peerdn$&
24627 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
24628 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
24629 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
24630 outgoing connection.
24631
24632
24633
24634 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
24635 "SECTmulmessam"
24636 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
24637 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24638 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
24639 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
24640 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
24641 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
24642 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
24643 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
24644 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
24645 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
24646 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
24647
24648 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
24649 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
24650 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
24651 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
24652 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
24653 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
24654 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
24655 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
24656 and delay other deliveries to that host.
24657
24658 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
24659 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
24660 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
24661 information is recorded.
24662
24663 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
24664 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
24665 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
24666
24667
24668
24669
24670 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
24671 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
24672 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
24673 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
24674 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
24675 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
24676 to Apache, currently at
24677 .display
24678 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
24679 .endd
24680 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
24681 links to further files.
24682 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
24683 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
24684 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
24685 .display
24686 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
24687 .endd
24688
24689
24690 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
24691 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
24692 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
24693 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
24694 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
24695 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
24696 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
24697 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
24698 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
24699 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
24700 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
24701 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
24702 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
24703
24704
24705 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
24706 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
24707 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
24708 with OpenSSL, like this:
24709 .code
24710 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
24711 -days 9999 -nodes
24712 .endd
24713 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
24714 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
24715 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
24716 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
24717 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
24718 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
24719 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
24720
24721 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
24722 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
24723 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
24724
24725 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
24726 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
24727 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
24728 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
24729 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
24730 signed with that self-signed certificate.
24731
24732 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
24733 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
24734 Open-source PKI book, available online at
24735 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
24736 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
24737 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
24738
24739
24740
24741 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24742 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24743
24744 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
24745 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
24746 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
24747 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
24748 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
24749 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
24750 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
24751 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
24752 one very small ACL:
24753 .code
24754 begin acl
24755 small_acl:
24756 accept hosts = one.host.only
24757 .endd
24758 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
24759 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
24760
24761 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
24762 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
24763 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
24764 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
24765 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
24766 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
24767 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
24768 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
24769
24770
24771 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
24772 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
24773 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
24774 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
24775 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
24776
24777
24778
24779 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
24780 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
24781 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
24782 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
24783 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
24784 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
24785 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
24786 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
24787 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
24788 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
24789 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
24790 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
24791 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
24792 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
24793 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
24794 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
24795 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
24796 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
24797
24798 .table2 140pt
24799 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
24800 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
24801 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
24802 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
24803 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
24804 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
24805 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
24806 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
24807 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
24808 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
24809 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
24810 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
24811 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
24812 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
24813 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
24814 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
24815 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
24816 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
24817 .endtable
24818
24819 For example, if you set
24820 .code
24821 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
24822 .endd
24823 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
24824 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
24825 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
24826 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
24827 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
24828 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
24829 testing as possible at RCPT time.
24830
24831
24832 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
24833 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
24834 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
24835 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
24836 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
24837 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
24838 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
24839 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
24840 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
24841 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
24842 in any of these ACLs.
24843
24844 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
24845 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
24846 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
24847 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
24848 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
24849 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
24850 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
24851 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
24852 .code
24853 control = suppress_local_fixups
24854 .endd
24855 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
24856 run, it is too late.
24857
24858 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
24859 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
24860
24861 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
24862 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
24863 temporary error for these kinds of message.
24864
24865
24866 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
24867 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
24868 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
24869 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
24870 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
24871 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
24872 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
24873 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
24874 &%smtp_banner%& option.
24875
24876
24877 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
24878 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
24879 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
24880 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
24881 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
24882 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
24883 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
24884 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
24885 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
24886
24887 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
24888 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
24889 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
24890 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
24891 an EHLO response.
24892
24893
24894 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
24895 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
24896 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
24897 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
24898 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
24899 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
24900 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
24901 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
24902 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
24903 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
24904
24905 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
24906 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
24907 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
24908 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
24909 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
24910 associated with the DATA command.
24911
24912 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
24913 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
24914 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
24915 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
24916 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
24917 your resources.
24918
24919
24920 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
24921 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
24922 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
24923
24924
24925 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
24926 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
24927 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
24928 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
24929 does not in fact control any access. For this reason, the only verbs that are
24930 permitted are &%accept%& and &%warn%&.
24931
24932 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
24933 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
24934 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
24935 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
24936
24937 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
24938 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
24939
24940 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
24941 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
24942 response to QUIT.
24943
24944 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
24945 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
24946 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
24947 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
24948 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
24949
24950
24951 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
24952 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
24953 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
24954 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is is bad
24955 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
24956 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
24957 situation even worse.
24958
24959 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
24960 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
24961 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
24962 and &%warn%&.
24963
24964 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
24965 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
24966 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
24967 connection. The possible values are:
24968 .table2
24969 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
24970 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
24971 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
24972 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
24973 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
24974 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
24975 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
24976 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
24977 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
24978 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
24979 .endtable
24980 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
24981 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
24982 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
24983 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
24984 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
24985 used.
24986
24987
24988 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
24989 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
24990 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
24991 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
24992 .code
24993 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
24994 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
24995 .endd
24996 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
24997 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
24998 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
24999 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
25000 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
25001
25002 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
25003 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
25004 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
25005
25006 .ilist
25007 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
25008 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
25009 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
25010 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
25011 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
25012 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
25013 .code
25014 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
25015 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
25016 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
25017 .endd
25018 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
25019 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
25020 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
25021 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
25022 .next
25023 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
25024 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
25025 matches the string.
25026 .next
25027 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
25028 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
25029 want to have something like
25030 .code
25031 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
25032 .endd
25033 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
25034 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
25035 .endlist
25036
25037
25038
25039
25040 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
25041 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
25042 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
25043 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
25044 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
25045 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
25046 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
25047 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
25048 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
25049
25050 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
25051 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
25052 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
25053
25054
25055 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
25056 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
25057 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
25058 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
25059
25060 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
25061 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
25062 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
25063 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
25064 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
25065 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
25066 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
25067
25068
25069 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
25070 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
25071 recipients; it may create new recipients.
25072
25073
25074
25075 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
25076 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
25077 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
25078 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
25079 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
25080 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
25081
25082 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
25083 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
25084 used to accept or reject anything.
25085
25086 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
25087 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
25088 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
25089 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
25090
25091 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
25092 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
25093 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
25094 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
25095 configuration file.
25096
25097
25098
25099
25100 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
25101 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
25102 .vindex &$domain$&
25103 .vindex &$local_part$&
25104 .vindex &$sender_address$&
25105 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
25106 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
25107 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
25108 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
25109 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
25110 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
25111 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
25112 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
25113
25114 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
25115 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
25116 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
25117 how it is used.
25118
25119 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
25120 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
25121 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
25122 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
25123 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
25124 received).
25125
25126 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
25127 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
25128 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
25129 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
25130 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
25131 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
25132 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
25133 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
25134
25135
25136
25137
25138
25139 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
25140 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
25141 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
25142 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
25143 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
25144 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
25145 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
25146 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
25147 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
25148 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
25149 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
25150 unencrypted connections.
25151 .code
25152 acl_check_auth:
25153 accept encrypted = *
25154 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
25155 {CRAM-MD5}}
25156 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
25157 .endd
25158 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
25159 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
25160 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
25161 option to do this.)
25162
25163
25164
25165 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
25166 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
25167 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
25168 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
25169 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
25170 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
25171 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
25172
25173 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
25174 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
25175 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
25176 example:
25177 .code
25178 deny dnslists = list1.example
25179 dnslists = list2.example
25180 .endd
25181 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
25182 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
25183 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
25184 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
25185 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
25186
25187
25188 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
25189 The ACL verbs are as follows:
25190
25191 .ilist
25192 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
25193 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
25194 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
25195 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
25196 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
25197 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
25198 check a RCPT command:
25199 .code
25200 accept domains = +local_domains
25201 endpass
25202 verify = recipient
25203 .endd
25204 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
25205 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
25206 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
25207 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
25208 &%endpass%&.
25209
25210 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
25211 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
25212 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
25213 configuration.
25214
25215 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
25216 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
25217 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
25218 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
25219 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
25220 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
25221 .display
25222 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
25223 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
25224 .endd
25225 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
25226 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
25227 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
25228
25229 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
25230 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
25231 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
25232 of &%endpass%&.
25233
25234
25235 .next
25236 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
25237 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
25238 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
25239 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
25240 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
25241 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
25242 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
25243
25244
25245 .next
25246 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
25247 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
25248 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
25249 example,
25250 .code
25251 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
25252 .endd
25253 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
25254
25255
25256 .next
25257 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
25258 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
25259 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
25260 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
25261 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
25262 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
25263 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
25264 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
25265 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
25266
25267 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
25268 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
25269 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
25270
25271
25272 .next
25273 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
25274 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
25275 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
25276 .code
25277 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
25278 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
25279 .endd
25280 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
25281 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
25282
25283 .next
25284 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
25285 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
25286 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
25287 example, when checking a RCPT command,
25288 .code
25289 require message = Sender did not verify
25290 verify = sender
25291 .endd
25292 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
25293 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
25294 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
25295 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
25296
25297 .next
25298 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
25299 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
25300 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
25301 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
25302 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
25303 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
25304 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
25305
25306 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
25307 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
25308 &%logwrite%&, and &%add_header%&) that appear before the first failing
25309 condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
25310 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
25311
25312 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
25313 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
25314 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
25315 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
25316 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
25317 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
25318 onwards.
25319
25320
25321 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
25322 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
25323 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
25324 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
25325 .code
25326 warn !verify = sender
25327 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
25328 .endd
25329 .endlist
25330
25331 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
25332
25333 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
25334 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
25335 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
25336 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
25337 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
25338
25339
25340
25341 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
25342 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
25343 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
25344 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
25345 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
25346 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
25347 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
25348 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
25349 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
25350 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
25351 .ilist
25352 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
25353 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
25354 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
25355 on the same SMTP connection.
25356 .next
25357 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
25358 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
25359 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
25360 .endlist
25361
25362 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
25363 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
25364 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
25365 .code
25366 accept hosts = whatever
25367 set acl_m4 = some value
25368 accept authenticated = *
25369 set acl_c_auth = yes
25370 .endd
25371 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
25372 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
25373 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
25374
25375 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
25376 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
25377 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
25378 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
25379 error is generated.
25380
25381 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
25382 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
25383
25384
25385 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
25386 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
25387 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
25388 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
25389 .code
25390 deny domains = *.dom.example
25391 !verify = recipient
25392 .endd
25393 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
25394 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
25395 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
25396 two statements are equivalent:
25397 .code
25398 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
25399 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
25400 .endd
25401 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
25402 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
25403
25404 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
25405 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
25406 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
25407 .code
25408 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
25409 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
25410 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
25411 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
25412 .endd
25413 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
25414 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
25415 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
25416 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
25417 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
25418 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
25419 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
25420
25421 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
25422 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
25423 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
25424 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
25425 message is handled.
25426
25427 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement important, because the
25428 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
25429 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
25430 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
25431 .code
25432 require message = Can't verify sender
25433 verify = sender
25434 message = Can't verify recipient
25435 verify = recipient
25436 message = This message cannot be used
25437 .endd
25438 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
25439 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
25440 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
25441 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
25442 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
25443 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
25444
25445 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
25446 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
25447 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
25448 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
25449 .code
25450 deny hosts = ...
25451 !senders = *@my.domain.example
25452 message = Invalid sender from client host
25453 .endd
25454 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
25455 by which time Exim has set up the message.
25456
25457
25458
25459 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
25460 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
25461 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
25462
25463 .vlist
25464 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25465 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
25466 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
25467 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
25468
25469 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25470 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
25471 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
25472 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
25473 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
25474 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
25475 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
25476 write rather ugly lines like this:
25477 .display
25478 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
25479 .endd
25480 Instead, all you need is
25481 .display
25482 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
25483 .endd
25484
25485 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25486 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
25487 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
25488 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
25489 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
25490 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
25491 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
25492 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
25493
25494 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
25495 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
25496 in several different ways. For example:
25497
25498 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
25499 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
25500 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
25501 . ==== way.
25502
25503 .ilist
25504 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
25505 .code
25506 accept ...some conditions
25507 control = queue_only
25508 .endd
25509 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
25510 other words, when the conditions are all true.
25511
25512 .next
25513 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
25514 .code
25515 accept ...some conditions...
25516 control = queue_only
25517 ...some more conditions...
25518 .endd
25519 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
25520 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
25521 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
25522 to be relevant.
25523
25524 .next
25525 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
25526 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
25527 example:
25528 .code
25529 warn ...some conditions...
25530 control = freeze
25531 accept ...
25532 .endd
25533 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
25534 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
25535 log entry.
25536
25537 .next
25538 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
25539 &%require%& verb. For example:
25540 .code
25541 require control = no_multiline_responses
25542 .endd
25543 .endlist
25544
25545 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
25546 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
25547 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
25548 This modifier may appear in any ACL. It causes Exim to wait for the time
25549 interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the &%-bh%&
25550 option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is output
25551 instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay happens
25552 as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending output is
25553 flushed before the delay is imposed.
25554
25555 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
25556 example:
25557 .code
25558 deny ...some conditions...
25559 delay = 30s
25560 .endd
25561 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
25562 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
25563 .code
25564 deny delay = 30s
25565 ...some conditions...
25566 .endd
25567 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
25568 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
25569 .code
25570 warn ...some conditions...
25571 delay = 2m
25572 control = freeze
25573 accept ...
25574 .endd
25575
25576 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
25577 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
25578 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
25579 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
25580 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
25581 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
25582 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
25583
25584
25585 .vitem &*endpass*&
25586 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
25587 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
25588 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
25589 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
25590 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
25591 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
25592 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
25593
25594
25595 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25596 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
25597 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
25598 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
25599 .code
25600 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_cipher
25601 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
25602 .endd
25603 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
25604 example:
25605 .display
25606 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
25607 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
25608 .endd
25609 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
25610 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
25611 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
25612 message.
25613
25614 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
25615 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
25616 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
25617 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
25618 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
25619 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
25620 ignored.
25621
25622 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
25623 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
25624 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
25625 error message.
25626
25627 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
25628 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
25629 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
25630 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
25631 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
25632 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
25633
25634 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
25635 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
25636 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
25637 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
25638 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
25639 logging rejections.
25640
25641
25642 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
25643 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
25644 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
25645 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
25646 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
25647 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
25648 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
25649 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
25650 .display
25651 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
25652 &` log_reject_target =`&
25653 .endd
25654 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
25655 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
25656 current ACL.
25657
25658
25659 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25660 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
25661 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
25662 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
25663 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
25664 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
25665 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
25666 ACLs. For example:
25667 .display
25668 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
25669 &` control = freeze`&
25670 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
25671 .endd
25672 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
25673 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
25674 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
25675 example:
25676 .code
25677 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
25678 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
25679 .endd
25680
25681
25682 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25683 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
25684 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
25685 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
25686 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
25687 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
25688 &%accept%& for details.)
25689
25690 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
25691 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
25692 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
25693 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
25694 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
25695 .code
25696 require message = Host not recognized
25697 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
25698 .endd
25699 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
25700 processed.)
25701
25702 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
25703 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
25704 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
25705 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
25706 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
25707 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
25708 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
25709 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
25710 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
25711 EHLO options.
25712
25713 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
25714 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
25715 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
25716 .code
25717 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
25718 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
25719 .endd
25720 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
25721 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
25722 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
25723 2&'xx'&.
25724
25725 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
25726 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
25727
25728 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
25729 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
25730 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
25731 response.
25732
25733 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
25734 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
25735 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
25736 However, the original message is available in the variable
25737 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
25738 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
25739 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
25740 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
25741
25742 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
25743 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
25744 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
25745 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
25746 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
25747 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
25748 effect.
25749
25750
25751 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
25752 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
25753 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
25754 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
25755 .endlist
25756
25757
25758
25759
25760
25761 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
25762 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
25763 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
25764
25765 .vlist
25766 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
25767 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
25768 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
25769 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
25770 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
25771 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
25772 not work without it. For example:
25773 .code
25774 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
25775 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
25776 .endd
25777 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
25778 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
25779 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
25780 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
25781 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
25782
25783
25784 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
25785 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
25786 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
25787 .cindex "case of local parts"
25788 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25789 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
25790 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
25791 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
25792 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
25793 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
25794 is encountered.
25795
25796 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
25797 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
25798 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
25799 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
25800 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
25801
25802 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
25803 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
25804 spam score:
25805 .code
25806 warn control = caseful_local_part
25807 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
25808 $acl_m4 + \
25809 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
25810 }
25811 control = caselower_local_part
25812 .endd
25813 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
25814 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
25815
25816 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
25817 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
25818 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
25819 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
25820 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
25821 &'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
25822 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
25823 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
25824 option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
25825 contexts):
25826 .code
25827 control = debug
25828 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
25829 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
25830 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
25831 .endd
25832
25833 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
25834 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
25835 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
25836 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
25837 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
25838 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
25839 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
25840 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
25841
25842 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
25843 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
25844 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
25845 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
25846 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
25847 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
25848 work with.
25849
25850
25851 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
25852 .cindex "fake defer"
25853 .cindex "defer, fake"
25854 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
25855 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
25856 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
25857 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
25858 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
25859
25860 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
25861 .cindex "fake rejection"
25862 .cindex "rejection, fake"
25863 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
25864 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
25865 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
25866 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
25867 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
25868 the same SMTP connection.
25869
25870 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
25871 message is supplied, the following is used:
25872 .code
25873 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
25874 550-kept for evaluation.
25875 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
25876 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
25877 .endd
25878 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
25879
25880 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
25881 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
25882 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
25883 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
25884 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
25885 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
25886 SMTP connection.
25887
25888 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
25889 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
25890 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
25891 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
25892
25893 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
25894 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
25895 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
25896 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
25897 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
25898 disables such output flushing.
25899
25900 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
25901 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
25902 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
25903 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
25904 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
25905 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
25906
25907 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
25908 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
25909 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
25910 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
25911 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
25912 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
25913 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
25914 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
25915 to be useful in production.
25916
25917 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
25918 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
25919 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
25920 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
25921 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
25922
25923 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
25924 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
25925 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
25926 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
25927 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
25928 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
25929
25930 .ilist
25931 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
25932 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
25933 verification failed"&) is sent.
25934 .next
25935 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
25936 line is output.
25937 .endlist
25938
25939 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
25940 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
25941
25942 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
25943 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
25944 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
25945 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
25946 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
25947 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
25948 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
25949
25950 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
25951 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
25952 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
25953 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
25954 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
25955 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
25956 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
25957 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
25958 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
25959 same SMTP connection.
25960
25961 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
25962 .cindex "message" "submission"
25963 .cindex "submission mode"
25964 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
25965 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
25966 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
25967 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
25968 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
25969 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
25970 late (the message has already been created).
25971
25972 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
25973 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
25974 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
25975 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
25976 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
25977
25978 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
25979 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
25980 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
25981 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
25982 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
25983
25984 .ilist
25985 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
25986 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
25987 .next
25988 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
25989 .next
25990 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
25991 .endlist ilist
25992
25993 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
25994 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
25995 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
25996 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
25997 data is read.
25998
25999 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
26000 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
26001 .endlist vlist
26002
26003
26004 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
26005 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
26006
26007 .ilist
26008 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
26009 .next
26010 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
26011 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
26012 .next
26013 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
26014 .next
26015 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
26016 .endlist
26017
26018
26019
26020 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
26021 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
26022 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
26023 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
26024 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
26025 to an incoming message, as in this example:
26026 .code
26027 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26028 dialup.mail-abuse.org
26029 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
26030 .endd
26031 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
26032 MIME, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
26033 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
26034 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
26035 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
26036 RCPT ACL).
26037
26038 If the data for the &%add_header%& modifier contains one or more newlines that
26039 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
26040 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
26041 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
26042
26043 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
26044 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
26045 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
26046 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
26047 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
26048 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
26049 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
26050 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
26051 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
26052 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
26053 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
26054
26055 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
26056 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until they are added to the
26057 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
26058 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
26059 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
26060 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
26061 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
26062 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
26063 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
26064
26065 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately it is encountered during the
26066 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
26067 .display
26068 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
26069 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
26070
26071 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
26072 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
26073 .endd
26074 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
26075 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
26076 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
26077 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
26078 honoured.
26079
26080 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
26081 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
26082 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
26083 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
26084 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
26085 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
26086 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
26087 specifications.
26088
26089 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
26090 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
26091 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
26092 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
26093 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
26094
26095 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
26096 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
26097 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
26098 to be a header name first.) For example:
26099 .code
26100 warn add_header = \
26101 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
26102 .endd
26103 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
26104 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
26105 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
26106 up in reverse order.
26107
26108 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
26109 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
26110 system filter or in a router or transport.
26111
26112
26113
26114
26115 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
26116 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
26117 Some of conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
26118 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
26119 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
26120 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26121
26122 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
26123 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
26124 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
26125 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
26126 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
26127 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
26128 The conditions are as follows:
26129
26130
26131 .vlist
26132 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
26133 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
26134 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
26135 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
26136 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
26137 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
26138 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
26139 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
26140 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
26141 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
26142 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
26143
26144 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
26145 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
26146 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
26147 conditions are tested.
26148
26149 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
26150 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
26151 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
26152 for different local users or different local domains.
26153
26154 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
26155 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
26156 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
26157 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
26158 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
26159 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
26160 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
26161 .code
26162 authenticated = *
26163 .endd
26164
26165 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
26166 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
26167 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
26168 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
26169 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
26170 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
26171 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
26172 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
26173 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
26174 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
26175 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
26176 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
26177 negative.
26178
26179 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
26180 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
26181 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26182 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
26183 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
26184 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
26185 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
26186 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26187
26188 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
26189 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
26190 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26191 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
26192 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
26193
26194 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
26195 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
26196 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
26197 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
26198 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
26199 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
26200 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
26201 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
26202 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
26203 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
26204
26205 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
26206 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
26207 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
26208 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
26209 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
26210 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
26211 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
26212 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
26213 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
26214 &%domains%& test.
26215
26216 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
26217 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
26218
26219
26220 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
26221 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
26222 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
26223 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
26224 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
26225 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
26226 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
26227 .code
26228 encrypted = *
26229 .endd
26230
26231
26232 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'&~host&~list'&>
26233 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
26234 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
26235 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
26236 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
26237 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
26238 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
26239 .code
26240 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
26241 .endd
26242 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
26243 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
26244 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
26245
26246 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
26247 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
26248 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
26249 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
26250 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
26251 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
26252
26253 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
26254 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
26255 .code
26256 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
26257 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
26258 .endd
26259 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
26260 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
26261 statement can then check the IP address.
26262
26263 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
26264 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
26265 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
26266 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
26267 .code
26268 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
26269 message = $host_data
26270 .endd
26271 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
26272
26273 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
26274 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
26275 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
26276 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
26277 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
26278 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
26279 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
26280 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
26281 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
26282 the next &%local_parts%& test.
26283
26284 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
26285 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
26286 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
26287 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
26288 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26289 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
26290 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26291
26292 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
26293 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
26294 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
26295 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26296 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
26297 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
26298 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
26299 &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26300
26301 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
26302 .cindex "rate limiting"
26303 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
26304 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
26305
26306 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
26307 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
26308 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
26309 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
26310 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
26311 recipient address against a list of recipients.
26312
26313 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
26314 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
26315 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
26316 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26317 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
26318 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
26319 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26320
26321 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
26322 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
26323 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
26324 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
26325 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26326 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
26327 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
26328 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
26329 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
26330 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
26331 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
26332 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
26333 influence the sender checking.
26334
26335 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
26336 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
26337
26338 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
26339 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
26340 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
26341 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
26342 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
26343 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
26344 .code
26345 senders = :
26346 .endd
26347 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
26348 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
26349
26350 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
26351 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
26352 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
26353 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26354 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
26355 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26356
26357 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
26358 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26359 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
26360 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
26361 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
26362 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
26363 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
26364 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
26365 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
26366 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
26367
26368 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
26369 .cindex "CSA verification"
26370 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
26371 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
26372 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
26373
26374 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
26375 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26376 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
26377 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
26378 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
26379 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
26380 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
26381 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
26382 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
26383 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
26384 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
26385 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
26386 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
26387 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
26388 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
26389
26390 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
26391 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
26392 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
26393 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
26394 .code
26395 deny senders = :
26396 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
26397 !verify = header_sender
26398 .endd
26399
26400 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
26401 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26402 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
26403 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
26404 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
26405 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
26406 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
26407 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
26408 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
26409 and &'Bcc:'&). Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
26410 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
26411 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
26412 appropriate.
26413
26414 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
26415 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
26416 .code
26417 To: @
26418 .endd
26419 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
26420 common as they used to be.
26421
26422 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
26423 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26424 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
26425 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
26426 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
26427 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
26428 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
26429 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
26430 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
26431 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
26432 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
26433 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
26434 independently of this condition.
26435
26436 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
26437 option), this condition is always true.
26438
26439
26440 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
26441 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
26442 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
26443 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
26444 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
26445 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
26446 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
26447 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
26448 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
26449
26450 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
26451 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
26452
26453
26454 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
26455 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26456 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
26457 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
26458 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
26459 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
26460 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
26461 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
26462 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
26463 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
26464 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
26465 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
26466 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
26467 value for the child address.
26468
26469 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup*&
26470 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26471 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
26472 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
26473 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
26474 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
26475 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
26476 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
26477 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
26478 original IP address.
26479
26480 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
26481 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
26482
26483 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
26484 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26485 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
26486 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
26487 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
26488 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
26489 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
26490 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
26491 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
26492
26493 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
26494 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
26495 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
26496 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
26497 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
26498 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
26499 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
26500
26501 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
26502 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
26503 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
26504
26505 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
26506 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26507 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
26508 verified as a sender.
26509 .endlist
26510
26511
26512
26513 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
26514 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
26515 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
26516 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
26517 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
26518 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
26519 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
26520 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
26521 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
26522 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
26523 .code
26524 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
26525 dialups.mail-abuse.org
26526 .endd
26527 the following records are looked up:
26528 .code
26529 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26530 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
26531 .endd
26532 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
26533 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
26534 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
26535 use two separate conditions:
26536 .code
26537 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26538 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
26539 .endd
26540 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
26541 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
26542 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
26543 processed.
26544
26545 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
26546 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
26547 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
26548 following special items in the list:
26549 .display
26550 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
26551 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
26552 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
26553 .endd
26554 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
26555 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
26556 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
26557 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
26558 .code
26559 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
26560 .endd
26561 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
26562 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
26563 .code
26564 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26565 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
26566 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
26567 .endd
26568 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
26569 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
26570 connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
26571 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
26572
26573
26574
26575 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
26576 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
26577 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
26578 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
26579 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
26580 .code
26581 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
26582 .endd
26583 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
26584 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
26585 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
26586 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
26587
26588
26589
26590
26591 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
26592 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
26593 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
26594 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
26595 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
26596 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
26597 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
26598 .code
26599 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
26600 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
26601 .endd
26602 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
26603 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
26604 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
26605 up by this example is
26606 .code
26607 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
26608 .endd
26609 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
26610 addresses. For example:
26611 .code
26612 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26613 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
26614 .endd
26615 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
26616 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
26617
26618
26619
26620
26621 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
26622 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
26623 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
26624 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
26625 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
26626 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
26627 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
26628 either to double the separators like this:
26629 .code
26630 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
26631 .endd
26632 or to change the separator character, like this:
26633 .code
26634 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
26635 .endd
26636 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
26637 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
26638 occurs. Consider this condition:
26639 .code
26640 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
26641 .endd
26642 The DNS lookups that occur are:
26643 .code
26644 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
26645 a.domain.black.list.tld
26646 .endd
26647 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
26648 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
26649 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
26650 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
26651 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
26652 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
26653 error for a previous item.
26654
26655 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
26656 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
26657 .code
26658 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
26659 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
26660 .endd
26661 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
26662 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
26663 .code
26664 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
26665 $sender_address_domain \
26666 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
26667 see $dnslist_text.
26668 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
26669 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
26670 $sender_address_domain} }} }
26671 .endd
26672 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
26673 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
26674 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
26675 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
26676 .code
26677 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
26678 .endd
26679 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
26680 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
26681
26682 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
26683 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
26684
26685
26686
26687
26688 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
26689 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
26690 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
26691 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
26692 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
26693 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
26694 .display
26695 127.1.0.1 RBL
26696 127.1.0.2 DUL
26697 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
26698 127.1.0.4 RSS
26699 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
26700 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
26701 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
26702 .endd
26703 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
26704 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
26705 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
26706
26707
26708 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
26709 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
26710 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
26711 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
26712 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
26713 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
26714 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
26715 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
26716 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
26717 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
26718 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
26719 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
26720 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
26721 cases, for example:
26722 .code
26723 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
26724 .endd
26725 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
26726 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
26727 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
26728 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
26729 .code
26730 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
26731 .endd
26732 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
26733 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
26734
26735 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
26736 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
26737 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
26738 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
26739 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
26740 information.
26741
26742 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
26743 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
26744 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
26745 .code
26746 deny hosts = !+local_networks
26747 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
26748 at $dnslist_domain
26749 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
26750 .endd
26751
26752
26753
26754 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
26755 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
26756 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
26757 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
26758 For example,
26759 .code
26760 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
26761 .endd
26762 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
26763 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
26764 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
26765 describes how multiple records are handled.
26766
26767 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
26768 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
26769 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
26770 .code
26771 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26772 .endd
26773 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
26774 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
26775 first. For example:
26776 .code
26777 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
26778 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
26779 .endd
26780
26781 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
26782 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
26783 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
26784 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
26785 tested. For example:
26786 .code
26787 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
26788 .endd
26789 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
26790 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
26791 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
26792 .code
26793 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
26794 .endd
26795 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
26796 an odd number.
26797
26798
26799
26800 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
26801 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
26802 condition. Whereas
26803 .code
26804 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26805 .endd
26806 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
26807 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
26808 .code
26809 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26810 .endd
26811 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
26812 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
26813 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
26814 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
26815
26816 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
26817 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
26818
26819 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
26820 previous example is precisely equivalent to
26821 .code
26822 deny dnslists = a.b.c
26823 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26824 .endd
26825 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
26826 Consider this example:
26827 .code
26828 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26829 list.dsbl.org : \
26830 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
26831 relays.ordb.org
26832 .endd
26833 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
26834 .code
26835 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26836 list.dsbl.org
26837 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
26838 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
26839 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
26840 .endd
26841 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
26842
26843
26844
26845
26846 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
26847 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
26848 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
26849 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
26850 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
26851 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
26852 .code
26853 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
26854 .endd
26855 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
26856 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
26857 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
26858 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
26859 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
26860 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
26861
26862 .ilist
26863 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
26864 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
26865 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
26866 .next
26867 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
26868 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
26869 changed to:
26870 .code
26871 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
26872 .endd
26873 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
26874 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
26875 .code
26876 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
26877 .endd
26878 for the condition to be true.
26879 .endlist
26880
26881 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
26882 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
26883 .ilist
26884 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
26885 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
26886 .code
26887 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
26888 .endd
26889 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
26890 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
26891 .next
26892 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true there is at least one
26893 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
26894 .code
26895 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
26896 .endd
26897 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
26898 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
26899 .code
26900 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
26901 .endd
26902 for the condition to be false.
26903 .endlist
26904 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
26905 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
26906
26907
26908
26909
26910 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
26911 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
26912 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
26913 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
26914 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
26915 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
26916 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
26917 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
26918 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
26919 lists.
26920
26921 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
26922 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
26923 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
26924 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
26925 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
26926 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
26927 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
26928 .code
26929 reject message = \
26930 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
26931 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
26932 dnslists = \
26933 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
26934 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
26935 .endd
26936 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
26937 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
26938 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
26939 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
26940 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
26941 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
26942
26943 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
26944 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
26945 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
26946 .code
26947 reject dnslists = \
26948 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
26949 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
26950 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
26951 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
26952 .endd
26953 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
26954 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
26955 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
26956
26957
26958
26959 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
26960 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
26961 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
26962 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
26963 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
26964 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
26965 .code
26966 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
26967 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26968 .endd
26969 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
26970 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
26971 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
26972 .code
26973 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
26974 .endd
26975 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
26976 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
26977
26978 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
26979 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
26980 .code
26981 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
26982 dnslists = some.list.example
26983 .endd
26984
26985 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
26986 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
26987 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
26988 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
26989 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
26990 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
26991 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
26992 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
26993 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
26994 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
26995 .display
26996 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
26997 .endd
26998 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
26999 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
27000
27001 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
27002 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
27003 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
27004 of &'p'&.
27005
27006 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
27007 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
27008 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
27009 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
27010 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
27011 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
27012 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
27013 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
27014 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
27015
27016 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
27017 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
27018 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
27019 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
27020
27021 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
27022 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
27023 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
27024 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
27025 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
27026 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
27027 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
27028 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
27029 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
27030 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
27031
27032 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
27033 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
27034 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
27035 ACL.
27036
27037 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& and the options onto the
27038 lookup key because they alter the meaning of the stored data. This is not true
27039 for the limit &'m'&, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will
27040 still remember clients' past behaviour, but if you alter the other ratelimit
27041 parameters Exim forgets past behaviour.
27042
27043 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to three options. One option
27044 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, and the second specifies how Exim
27045 handles excessively fast clients. The third option can be &`noupdate`&, to
27046 disable updating of the ratelimiting database (see section &<<rearatdat>>&).
27047 The options are separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may
27048 appear in any order.
27049
27050 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
27051 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate.
27052
27053 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
27054 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified.
27055
27056 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. Note that it is
27057 best to use this option in the DATA ACL; if it is used in an earlier ACL it
27058 relies on the SIZE parameter specified by the client in its MAIL command,
27059 which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can follow the limit &'m'&
27060 in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits in kilobytes,
27061 megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
27062
27063 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which
27064 recipients are accepted. To be effective, it would need to be used in
27065 either the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& or the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. In the
27066 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACL, the number of recipients is incremented by one.
27067 In the case of a locally submitted message in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL,
27068 the number of recipients is incremented by the &%$recipients_count%&
27069 for the entire message. Note that in either case the rate limiting
27070 engine will see a message with many recipients as a large high-speed
27071 burst.
27072
27073 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
27074 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the SMTP command rate.
27075 This command is essentially an alias of &%per_rcpt%& to make it clear
27076 that the effect is to limit the rate at which individual commands,
27077 rather than recipients, are accepted.
27078
27079 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratophanfas"
27080 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
27081 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
27082 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& options. This is independent of the other
27083 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
27084 rest of the ACL. The default mode is leaky, which avoids a sender's
27085 over-aggressive retry rate preventing it from getting any email through.
27086
27087 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
27088 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
27089 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
27090 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
27091 counter-measures by the ACL until it slows down below the maximum rate. If
27092 the client stops attempting to send email for the time specified in the &'p'&
27093 parameter then its computed rate will decay exponentially to 37% of its peak
27094 value. You can work out the time (the number of smoothing periods) that a
27095 client is subjected to counter-measures after an over-limit burst with this
27096 formula:
27097 .code
27098 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
27099 .endd
27100 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
27101 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
27102 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
27103 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
27104 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
27105 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
27106 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
27107
27108 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
27109 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
27110 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
27111 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
27112 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
27113 message. For example:
27114 .code
27115 # Log all senders' rates
27116 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
27117 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
27118
27119 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
27120 # at the decimal point.
27121 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
27122 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
27123 $sender_rate_limit }s
27124
27125 # Keep authenticated users under control
27126 deny authenticated = *
27127 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
27128
27129 # System-wide rate limit
27130 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
27131 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
27132
27133 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
27134 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
27135 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
27136 messages per $sender_rate_period
27137 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
27138 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
27139 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
27140 .endd
27141 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
27142 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
27143 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
27144 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
27145 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
27146 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
27147 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
27148
27149
27150 .section "Reading ratelimit data without updating" "rearatdat"
27151 .cindex "rate limitint" "reading data without updating"
27152 If the &%noupdate%& option is present on a &%ratelimit%& ACL condition, Exim
27153 computes the rate and checks the limit as normal, but it does not update the
27154 saved data. This means that, in relevant ACLs, it is possible to lookup the
27155 existence of a specified (or auto-generated) ratelimit key without incrementing
27156 the ratelimit counter for that key. In order for this to be useful, another ACL
27157 entry must set the rate for the same key (otherwise it will always be zero).
27158 For example:
27159 .code
27160 acl_check_connect:
27161 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict / per_cmd / noupdate
27162 log_message = RATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
27163 (max $sender_rate_limit)
27164 .endd
27165 .display
27166 &'... some other logic and tests...'&
27167 .endd
27168 .code
27169 acl_check_mail:
27170 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict / per_cmd
27171 condition = ${if le{$sender_rate}{$sender_rate_limit}}
27172 logwrite = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
27173 (max $sender_rate_limit)
27174 .endd
27175 In this example, the rate is tested and used to deny access (when it is too
27176 high) in the connect ACL, but the actual computation of the remembered rate
27177 happens later, on a per-command basis, in another ACL.
27178
27179
27180
27181 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
27182 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
27183 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
27184 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
27185 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
27186 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
27187 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
27188 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
27189 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
27190 .code
27191 verify = sender/callout
27192 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
27193 .endd
27194 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
27195 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
27196 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
27197 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
27198 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
27199 The available options are as follows:
27200
27201 .ilist
27202 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
27203 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
27204 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
27205 .next
27206 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
27207 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
27208 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
27209 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
27210 .next
27211 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
27212 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
27213 .next
27214 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
27215 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
27216 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
27217 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
27218 .endlist
27219
27220 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
27221 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
27222 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
27223 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27224 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
27225 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
27226 coding like this:
27227 .code
27228 warn !verify = sender
27229 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
27230 .endd
27231 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
27232 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
27233 verification failure.
27234
27235 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
27236 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
27237
27238 .ilist
27239 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
27240 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
27241 .next
27242 &%route%&: Routing failed.
27243 .next
27244 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
27245 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
27246 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
27247 .next
27248 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
27249 .next
27250 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
27251 .endlist
27252
27253 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
27254 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
27255
27256
27257
27258
27259 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
27260 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
27261 .cindex "callout" "verification"
27262 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
27263 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
27264 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
27265 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
27266 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
27267 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
27268 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
27269 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
27270 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
27271 sender's domain.
27272
27273 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
27274 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
27275 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
27276 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
27277 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
27278 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
27279
27280 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
27281 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
27282 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
27283 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
27284 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
27285
27286 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
27287 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
27288 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
27289 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
27290 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
27291 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
27292 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
27293 supplies a host list.
27294
27295 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
27296 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
27297 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
27298 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
27299 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
27300 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
27301 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
27302
27303 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
27304 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
27305 following SMTP commands are sent:
27306 .display
27307 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
27308 &`MAIL FROM:<>`&
27309 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
27310 &`QUIT`&
27311 .endd
27312 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
27313 set to &"lmtp"&.
27314
27315 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
27316 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
27317 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
27318 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
27319 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
27320 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
27321
27322 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
27323 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
27324 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
27325 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
27326 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
27327
27328 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
27329 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
27330 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
27331 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
27332 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
27333
27334
27335
27336
27337 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
27338 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
27339 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
27340 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
27341 .code
27342 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
27343 .endd
27344 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
27345 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
27346 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
27347
27348
27349 .vlist
27350 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
27351 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
27352 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
27353 For example:
27354 .code
27355 verify = sender/callout=5s
27356 .endd
27357 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
27358 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
27359 the &%connect%& parameter.
27360
27361
27362 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
27363 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
27364 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
27365 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
27366 .code
27367 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
27368 .endd
27369 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
27370
27371 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
27372 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
27373 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
27374 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
27375 updated in this circumstance.
27376
27377 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
27378 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
27379 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
27380 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
27381 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
27382 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
27383
27384
27385 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
27386 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
27387 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
27388 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
27389 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
27390 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
27391 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
27392 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
27393 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
27394 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
27395 .code
27396 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
27397 .endd
27398 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
27399
27400
27401 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
27402 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
27403 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
27404 For example:
27405 .code
27406 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
27407 .endd
27408 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
27409 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
27410 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
27411 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
27412 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
27413
27414
27415 .vitem &*no_cache*&
27416 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
27417 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
27418 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
27419
27420 .vitem &*postmaster*&
27421 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
27422 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
27423 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
27424 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
27425 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
27426 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
27427 made, until the cache record expires.
27428
27429 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
27430 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
27431 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
27432 For example:
27433 .code
27434 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
27435 .endd
27436 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
27437 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
27438 .code
27439 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
27440 .endd
27441 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
27442 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
27443 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
27444 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
27445
27446
27447 .vitem &*random*&
27448 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
27449 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
27450 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
27451 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
27452 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
27453 .code
27454 $primary_host_name-$tod_epoch-testing
27455 .endd
27456 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
27457 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
27458 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
27459 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
27460 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
27461
27462 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
27463 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
27464 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
27465 .code
27466 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
27467 .endd
27468 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
27469 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
27470 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
27471 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
27472 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
27473
27474 .vitem &*use_sender*&
27475 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
27476 .code
27477 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
27478 .endd
27479 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
27480 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
27481 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
27482 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
27483 usefulness of callout caching.
27484 .endlist
27485
27486 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
27487 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
27488 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
27489 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
27490 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
27491 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
27492 these circumstances.
27493
27494 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
27495 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
27496 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
27497 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
27498 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
27499 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
27500 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
27501
27502 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
27503 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
27504 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
27505 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
27506
27507
27508
27509
27510 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
27511 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
27512 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
27513 .cindex "caching" "callout"
27514 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
27515 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
27516 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
27517 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
27518 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
27519 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
27520
27521 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
27522 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
27523 is not available.
27524
27525 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
27526 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
27527 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
27528
27529 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
27530 commands up to and including
27531 .code
27532 MAIL FROM:<>
27533 .endd
27534 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
27535 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
27536 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
27537 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
27538 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
27539 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
27540 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
27541
27542 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
27543 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
27544 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
27545 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
27546 will eventually be noticed.
27547
27548 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
27549 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
27550 behaviour will be the same.
27551
27552
27553
27554 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
27555 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
27556 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
27557 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
27558 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
27559 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
27560 you might see:
27561 .code
27562 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
27563 250 OK
27564 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
27565 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
27566 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
27567 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
27568 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
27569 550 Sender verification failed
27570 .endd
27571 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
27572 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
27573 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
27574 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
27575 example:
27576 .code
27577 verify = sender/no_details
27578 .endd
27579
27580 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
27581 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
27582 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
27583 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
27584 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
27585 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
27586 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
27587
27588 .ilist
27589 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
27590 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
27591 verification also fails.
27592 .next
27593 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
27594 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
27595 .endlist
27596
27597 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
27598 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
27599 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
27600 .code
27601 A.Wol: aw123
27602 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
27603 .endd
27604 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
27605 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
27606 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
27607 verification to succeed.
27608
27609 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
27610 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
27611 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
27612 option. For example:
27613 .code
27614 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
27615 .endd
27616 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
27617 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
27618
27619 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
27620 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
27621 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
27622 address and a report is output for each of them.
27623
27624
27625
27626 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
27627 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
27628 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
27629 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
27630 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
27631 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
27632 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
27633 .code
27634 verify = csa
27635 .endd
27636 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
27637 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
27638 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
27639 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
27640 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
27641 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
27642
27643 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
27644 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
27645 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
27646 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
27647
27648 .ilist
27649 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
27650 .next
27651 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
27652 .next
27653 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
27654 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
27655 .next
27656 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
27657 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
27658 .endlist
27659
27660 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
27661 use for the DNS query. The default is:
27662 .code
27663 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
27664 .endd
27665 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
27666 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
27667 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
27668 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
27669 meaningful to say:
27670 .code
27671 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
27672 .endd
27673 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
27674 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
27675 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
27676
27677 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
27678 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
27679 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
27680 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
27681 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
27682 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
27683 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
27684 of legitimate HELO domains.
27685
27686 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
27687 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
27688 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
27689 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
27690 lookup such as:
27691 .code
27692 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
27693 .endd
27694 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
27695 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
27696 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
27697
27698
27699
27700
27701 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
27702 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
27703 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
27704 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
27705 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
27706 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
27707 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
27708 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
27709
27710 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
27711 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
27712 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
27713 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
27714 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
27715 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
27716 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
27717
27718 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
27719 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
27720 like this:
27721 .code
27722 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
27723 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
27724 }{$value}}
27725 .endd
27726 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
27727 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
27728 use this:
27729 .code
27730 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
27731 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
27732 senders = :
27733 recipients = +batv_senders
27734
27735 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
27736 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
27737 senders = :
27738 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
27739 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
27740 !condition = $prvscheck_result
27741 .endd
27742 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
27743 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
27744 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
27745 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
27746 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
27747
27748 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
27749 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
27750 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
27751 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
27752 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
27753 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
27754 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
27755
27756 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
27757 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
27758 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
27759 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
27760 .code
27761 batv_redirect:
27762 driver = redirect
27763 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
27764 .endd
27765 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
27766 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
27767 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
27768 local addresses.
27769
27770 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
27771 can be used:
27772 .code
27773 external_smtp_batv:
27774 driver = smtp
27775 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
27776 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
27777 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
27778 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
27779 {$value}fail}}}
27780 .endd
27781 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
27782
27783
27784
27785 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
27786 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
27787 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
27788 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
27789 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
27790 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
27791 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
27792 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
27793 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
27794 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
27795
27796 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
27797 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
27798 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
27799 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
27800 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
27801 same host is fulfilling both functions,
27802 . ///
27803 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
27804 . ///
27805 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
27806 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
27807 system to arbitrary domains.
27808
27809
27810 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
27811 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
27812 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
27813 example, suppose you want to do the following:
27814
27815 .ilist
27816 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
27817 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
27818 &'my.dom2.example'&.
27819 .next
27820 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
27821 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
27822 .next
27823 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
27824 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
27825 .endlist
27826
27827
27828 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
27829 .code
27830 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
27831 domainlist relay_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
27832 hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
27833 .endd
27834 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
27835 command:
27836 .code
27837 acl_check_rcpt:
27838 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
27839 accept hosts = +relay_hosts
27840 .endd
27841 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
27842 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
27843 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
27844 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
27845 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
27846 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
27847 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
27848
27849
27850
27851 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
27852 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
27853 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
27854 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
27855 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
27856
27857 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
27858 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
27859 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
27860 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
27861 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
27862 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
27863 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
27864 .ecindex IIDacl
27865
27866
27867
27868 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27869 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27870
27871 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
27872 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
27873 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
27874 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
27875 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
27876 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
27877 specification.
27878
27879 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
27880 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
27881 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
27882 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
27883 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
27884
27885 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
27886 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
27887 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
27888
27889 .ilist
27890 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
27891 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
27892 .next
27893 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
27894 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
27895 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
27896 .next
27897 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
27898 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
27899 .next
27900 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
27901 conditions.
27902 .next
27903 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
27904 .endlist
27905
27906 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
27907 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
27908 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
27909
27910 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
27911 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
27912 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
27913 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
27914 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
27915 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
27916
27917 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
27918 temporarily created in a file called:
27919 .display
27920 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
27921 .endd
27922 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
27923 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
27924 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
27925 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
27926 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
27927 .code
27928 control = no_mbox_unspool
27929 .endd
27930 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
27931 same directory by default.
27932
27933
27934
27935 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
27936 .cindex "virus scanning"
27937 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
27938 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
27939 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
27940 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
27941 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
27942 in memory and thus are much faster.
27943
27944 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
27945 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in first part of the Exim configuration
27946 file to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
27947 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
27948 .display
27949 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
27950 .endd
27951 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
27952 .code
27953 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
27954 .endd
27955 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
27956 before use. The following scanner types are supported in this release:
27957
27958 .vlist
27959 .vitem &%aveserver%&
27960 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
27961 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
27962 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
27963 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
27964 example:
27965 .code
27966 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
27967 .endd
27968
27969 .vitem &%clamd%&
27970 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
27971 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
27972 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
27973 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
27974 in the MIME ACL. This no longer believed to be necessary. One option is
27975 required: either the path and name of a UNIX socket file, or a hostname or IP
27976 number, and a port, separated by space, as in the second of these examples:
27977 .code
27978 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
27979 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
27980 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
27981 .endd
27982 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the local
27983 keyword, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
27984 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
27985 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
27986 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
27987 There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
27988 you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
27989 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
27990 contributing the code for this scanner.
27991
27992 .vitem &%cmdline%&
27993 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
27994 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
27995 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
27996 type takes 3 mandatory options:
27997
27998 .olist
27999 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
28000 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
28001
28002 .next
28003 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
28004 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
28005 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
28006 the &"trigger"& expression.
28007
28008 .next
28009 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
28010 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
28011 &"name"& expression.
28012 .endlist olist
28013
28014 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
28015 .code
28016 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
28017 .endd
28018 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
28019 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
28020 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
28021 configuration setting:
28022 .code
28023 av_scanner = cmdline:\
28024 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
28025 found in file:'(.+)'
28026 .endd
28027 .vitem &%drweb%&
28028 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
28029 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface takes one
28030 argument, either a full path to a UNIX socket, or an IP address and port
28031 separated by white space, as in these examples:
28032 .code
28033 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
28034 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
28035 .endd
28036 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
28037 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
28038
28039 .vitem &%fsecure%&
28040 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
28041 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
28042 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
28043 .code
28044 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
28045 .endd
28046 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
28047 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
28048
28049 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
28050 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
28051 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
28052 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
28053 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
28054 For example:
28055 .code
28056 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
28057 .endd
28058 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
28059
28060 .vitem &%mksd%&
28061 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
28062 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
28063 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
28064 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
28065 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
28066 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
28067 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
28068 .code
28069 av_scanner = mksd:2
28070 .endd
28071 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
28072
28073 .vitem &%sophie%&
28074 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
28075 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
28076 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
28077 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
28078 client communication. For example:
28079 .code
28080 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
28081 .endd
28082 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
28083 the option.
28084 .endlist
28085
28086 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
28087 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
28088 ACL.
28089
28090 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
28091 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
28092 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
28093 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
28094 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
28095 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
28096 message.
28097
28098 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
28099 use. It can then be one of
28100
28101 .ilist
28102 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
28103 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
28104 recommended usage.
28105 .next
28106 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
28107 the condition fails immediately.
28108 .next
28109 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
28110 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
28111 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
28112 .endlist
28113
28114 You can append &`/defer_ok`& to the &%malware%& condition to accept messages
28115 even if there is a problem with the virus scanner. Otherwise, such a problem
28116 causes the ACL to defer.
28117
28118 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
28119 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
28120 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
28121 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
28122 logging data.
28123
28124 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
28125 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
28126 &%malware%& condition.
28127
28128 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
28129 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
28130
28131 Here is a very simple scanning example:
28132 .code
28133 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
28134 demime = *
28135 malware = *
28136 .endd
28137 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
28138 .code
28139 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
28140 demime = *
28141 malware = */defer_ok
28142 .endd
28143 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
28144 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
28145 .code
28146 av_scanner = $acl_m0
28147 .endd
28148 in the main Exim configuration.
28149 .code
28150 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
28151 set acl_m0 = sophie
28152 malware = *
28153
28154 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
28155 set acl_m0 = aveserver
28156 malware = *
28157 .endd
28158
28159
28160 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin" "SECTscanspamass"
28161 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
28162 .cindex "spam scanning"
28163 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
28164 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
28165 score and a report for the message. You can get SpamAssassin at
28166 &url(http://www.spamassassin.org), or, if you have a working Perl
28167 installation, you can use CPAN by running:
28168 .code
28169 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
28170 .endd
28171 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
28172 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
28173 nicely, however.
28174
28175 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
28176 After having installed and configured SpamAssassin, start the &%spamd%& daemon.
28177 By default, it listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783. If you use another host or
28178 port for &%spamd%&, you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global
28179 part of the Exim configuration as follows (example):
28180 .code
28181 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
28182 .endd
28183 You do not need to set this option if you use the default. As of version 2.60,
28184 &%spamd%& also supports communication over UNIX sockets. If you want to use
28185 these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute file name instead of a
28186 address/port pair:
28187 .code
28188 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
28189 .endd
28190 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
28191 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
28192 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
28193 option, separated with colons:
28194 .code
28195 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
28196 192.168.2.11 783 : \
28197 192.168.2.12 783
28198 .endd
28199 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported. The servers are queried in a random
28200 fashion. When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
28201 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
28202 condition defers.
28203
28204 &*Warning*&: It is not possible to use the UNIX socket connection method with
28205 multiple &%spamd%& servers.
28206
28207 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
28208 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
28209 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
28210 expansion.
28211
28212 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
28213 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
28214 .code
28215 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
28216 spam = joe
28217 .endd
28218 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
28219 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
28220 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
28221 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
28222 However, you must put something on the right-hand side.
28223
28224 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
28225 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
28226 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
28227 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA ACL in order to be able to
28228 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
28229 are not set.
28230
28231 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
28232 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
28233 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
28234
28235
28236 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
28237 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
28238 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
28239 example:
28240 .code
28241 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
28242 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
28243 spam = nobody
28244 .endd
28245
28246 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
28247 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
28248 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
28249 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
28250
28251 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
28252 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
28253 variables. These variables are saved with the received message, thus they are
28254 available for use at delivery time.
28255
28256 .vlist
28257 .vitem &$spam_score$&
28258 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
28259 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
28260
28261 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
28262 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
28263 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
28264 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
28265 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
28266
28267
28268 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
28269 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
28270 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
28271 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
28272 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
28273
28274 .vitem &$spam_report$&
28275 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
28276 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
28277 .endlist
28278
28279 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
28280 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
28281 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
28282
28283 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
28284 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
28285 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
28286 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
28287 spam condition, like this:
28288 .code
28289 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
28290 spam = joe/defer_ok
28291 .endd
28292 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
28293
28294 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
28295 condition:
28296 .code
28297 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
28298 warn spam = nobody:true
28299 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
28300 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
28301
28302 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
28303 # is over threshold
28304 warn spam = nobody
28305 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
28306
28307 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
28308 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
28309 spam = nobody:true
28310 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
28311 .endd
28312
28313
28314
28315 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
28316 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
28317 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
28318 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
28319 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
28320 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
28321 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
28322 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
28323 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
28324 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
28325 cases.
28326
28327 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
28328 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
28329 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
28330 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
28331 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
28332 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
28333 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
28334
28335 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
28336 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
28337 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
28338 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
28339 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
28340
28341 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
28342 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
28343 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
28344 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
28345 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
28346 syntax is:
28347 .display
28348 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
28349 .endd
28350 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
28351 the value can be:
28352
28353 .olist
28354 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
28355 .next
28356 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
28357 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
28358 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
28359 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
28360 .next
28361 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
28362 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
28363 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
28364 the full path and file name.
28365 .next
28366 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
28367 filename, and the default path is then used.
28368 .endlist
28369 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
28370 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
28371 a file with its original, proposed filename using
28372 .code
28373 decode = $mime_filename
28374 .endd
28375 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
28376 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
28377 automatically unlinked.
28378
28379 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
28380 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
28381 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
28382 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
28383 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
28384
28385 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
28386 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
28387 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
28388
28389 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
28390 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
28391 available in the MIME ACL:
28392
28393 .vlist
28394 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
28395 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
28396 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
28397 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
28398 contains the empty string.
28399
28400 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
28401 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
28402 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
28403 .code
28404 us-ascii
28405 gb2312 (Chinese)
28406 iso-8859-1
28407 .endd
28408 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
28409 case-insensitively.
28410
28411 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
28412 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
28413 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
28414 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
28415 only used for display purposes.
28416
28417 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
28418 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
28419 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
28420
28421 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
28422 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
28423 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
28424
28425 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
28426 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
28427 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
28428 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
28429 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
28430
28431 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
28432 This variable contains the normalized content of the
28433 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
28434 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
28435
28436 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
28437 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
28438 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
28439 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
28440 .code
28441 text/plain
28442 text/html
28443 application/octet-stream
28444 image/jpeg
28445 audio/midi
28446 .endd
28447 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
28448 empty string.
28449
28450 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
28451 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
28452 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
28453 containing the decoded data.
28454 .endlist
28455
28456 .cindex "RFC 2047"
28457 .vlist
28458 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
28459 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
28460 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
28461 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
28462 RFC2047 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done. If no filename was
28463 found, this variable contains the empty string.
28464
28465 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
28466 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
28467 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
28468 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
28469
28470 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
28471 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
28472 follows:
28473
28474 .olist
28475 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
28476
28477 .next
28478 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
28479 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
28480
28481 .next
28482 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
28483 and the rest are attachments.
28484
28485 .next
28486 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
28487 .endlist olist
28488
28489 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
28490 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
28491 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
28492 .code
28493 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
28494 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
28495 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
28496 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
28497 .endd
28498 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
28499 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
28500 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
28501 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
28502 want to carry out specific actions on them.
28503
28504 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
28505 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
28506 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
28507 decoding is fully recursive.
28508
28509 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
28510 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
28511 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
28512 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
28513 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
28514 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
28515 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
28516 .endlist
28517
28518
28519
28520 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
28521 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
28522 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
28523 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
28524 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
28525
28526 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
28527 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
28528 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
28529 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
28530 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
28531
28532 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
28533 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
28534 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
28535 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
28536 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
28537 32K characters are checked.
28538
28539 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
28540 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
28541 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
28542 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
28543 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
28544 .code
28545 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
28546 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
28547 .endd
28548 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
28549 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
28550 matching regular expression.
28551
28552 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
28553 CPU-intensive.
28554
28555
28556
28557
28558 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
28559 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
28560 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
28561 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
28562 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
28563 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
28564 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
28565 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
28566 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
28567 use the &%demime%& condition.
28568
28569 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
28570 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
28571 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
28572 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
28573 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
28574 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
28575
28576 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
28577 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
28578 example:
28579 .code
28580 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
28581 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
28582 .endd
28583 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
28584 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
28585 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
28586 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
28587
28588 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
28589 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
28590 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
28591
28592 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
28593
28594 .vlist
28595 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
28596 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
28597 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
28598 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
28599 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
28600 zero, no error occurred.
28601
28602 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
28603 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
28604 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
28605 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
28606 .endlist
28607
28608 .vlist
28609 .vitem &$found_extension$&
28610 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
28611 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
28612 extension it found.
28613 .endlist
28614
28615 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
28616 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
28617
28618 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
28619 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
28620 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
28621 facility:
28622 .code
28623 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
28624 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
28625 demime = *
28626 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
28627
28628 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
28629 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
28630 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
28631 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
28632
28633 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
28634 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
28635 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
28636 demime = exe:doc
28637 control = freeze
28638 .endd
28639 .ecindex IIDcosca
28640
28641
28642
28643
28644 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28645 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28646
28647 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
28648 "Local scan function"
28649 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
28650 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
28651 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
28652 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
28653 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
28654
28655 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
28656 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
28657 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
28658 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
28659 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
28660
28661 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
28662 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
28663 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
28664 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
28665
28666 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
28667 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
28668 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
28669 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
28670
28671 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
28672 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
28673 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
28674 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
28675 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
28676 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
28677 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
28678 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
28679 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
28680
28681
28682
28683 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
28684 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
28685 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
28686 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
28687 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
28688 directory, so you might set
28689 .code
28690 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
28691 .endd
28692 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
28693 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
28694 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
28695 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
28696 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
28697 _src/local_scan.c_.
28698
28699 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
28700 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
28701 .code
28702 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
28703 .endd
28704 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
28705
28706
28707
28708
28709 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
28710 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
28711 You must include this line near the start of your code:
28712 .code
28713 #include "local_scan.h"
28714 .endd
28715 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
28716 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
28717 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
28718 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
28719 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
28720 strings and pointers to character strings:
28721 .code
28722 #define CS (char *)
28723 #define CCS (const char *)
28724 #define CSS (char **)
28725 #define US (unsigned char *)
28726 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
28727 #define USS (unsigned char **)
28728 .endd
28729 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
28730 .code
28731 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
28732 .endd
28733 The arguments are as follows:
28734
28735 .ilist
28736 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
28737 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
28738 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
28739
28740 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
28741 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
28742 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
28743 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
28744 case this changes in some future version.
28745 .next
28746 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
28747 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
28748 .endlist
28749
28750 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
28751
28752 .vlist
28753 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
28754 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
28755 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
28756 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
28757 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
28758 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
28759
28760 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
28761 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
28762 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
28763
28764 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
28765 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
28766 queued without immediate delivery.
28767
28768 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
28769 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
28770 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
28771 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
28772 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
28773 used.
28774
28775 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
28776 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
28777 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
28778 problem"& is used.
28779
28780 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
28781 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
28782 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
28783 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
28784 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
28785 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
28786 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
28787
28788 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
28789 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
28790 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
28791 .endlist
28792
28793 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
28794 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
28795 &%-oe%& command line options.
28796
28797
28798
28799 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
28800 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
28801 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
28802 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
28803 want to do this, you must have the line
28804 .code
28805 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
28806 .endd
28807 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
28808 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
28809 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
28810 to define them.
28811
28812 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
28813 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
28814 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
28815 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
28816 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
28817 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
28818 .code
28819 static int my_integer_option = 42;
28820 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
28821
28822 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
28823 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
28824 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
28825 };
28826
28827 int local_scan_options_count =
28828 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
28829 .endd
28830 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
28831 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
28832 .code
28833 begin local_scan
28834 my_integer = 99
28835 my_string = some string of text...
28836 .endd
28837 The available types of option data are as follows:
28838
28839 .vlist
28840 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
28841 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
28842 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
28843 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
28844 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
28845 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
28846 values.)
28847
28848 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
28849 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
28850 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
28851 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
28852
28853 .vitem &*opt_int*&
28854 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
28855 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
28856 Exim.
28857
28858 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
28859 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
28860 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
28861 printed with the suffix K or M.
28862
28863 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
28864 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
28865 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
28866 always output in octal.
28867
28868 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
28869 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
28870 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
28871
28872 .vitem &*opt_time*&
28873 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
28874 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
28875 .endlist
28876
28877 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
28878 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
28879
28880
28881
28882 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
28883 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
28884 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
28885 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
28886 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
28887 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
28888 C variables are as follows:
28889
28890 .vlist
28891 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
28892 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
28893
28894 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
28895 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
28896
28897 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
28898 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
28899 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
28900 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
28901
28902 .ilist
28903 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
28904 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
28905 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
28906
28907 .next
28908 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
28909 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
28910 of debugging bits.
28911 .endlist ilist
28912
28913 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
28914 selected, you should use code like this:
28915 .code
28916 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
28917 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
28918 .endd
28919 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
28920 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
28921 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
28922
28923 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
28924 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
28925 discussed below.
28926
28927 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
28928 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
28929
28930 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
28931 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
28932
28933 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
28934 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
28935 &%-bh%& command line option.
28936
28937 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
28938 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
28939 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
28940
28941 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
28942 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
28943 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
28944 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
28945
28946 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
28947 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
28948 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
28949
28950 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
28951 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
28952
28953 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
28954 The number of accepted recipients.
28955
28956 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
28957 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
28958 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
28959 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
28960 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
28961 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
28962 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
28963 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
28964 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
28965 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
28966 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
28967 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
28968
28969 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
28970 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
28971
28972 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
28973 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
28974 locally-submitted messages.
28975
28976 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
28977 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
28978 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
28979
28980 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
28981 The name of the sending host, if known.
28982
28983 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
28984 The port on the sending host.
28985
28986 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
28987 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
28988
28989 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
28990 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
28991
28992 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
28993 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
28994 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
28995 .endlist
28996
28997
28998 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
28999 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
29000 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
29001 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
29002 their type to *.
29003
29004
29005 .vlist
29006 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
29007 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
29008
29009 .vitem &*int&~type*&
29010 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
29011 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
29012 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
29013 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
29014 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
29015 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
29016
29017 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
29018 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
29019 internal newlines.
29020
29021 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
29022 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
29023 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
29024 .endlist
29025
29026
29027
29028 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
29029 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
29030
29031 .vlist
29032 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
29033 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
29034
29035 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
29036 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
29037 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
29038 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
29039
29040 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
29041 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
29042 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
29043 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
29044 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
29045 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
29046 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
29047 is NULL for all recipients.
29048 .endlist
29049
29050
29051
29052 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
29053 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
29054 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
29055 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
29056 release:
29057
29058 .vlist
29059 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
29060 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
29061
29062 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
29063 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
29064 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
29065 for the process in &%newumask%&.
29066
29067 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
29068 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
29069 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
29070 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
29071 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
29072
29073 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
29074
29075 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
29076 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
29077 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
29078 return value is as follows:
29079
29080 .ilist
29081 >= 0
29082
29083 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
29084 ending status.
29085
29086 .next
29087 < 0 and > &--256
29088
29089 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
29090 signal number.
29091
29092 .next
29093 &--256
29094
29095 The process timed out.
29096 .next
29097 &--257
29098
29099 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
29100 .endlist
29101
29102 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
29103 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
29104 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
29105 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
29106 forks a subprocess that is running
29107 .code
29108 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
29109 .endd
29110 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
29111 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
29112 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
29113 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
29114
29115 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
29116 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
29117 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
29118 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
29119
29120
29121 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
29122 *sender_authentication)*&
29123 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
29124 that it runs is:
29125 .display
29126 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
29127 .endd
29128 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
29129
29130
29131 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
29132 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
29133 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
29134 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
29135 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
29136 .code
29137 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
29138 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
29139 .endd
29140
29141 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
29142 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
29143 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
29144 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
29145 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
29146 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
29147 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
29148 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
29149
29150 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
29151 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
29152 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
29153 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
29154 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
29155 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
29156
29157 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
29158 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
29159 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
29160 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
29161
29162 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
29163 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
29164 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
29165 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
29166 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
29167 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
29168 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
29169 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
29170 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
29171 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
29172 .code
29173 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
29174 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
29175 .endd
29176 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
29177 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
29178
29179
29180 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
29181 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
29182 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
29183 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
29184 match the specification, the function does nothing.
29185
29186
29187 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
29188 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
29189 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
29190 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
29191 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
29192 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
29193 .code
29194 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
29195 .endd
29196 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
29197 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
29198 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
29199 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
29200 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
29201 zero-terminated.
29202
29203 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
29204 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
29205 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
29206 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
29207 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
29208 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
29209 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
29210 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
29211
29212 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
29213 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
29214 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
29215 .display
29216 &`OK `& match succeeded
29217 &`FAIL `& match failed
29218 &`DEFER `& match deferred
29219 .endd
29220 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
29221 inability to contact a database.
29222
29223 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
29224 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
29225 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
29226 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
29227 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
29228
29229 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
29230 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
29231 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
29232 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
29233 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
29234
29235 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
29236 uschar&~*list)*&"
29237 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
29238 expected to be
29239 .code
29240 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
29241 .endd
29242 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
29243 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
29244 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
29245 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
29246 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
29247 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
29248 failed.
29249
29250 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
29251 *format,&~...)*&"
29252 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
29253 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
29254 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
29255 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
29256 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
29257 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
29258
29259
29260 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
29261 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
29262 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
29263 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
29264
29265 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
29266 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
29267 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
29268 value afterwards. For example:
29269 .code
29270 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
29271 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
29272 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
29273 .endd
29274
29275 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
29276 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
29277 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
29278 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
29279 address.
29280 .endlist
29281
29282
29283 .cindex "RFC 2047"
29284 .vlist
29285 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
29286 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
29287 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
29288 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
29289 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
29290 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
29291 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
29292 binary string is returned with an error message.
29293
29294 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
29295 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
29296 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
29297
29298 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
29299 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
29300 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
29301 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
29302 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
29303
29304 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
29305 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
29306 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
29307
29308 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
29309 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
29310 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
29311 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
29312 with translation.
29313
29314
29315 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
29316 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
29317 below.
29318
29319 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
29320 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
29321 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
29322 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
29323 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
29324 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
29325 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
29326 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
29327 is involved.
29328
29329 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
29330 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
29331
29332 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
29333 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
29334 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
29335 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
29336 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
29337 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
29338 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
29339 .code
29340 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
29341 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
29342 .endd
29343 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
29344 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
29345 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
29346 multiple output lines.
29347
29348 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
29349 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
29350 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
29351 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
29352 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
29353 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
29354 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
29355 is an error.
29356
29357 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
29358 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
29359 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
29360 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
29361
29362 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
29363 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
29364 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
29365
29366 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
29367 See below.
29368
29369 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
29370 See below.
29371
29372 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
29373 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
29374 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
29375 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
29376 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
29377 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
29378 more discussion.
29379 .endlist
29380
29381
29382
29383 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
29384 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
29385 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
29386 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
29387 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
29388 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
29389 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
29390 terminates.
29391
29392 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
29393 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
29394 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
29395 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
29396
29397 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
29398 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
29399 .code
29400 store_pool = POOL_PERM
29401 .endd
29402 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
29403 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
29404 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
29405 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
29406
29407 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
29408 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
29409 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
29410 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
29411 &%store_pool%&.
29412 .ecindex IIDlosca
29413
29414
29415
29416
29417 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29418 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29419
29420 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
29421 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
29422 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
29423 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
29424 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
29425 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
29426 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
29427 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
29428
29429 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
29430 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
29431 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
29432 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
29433 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
29434
29435 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
29436 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
29437 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
29438 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
29439 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
29440 prevent it happening on retries.
29441
29442 .vindex "&$domain$&"
29443 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
29444 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
29445 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
29446 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
29447 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
29448 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
29449 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
29450
29451
29452 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
29453 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
29454 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
29455 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
29456 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
29457 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
29458 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
29459 .code
29460 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
29461 system_filter_user = exim
29462 .endd
29463 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
29464 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
29465 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
29466 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
29467 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
29468 by the &%reply%& command.
29469
29470
29471 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
29472 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
29473 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
29474 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
29475
29476 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
29477 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
29478
29479
29480
29481 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
29482 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
29483 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
29484 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
29485 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
29486 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
29487 they cause errors.
29488
29489 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
29490 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
29491 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
29492 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
29493 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
29494 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
29495 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
29496
29497 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
29498 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
29499 succeed, it will not be tried again.
29500 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
29501 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
29502
29503 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
29504 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
29505 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
29506 to which users' filter files can refer.
29507
29508
29509
29510 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
29511 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
29512 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
29513 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
29514 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
29515
29516
29517
29518 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
29519 .cindex "freezing messages"
29520 .cindex "message" "freezing"
29521 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
29522 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
29523 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
29524 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
29525 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
29526 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
29527 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
29528 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
29529 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
29530 .code
29531 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
29532 .endd
29533 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
29534
29535 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
29536 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
29537 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
29538 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
29539 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
29540 run.
29541
29542 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
29543 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
29544 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
29545 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
29546
29547 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
29548 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
29549 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
29550 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
29551 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
29552 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
29553 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
29554 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
29555 message. For example:
29556 .code
29557 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
29558 because it contains attachments that we are \
29559 not prepared to receive."
29560 .endd
29561
29562 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
29563 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
29564 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
29565 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
29566 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
29567 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
29568 use, for example
29569 .code
29570 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
29571 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
29572 .endd
29573 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
29574 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
29575 generated by the filter.
29576
29577 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
29578 &%defer%&,
29579 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
29580 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
29581 as
29582 .code
29583 mail ...
29584 freeze
29585 .endd
29586 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
29587 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
29588 take place.
29589
29590
29591
29592 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
29593 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
29594 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
29595 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
29596 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
29597 .code
29598 headers add <string>
29599 headers remove <string>
29600 .endd
29601 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
29602 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
29603 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
29604 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
29605 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
29606
29607 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
29608 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
29609 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
29610 example:
29611 .code
29612 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
29613 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
29614 X-header-2: ...."
29615 .endd
29616 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
29617 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
29618 space after input continuations is ignored.
29619
29620 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
29621 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
29622 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
29623 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
29624 header with the same name, they are all removed.
29625
29626 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
29627 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
29628 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
29629 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
29630 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
29631 used for all recipients of the message.
29632
29633 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
29634 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
29635 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
29636 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
29637 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
29638 until the message is actually being written (see section
29639 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
29640
29641 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
29642 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
29643 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
29644 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
29645 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
29646 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
29647 modified more than once.
29648
29649 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
29650 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
29651 For example:
29652 .code
29653 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
29654 headers remove "Subject"
29655 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
29656 headers remove "Old-Subject"
29657 .endd
29658
29659
29660
29661 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
29662 .cindex "envelope sender"
29663 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
29664 .code
29665 errors_to <some address>
29666 .endd
29667 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
29668 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
29669 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
29670 might use
29671 .code
29672 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
29673 .endd
29674 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
29675 address if its delivery failed.
29676
29677
29678
29679 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
29680 .vindex "&$domain$&"
29681 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
29682 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
29683 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
29684 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
29685 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
29686 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
29687 which implements such a filter:
29688 .code
29689 central_filter:
29690 check_local_user
29691 driver = redirect
29692 domains = +local_domains
29693 file = /central/filters/$local_part
29694 no_verify
29695 allow_filter
29696 allow_freeze
29697 .endd
29698 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
29699 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
29700 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
29701 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
29702
29703 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
29704 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
29705 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
29706 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
29707 normal way.
29708 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
29709 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
29710 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
29711
29712
29713
29714
29715
29716
29717 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29718 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29719
29720 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
29721 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
29722 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
29723 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
29724 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
29725 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
29726 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
29727 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
29728
29729 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
29730 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
29731 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
29732 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
29733 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
29734
29735 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
29736 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
29737 loopback interface specially in any way.
29738
29739 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
29740 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
29741
29742
29743
29744
29745 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
29746 .cindex "message" "submission"
29747 .cindex "submission mode"
29748 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
29749 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
29750 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
29751 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
29752 .code
29753 control = submission
29754 .endd
29755 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
29756 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
29757 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
29758 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
29759 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
29760 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
29761 .code
29762 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
29763 control = submission
29764 .endd
29765 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
29766 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
29767 is used to separate options. For example:
29768 .code
29769 control = submission/sender_retain
29770 .endd
29771 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
29772 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
29773 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
29774 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
29775 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
29776 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
29777 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
29778
29779 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
29780 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
29781 example:
29782 .code
29783 control = submission/domain=some.domain
29784 .endd
29785 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
29786 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
29787 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
29788 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
29789 .code
29790 accept authenticated = *
29791 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
29792 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
29793 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
29794 .endd
29795 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
29796 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
29797 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
29798 .code
29799 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
29800 .endd
29801 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
29802 line would be:
29803 .code
29804 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
29805 .endd
29806 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
29807 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
29808 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
29809 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
29810
29811 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
29812 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
29813 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
29814 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
29815 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
29816 spoof another's address.
29817
29818 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
29819 .cindex "line endings"
29820 .cindex "carriage return"
29821 .cindex "linefeed"
29822 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
29823 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
29824 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
29825 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
29826 use CRLF or just CR.
29827
29828 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
29829 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
29830 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
29831 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
29832 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
29833 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
29834 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
29835 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
29836 follows:
29837
29838 .ilist
29839 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
29840 .next
29841 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
29842 is ignored.
29843 .next
29844 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
29845 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
29846 terminator.
29847 .next
29848 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
29849 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
29850 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
29851 people trying to play silly games.
29852 .next
29853 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
29854 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
29855 line.
29856 .endlist
29857
29858
29859
29860
29861
29862 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
29863 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
29864 .cindex "address" "qualification"
29865 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
29866 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
29867 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
29868 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
29869 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
29870
29871 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
29872 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
29873 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
29874 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
29875 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
29876
29877 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
29878 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
29879 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
29880 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
29881 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
29882 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
29883 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
29884 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
29885
29886
29887
29888
29889 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
29890 .cindex "&""From""& line"
29891 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
29892 .cindex "sender" "address"
29893 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
29894 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
29895 .cindex "envelope sender"
29896 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
29897 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
29898 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
29899 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
29900 .code
29901 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
29902 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
29903 .endd
29904 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
29905 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
29906 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
29907 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
29908 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
29909 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
29910 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
29911 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
29912 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
29913
29914 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
29915 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
29916 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
29917 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
29918 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
29919 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
29920 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
29921
29922 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
29923 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
29924 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
29925
29926 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
29927 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
29928 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
29929 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
29930
29931
29932
29933 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
29934 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
29935 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
29936 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
29937 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
29938 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
29939 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
29940
29941 .blockquote
29942 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
29943 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
29944 .endblockquote
29945
29946 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
29947 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
29948 follows:
29949
29950 .ilist
29951 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
29952 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
29953 .next
29954 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
29955 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
29956 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
29957 .next
29958 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
29959 also removed.
29960 .next
29961 For a locally-submitted message,
29962 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
29963 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
29964 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
29965 included in log lines in this case.
29966 .next
29967 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
29968 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
29969 .endlist
29970
29971
29972
29973
29974 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
29975 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
29976 includes the header line:
29977 .code
29978 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
29979 .endd
29980
29981 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
29982 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
29983 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
29984 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
29985 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
29986 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
29987
29988
29989 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
29990 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
29991 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
29992 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
29993 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
29994
29995 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
29996 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
29997 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
29998 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
29999 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
30000 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
30001 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
30002 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
30003 messages.
30004
30005
30006 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
30007 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
30008 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
30009 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
30010 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
30011 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
30012 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
30013 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
30014 messages.
30015
30016
30017 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
30018 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
30019 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
30020 .cindex "message" "submission"
30021 .cindex "submission mode"
30022 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
30023 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
30024
30025 .ilist
30026 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
30027 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
30028 .next
30029 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
30030 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
30031 .olist
30032 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
30033 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
30034 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
30035 .next
30036 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
30037 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
30038 .next
30039 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
30040 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
30041 .endlist
30042 .endlist
30043
30044 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
30045
30046 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
30047 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
30048 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
30049 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
30050 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
30051 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
30052 &%qualify_domain%&.
30053
30054 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
30055 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
30056 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
30057 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
30058
30059
30060 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
30061 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
30062 .cindex "message" "submission"
30063 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
30064 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
30065 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
30066 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
30067 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
30068 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
30069 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
30070 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
30071 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
30072 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
30073
30074
30075 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
30076 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
30077 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
30078 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
30079 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
30080
30081 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
30082 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
30083 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
30084 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
30085
30086 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
30087 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
30088 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
30089
30090
30091 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
30092 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
30093 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
30094 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
30095 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
30096 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
30097 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
30098 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
30099 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
30100 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
30101 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
30102
30103
30104
30105 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
30106 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
30107 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
30108 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
30109 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
30110 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
30111 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
30112 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
30113
30114
30115
30116 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
30117 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
30118 .cindex "message" "submission"
30119 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
30120 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
30121 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
30122 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
30123 control setting.
30124
30125 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
30126 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
30127 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
30128 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
30129 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
30130 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
30131 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
30132 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
30133 line is added to the message.
30134
30135 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
30136 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
30137 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
30138 options true at the same time.
30139
30140 .cindex "submission mode"
30141 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
30142 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
30143 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
30144 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
30145
30146 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
30147 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
30148 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
30149 created as follows:
30150
30151 .ilist
30152 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
30153 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
30154 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
30155 .next
30156 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
30157 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
30158 .next
30159 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
30160 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
30161 .endlist
30162
30163 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
30164 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
30165 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
30166 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
30167
30168 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
30169 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
30170 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
30171 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
30172
30173
30174
30175 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
30176 "SECTheadersaddrem"
30177 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
30178 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
30179 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
30180 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
30181 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
30182 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
30183 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
30184
30185 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
30186 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
30187 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
30188 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
30189 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
30190 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
30191
30192 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
30193 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
30194 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
30195
30196 For both routers and transports, the result of expanding a &%headers_add%&
30197 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
30198 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
30199 .code
30200 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
30201 X-added-second: another added header line
30202 .endd
30203 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
30204
30205 The result of expanding &%headers_remove%& must consist of a colon-separated
30206 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
30207 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
30208 not part of the names. For example:
30209 .code
30210 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
30211 .endd
30212 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router, its value
30213 is expanded at routing time, and then associated with all addresses that are
30214 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
30215 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
30216 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
30217
30218 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
30219 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
30220 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
30221 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
30222
30223 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
30224 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
30225 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
30226 requirements.
30227
30228 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
30229 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
30230 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
30231 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
30232 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
30233 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
30234 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
30235
30236 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
30237 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
30238 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
30239 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
30240
30241 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
30242 the following consequences:
30243
30244 .ilist
30245 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
30246 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
30247 to it, at all times.
30248 .next
30249 Header lines that are added by a router's
30250 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
30251 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
30252 .next
30253 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
30254 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
30255 .next
30256 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
30257 a later router or by a transport.
30258 .next
30259 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
30260 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
30261 .code
30262 headers_remove = subject
30263 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
30264 .endd
30265 .endlist
30266
30267 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
30268 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
30269
30270
30271
30272
30273
30274 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
30275 .cindex "address" "constructed"
30276 .cindex "constructed address"
30277 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
30278 the form
30279 .display
30280 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
30281 .endd
30282 For example:
30283 .code
30284 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
30285 .endd
30286 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
30287 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
30288 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
30289 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
30290 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
30291 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
30292 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
30293 there is no password file entry.
30294
30295 .cindex "RFC 2047"
30296 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
30297 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
30298 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
30299 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
30300 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
30301 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
30302 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
30303 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
30304
30305
30306
30307 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
30308 .cindex "case of local parts"
30309 .cindex "local part" "case of"
30310 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
30311 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
30312 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
30313 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
30314 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
30315 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
30316 router option.
30317
30318 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
30319 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
30320 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
30321 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
30322 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
30323 .code
30324 correct_case:
30325 driver = redirect
30326 domains = +local_domains
30327 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
30328 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
30329 @$domain
30330 .endd
30331 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
30332 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
30333 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
30334 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
30335 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
30336
30337
30338
30339 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
30340 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
30341 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
30342 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
30343 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
30344 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
30345 empty components for compatibility.
30346
30347
30348
30349 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
30350 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
30351 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
30352 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
30353 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
30354 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
30355
30356 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
30357 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
30358 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
30359 example, a header such as
30360 .code
30361 To: hare@teaparty
30362 .endd
30363 might get rewritten as
30364 .code
30365 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
30366 .endd
30367 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
30368 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
30369 been routed.
30370
30371 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
30372 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
30373 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
30374 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
30375 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
30376 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
30377 .ecindex IIDmesproc
30378
30379
30380
30381 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30382 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30383
30384 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
30385 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
30386 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
30387 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
30388 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
30389 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
30390 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
30391
30392 .ilist
30393 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
30394 .next
30395 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
30396 .next
30397 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
30398 .endlist
30399
30400 For mail delivery, the following are available:
30401
30402 .ilist
30403 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
30404 .next
30405 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
30406 &"lmtp"&);
30407 .next
30408 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
30409 transport);
30410 .next
30411 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
30412 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
30413 .endlist
30414
30415 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
30416 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
30417 used to contain the envelope information.
30418
30419
30420
30421 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
30422 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
30423 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
30424 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
30425 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
30426 .cindex "EHLO"
30427 .cindex "HELO"
30428 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
30429 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
30430 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
30431 processing is the same in both cases.
30432
30433 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
30434 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
30435 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
30436 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
30437 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
30438 .cindex "transport" "filter"
30439 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
30440 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
30441 suppressed.
30442
30443 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
30444 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
30445 required for the transaction.
30446
30447 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
30448 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
30449 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
30450
30451 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
30452 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
30453 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
30454
30455 .cindex "carriage return"
30456 .cindex "linefeed"
30457 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
30458 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
30459 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
30460 line terminator.
30461
30462 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
30463 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
30464 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
30465 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
30466 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
30467 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
30468 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
30469 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
30470 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
30471
30472 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
30473 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
30474 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
30475 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
30476
30477 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
30478 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
30479 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
30480 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
30481
30482 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
30483 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
30484 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
30485 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
30486 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
30487 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
30488 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
30489 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
30490 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
30491 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
30492
30493 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
30494 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
30495
30496 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
30497 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
30498 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
30499 square bracket of the IP address.
30500
30501
30502
30503
30504 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
30505 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
30506 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
30507 .cindex "host" "error"
30508 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
30509 message errors, and recipient errors.
30510
30511 .vlist
30512 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
30513 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
30514 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
30515
30516 .ilist
30517 Connection refused or timed out,
30518 .next
30519 Any error response code on connection,
30520 .next
30521 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
30522 .next
30523 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
30524 .next
30525 I/O errors at any time,
30526 .next
30527 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
30528 the &"."& at the end of the data.
30529 .endlist ilist
30530
30531 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
30532 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
30533 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
30534 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
30535 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
30536 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
30537 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
30538 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
30539
30540 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
30541 .cindex "message" "error"
30542 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
30543 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
30544 message errors are:
30545
30546 .ilist
30547 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
30548 the data,
30549 .next
30550 Timeout after MAIL,
30551 .next
30552 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
30553 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
30554 connection at any other time.
30555 .endlist ilist
30556
30557 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
30558 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
30559 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
30560 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
30561 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
30562 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
30563 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
30564 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
30565 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
30566 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
30567
30568 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
30569 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
30570 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
30571 response to MAIL.
30572
30573 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
30574 .cindex "recipient" "error"
30575 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
30576 recipient errors are:
30577
30578 .ilist
30579 Any error response to RCPT,
30580 .next
30581 Timeout after RCPT.
30582 .endlist
30583
30584 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
30585 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
30586 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
30587 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
30588 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
30589 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
30590 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
30591 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
30592 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
30593 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
30594 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
30595 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
30596 the retry clock is reset.
30597
30598 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
30599 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
30600 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
30601 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
30602 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
30603 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
30604 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
30605 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
30606 recipient's retry time.
30607 .endlist
30608
30609 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
30610 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
30611 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
30612 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
30613 until the next delivery attempt.
30614
30615 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
30616 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
30617 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
30618 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
30619 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
30620 is created.
30621
30622 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
30623 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
30624 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
30625 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
30626 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
30627 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
30628 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
30629
30630 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
30631 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
30632 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
30633 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
30634 then to be treated as a host error.
30635
30636 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
30637 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
30638 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
30639 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
30640 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
30641
30642
30643
30644
30645 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
30646 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
30647 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
30648 .cindex "inetd"
30649 .cindex "daemon"
30650 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
30651 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
30652 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
30653 .code
30654 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
30655 .endd
30656 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
30657 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
30658 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
30659 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
30660 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
30661 stream and exits with an error code.
30662
30663 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
30664 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
30665 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
30666 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
30667
30668 .cindex "carriage return"
30669 .cindex "linefeed"
30670 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
30671 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
30672 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
30673 line terminator.
30674 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
30675 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
30676 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
30677
30678 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
30679 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
30680 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
30681 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
30682 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
30683 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
30684 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
30685 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
30686
30687 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
30688 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
30689 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
30690 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
30691 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
30692 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
30693 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
30694 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
30695 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
30696
30697 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
30698 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
30699 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
30700
30701 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
30702 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
30703 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
30704 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
30705 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
30706
30707 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
30708 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
30709 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
30710 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
30711 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
30712 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
30713 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
30714
30715 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
30716 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
30717 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
30718 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
30719 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
30720
30721 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
30722 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
30723 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
30724 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
30725 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
30726 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
30727 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
30728 a delivery process.
30729
30730 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
30731 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
30732 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
30733 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
30734 however, available with &'inetd'&.
30735
30736 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
30737 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
30738 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
30739 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
30740
30741 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
30742 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
30743 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
30744
30745
30746
30747 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
30748 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
30749 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
30750 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
30751 the error response to the last command. The default value for
30752 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
30753 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
30754 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
30755
30756
30757 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
30758 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
30759 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
30760 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
30761 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
30762 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
30763 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
30764 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
30765 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
30766 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
30767 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
30768
30769
30770
30771 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
30772 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
30773 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
30774 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
30775 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
30776 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
30777 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
30778 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
30779
30780 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
30781 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
30782 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
30783 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
30784 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
30785 counted.
30786
30787 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
30788 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
30789 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
30790
30791 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
30792 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
30793 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
30794 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
30795 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
30796
30797
30798
30799
30800 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
30801 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
30802 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
30803 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
30804 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
30805
30806 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
30807 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
30808 called with the &%-bv%& option.
30809
30810 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
30811 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
30812 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
30813 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
30814 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
30815 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
30816 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
30817 RCPT failures.
30818
30819
30820
30821 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
30822 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
30823 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
30824 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
30825 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
30826 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
30827 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
30828
30829 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
30830 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
30831 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
30832 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
30833 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
30834 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
30835 argument. For example,
30836 .code
30837 ETRN #brigadoon
30838 .endd
30839 runs the command
30840 .code
30841 exim -R brigadoon
30842 .endd
30843 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
30844 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
30845 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
30846 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
30847 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
30848
30849 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
30850 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
30851 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
30852 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
30853 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
30854 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
30855 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
30856 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
30857
30858 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
30859 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
30860 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
30861 whatever the form of its argument. For
30862 example:
30863 .code
30864 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
30865 $sender_host_address
30866 .endd
30867 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30868 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
30869 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
30870 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
30871 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
30872 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
30873 for it to change them before running the command.
30874
30875
30876
30877 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
30878 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
30879 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
30880 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
30881 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
30882 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
30883 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
30884 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
30885 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
30886 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
30887 runs for RCPT commands:
30888 .code
30889 accept hosts = :
30890 .endd
30891 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
30892
30893
30894
30895 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
30896 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
30897 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
30898 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
30899 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
30900 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
30901 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
30902 envelope along with the message.
30903
30904 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
30905 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
30906 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
30907 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
30908 can be used to specify it.
30909
30910 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
30911 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
30912 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
30913 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
30914 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
30915
30916 .vindex "&$host$&"
30917 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
30918 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
30919 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
30920 router:
30921 .code
30922 begin routers
30923 route_append:
30924 driver = manualroute
30925 transport = smtp_appendfile
30926 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
30927
30928 begin transports
30929 smtp_appendfile:
30930 driver = appendfile
30931 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
30932 batch_max = 1000
30933 use_bsmtp
30934 user = exim
30935 .endd
30936 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
30937 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
30938 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
30939
30940
30941
30942 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
30943 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
30944 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
30945 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
30946 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
30947 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
30948 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
30949 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
30950 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
30951 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
30952
30953 No policy checking is done for BSMTP input. That is, no ACL is run at anytime.
30954 In this respect it is like non-SMTP local input.
30955
30956 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
30957 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
30958 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
30959 make some use of automatically, for example:
30960 .code
30961 554 Unexpected end of file
30962 Transaction started in line 10
30963 Error detected in line 14
30964 .endd
30965 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
30966 file, for example:
30967 .code
30968 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
30969 The error message was:
30970
30971 501 '>' missing at end of address
30972
30973 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
30974 The error was detected in line 12.
30975 The SMTP command at fault was:
30976
30977 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
30978
30979 1 previous message was successfully processed.
30980 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
30981 .endd
30982 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
30983 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
30984 accepted.
30985 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
30986 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
30987
30988
30989
30990 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30991 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30992
30993 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
30994 "Customizing messages"
30995 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
30996 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
30997 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
30998 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
30999 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
31000
31001 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
31002 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
31003 option. Exim also adds the line
31004 .code
31005 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
31006 .endd
31007 to all warning and bounce messages,
31008
31009
31010 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
31011 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
31012 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
31013 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
31014 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
31015 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
31016 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
31017
31018 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
31019 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
31020 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
31021 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
31022 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
31023 item.
31024
31025 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
31026 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
31027 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
31028 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
31029 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
31030 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
31031 option, rounded to a whole number.
31032
31033 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
31034
31035 .ilist
31036 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
31037 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
31038 .next
31039 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
31040 failing addresses with their error messages.
31041 .next
31042 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
31043 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
31044 .next
31045 The fourth item is used to introduce the copy of the message that is returned
31046 as part of the error report.
31047 .next
31048 The fifth item is added after the fourth one if the returned message is
31049 truncated because it is bigger than &%return_size_limit%&.
31050 .next
31051 The sixth item is added after the copy of the original message.
31052 .endlist
31053
31054 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
31055 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
31056 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
31057 .code
31058 Subject: Mail delivery failed
31059 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
31060 {: returning message to sender}}
31061 ****
31062 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
31063
31064 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
31065 {that you sent }{sent by
31066
31067 <$sender_address>
31068
31069 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
31070 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
31071 ****
31072 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
31073 ****
31074 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
31075 ------
31076 ****
31077 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
31078 only the first
31079 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
31080 ****
31081 .endd
31082 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
31083 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
31084 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
31085 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
31086 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
31087 text sections:
31088
31089 .ilist
31090 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
31091 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
31092 .next
31093 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
31094 the delayed addresses.
31095 .next
31096 The third item then ends the message.
31097 .endlist
31098
31099 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
31100 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
31101 .code
31102 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
31103 $warn_message_delay
31104 ****
31105 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
31106
31107 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
31108 {that you sent }{sent by
31109
31110 <$sender_address>
31111
31112 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
31113 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
31114
31115 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
31116 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
31117 The date of the message is: $h_date
31118
31119 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
31120 ****
31121 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
31122 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
31123 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
31124 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
31125 the message will be returned to you.
31126 .endd
31127 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
31128 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
31129 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
31130 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
31131 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
31132 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
31133 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
31134 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
31135 handled them.
31136
31137
31138
31139
31140 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31141 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31142
31143 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
31144 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
31145 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
31146
31147
31148
31149 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
31150 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
31151 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
31152 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
31153 routing explicitly:
31154 .code
31155 send_to_smart_host:
31156 driver = manualroute
31157 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
31158 transport = remote_smtp
31159 .endd
31160 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
31161 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
31162 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
31163 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
31164 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
31165
31166
31167
31168
31169 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
31170 .cindex "mailing lists"
31171 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
31172 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
31173 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
31174
31175 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
31176 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
31177 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
31178 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
31179 .code
31180 lists:
31181 driver = redirect
31182 domains = lists.example
31183 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
31184 forbid_pipe
31185 forbid_file
31186 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
31187 no_more
31188 .endd
31189 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
31190 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
31191 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
31192 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
31193
31194 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
31195 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
31196 a mailing list.
31197
31198 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
31199 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
31200 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
31201 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
31202 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
31203
31204 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
31205 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
31206 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
31207 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
31208 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
31209 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
31210 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
31211 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
31212 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
31213
31214
31215
31216 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
31217 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
31218 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
31219 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
31220 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
31221 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
31222 addresses are not rigorously checked.
31223
31224 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
31225 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
31226 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
31227 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
31228 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
31229
31230
31231
31232 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
31233 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
31234 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
31235 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
31236 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
31237 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
31238 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
31239 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
31240 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
31241 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
31242
31243 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
31244 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
31245 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
31246 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
31247 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
31248 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
31249 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
31250 pre-existing messages.
31251
31252 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
31253 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
31254 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
31255 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
31256 one level of expansion anyway.
31257
31258
31259
31260 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
31261 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
31262 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
31263 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
31264 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
31265 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
31266
31267 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
31268 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
31269 .code
31270 lists_request:
31271 driver = redirect
31272 domains = lists.example
31273 local_part_suffix = -request
31274 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
31275 no_more
31276
31277 lists_post:
31278 driver = redirect
31279 domains = lists.example
31280 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
31281 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
31282 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
31283 forbid_pipe
31284 forbid_file
31285 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
31286 no_more
31287
31288 lists_closed:
31289 driver = redirect
31290 domains = lists.example
31291 allow_fail
31292 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
31293 .endd
31294 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
31295 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
31296 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
31297 mailing list.
31298
31299 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
31300 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
31301 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
31302 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
31303 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
31304 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
31305 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
31306 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
31307 &"unrouteable address"& error.
31308
31309 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
31310 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
31311 the address, giving a suitable error message.
31312
31313
31314
31315
31316 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
31317 .cindex "VERP"
31318 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
31319 .cindex "envelope sender"
31320 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
31321 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
31322 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
31323 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
31324 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
31325 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
31326
31327 .oindex &%errors_to%&
31328 .oindex &%return_path%&
31329 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
31330 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
31331 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
31332 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
31333 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
31334 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
31335 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
31336 .code
31337 verp_smtp:
31338 driver = smtp
31339 max_rcpt = 1
31340 return_path = \
31341 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
31342 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
31343 .endd
31344 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
31345 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
31346 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
31347 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
31348 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
31349 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
31350 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
31351 rewritten as
31352 .code
31353 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
31354 .endd
31355 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
31356 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
31357 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
31358 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
31359 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
31360 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
31361
31362 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
31363 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
31364 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
31365 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
31366 .code
31367 dnslookup:
31368 driver = dnslookup
31369 domains = ! +local_domains
31370 transport = \
31371 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
31372 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
31373 no_more
31374 .endd
31375 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
31376 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
31377 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
31378 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
31379 address.
31380
31381 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
31382 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
31383 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
31384 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
31385 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
31386 .code
31387 verp_dnslookup:
31388 driver = dnslookup
31389 domains = ! +local_domains
31390 transport = remote_smtp
31391 errors_to = \
31392 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
31393 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
31394 no_more
31395 .endd
31396 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
31397 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
31398 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
31399 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
31400 them.
31401
31402 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
31403 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
31404 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
31405 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
31406 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
31407 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
31408 used).
31409
31410
31411
31412
31413
31414
31415 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
31416 .cindex "virtual domains"
31417 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
31418 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
31419 meanings:
31420
31421 .ilist
31422 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
31423 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
31424 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
31425 .next
31426 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
31427 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
31428 have login accounts on that host.
31429 .endlist
31430
31431 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
31432 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
31433 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
31434 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
31435 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
31436 to a router of this form:
31437 .code
31438 virtual:
31439 driver = redirect
31440 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
31441 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
31442 no_more
31443 .endd
31444 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
31445 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
31446 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
31447 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
31448 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
31449 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
31450
31451 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
31452 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
31453 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
31454 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
31455
31456 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
31457 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
31458 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
31459 .code
31460 my_domains:
31461 driver = accept
31462 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
31463 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
31464 transport = my_mailboxes
31465 .endd
31466 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
31467 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
31468 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
31469 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
31470 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
31471 follows:
31472 .code
31473 my_mailboxes:
31474 driver = appendfile
31475 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
31476 user = mail
31477 .endd
31478 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
31479 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
31480
31481 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
31482 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
31483 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
31484 information about the domains.
31485
31486
31487
31488 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
31489 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
31490 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
31491 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
31492 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
31493 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
31494 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
31495 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
31496 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
31497 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
31498 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
31499 example, consider this router:
31500 .code
31501 userforward:
31502 driver = redirect
31503 check_local_user
31504 file = $home/.forward
31505 local_part_suffix = -*
31506 local_part_suffix_optional
31507 allow_filter
31508 .endd
31509 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
31510 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
31511 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
31512 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
31513 .code
31514 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
31515 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
31516 endif
31517 .endd
31518 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
31519 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
31520 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
31521 control over which suffixes are valid.
31522
31523 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
31524 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
31525 another MTA:
31526 .code
31527 userforward:
31528 driver = redirect
31529 check_local_user
31530 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
31531 local_part_suffix = -*
31532 local_part_suffix_optional
31533 allow_filter
31534 .endd
31535 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
31536 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
31537 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
31538 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
31539 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
31540
31541
31542
31543 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
31544 .cindex "vacation processing"
31545 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
31546 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
31547 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
31548 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
31549 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
31550
31551 .ilist
31552 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
31553 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
31554 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
31555 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
31556 .code
31557 spqr, vacation-spqr
31558 .endd
31559 .next
31560 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
31561 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
31562 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
31563 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
31564 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
31565 message.
31566 .endlist
31567
31568 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
31569 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
31570
31571
31572
31573 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
31574 .cindex "message" "copying every"
31575 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
31576 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
31577 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
31578 each day's messages.
31579
31580 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
31581 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
31582 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
31583 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
31584
31585
31586
31587 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
31588 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
31589 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
31590 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
31591 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
31592 permanently connected.
31593
31594 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
31595 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
31596 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
31597
31598
31599 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
31600 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
31601 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
31602 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
31603 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
31604 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
31605 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
31606 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
31607
31608 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
31609 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
31610 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
31611 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
31612 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
31613 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
31614 if required.
31615
31616 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
31617 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
31618 intermittent host. For example:
31619 .code
31620 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
31621 .endd
31622 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
31623 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
31624 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
31625 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
31626 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
31627 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
31628 immediately.
31629
31630 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
31631 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
31632 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
31633 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
31634 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
31635 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
31636 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
31637
31638
31639
31640 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
31641 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
31642 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
31643 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
31644 delivered immediately.
31645
31646 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
31647 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
31648 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
31649 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
31650 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
31651 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
31652 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
31653 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
31654 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
31655 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
31656 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
31657 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
31658 single SMTP connection.
31659
31660
31661
31662 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31663 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31664
31665 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
31666 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
31667 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
31668 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
31669 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
31670 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
31671 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
31672 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
31673 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
31674 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
31675 messages this way.
31676
31677 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
31678 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
31679 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
31680 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
31681 email is not desirable.
31682
31683 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
31684 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
31685 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
31686 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
31687 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
31688 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
31689 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
31690
31691 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
31692 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
31693 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
31694 before sending a message to the smart host.
31695
31696 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
31697 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
31698 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
31699
31700 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
31701 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
31702 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
31703 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
31704 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
31705 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
31706 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
31707
31708 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
31709 following ways:
31710
31711 .ilist
31712 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
31713 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
31714 .next
31715 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
31716 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
31717 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
31718 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
31719 successful, a zero return code is given.
31720 .next
31721 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
31722 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
31723 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
31724 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
31725 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
31726 are.
31727 .next
31728 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
31729 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
31730 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
31731 .next
31732 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
31733 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
31734 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
31735 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
31736 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
31737 .next
31738 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
31739 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
31740 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
31741 .next
31742 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
31743 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
31744 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
31745 are ever generated.
31746 .next
31747 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
31748 .next
31749 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
31750 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
31751 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
31752 .endlist
31753
31754 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
31755 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
31756 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
31757 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
31758 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
31759 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
31760
31761
31762
31763
31764 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31765 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31766
31767 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
31768 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
31769 .cindex "log" "types of"
31770 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
31771 and the panic log:
31772
31773 .ilist
31774 .cindex "main log"
31775 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
31776 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
31777 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
31778 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
31779 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
31780 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
31781 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
31782 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
31783 .next
31784 .cindex "reject log"
31785 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
31786 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
31787 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
31788 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
31789 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
31790 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
31791 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
31792 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
31793 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
31794 false.
31795 .next
31796 .cindex "panic log"
31797 .cindex "system log"
31798 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
31799 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
31800 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
31801 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
31802 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
31803 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
31804 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
31805 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
31806 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
31807 .endlist
31808
31809 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
31810 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
31811 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
31812 .code
31813 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
31814 by QUIT
31815 .endd
31816 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
31817 ways of changing this:
31818
31819 .ilist
31820 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
31821 you set
31822 .code
31823 timezone = UTC
31824 .endd
31825 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
31826 .next
31827 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
31828 example:
31829 .code
31830 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
31831 .endd
31832 .endlist
31833
31834 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
31835 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
31836 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
31837 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
31838 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
31839 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
31840
31841
31842
31843
31844 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
31845 .cindex "log" "destination"
31846 .cindex "log" "to file"
31847 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
31848 .cindex "syslog"
31849 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
31850 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
31851 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
31852 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
31853 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
31854 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
31855 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
31856
31857 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
31858 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
31859 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
31860 references to the host name:
31861 .code
31862 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
31863 .endd
31864 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
31865 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
31866 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
31867 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
31868 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
31869 log at all.
31870
31871 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
31872 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
31873 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
31874 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
31875 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
31876 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
31877 implying the use of a default path.
31878
31879 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
31880 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
31881 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
31882 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
31883 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
31884 equivalent to the setting:
31885 .code
31886 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
31887 .endd
31888 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time, that is where the
31889 logs are written.
31890
31891 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& if datestamped log file names are in
31892 use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
31893
31894 Here are some examples of possible settings:
31895 .display
31896 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
31897 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
31898 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
31899 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
31900 .endd
31901 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
31902 error is logged.
31903
31904
31905
31906 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
31907 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
31908 .cindex "cycling logs"
31909 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
31910 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
31911 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
31912 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
31913 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
31914 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
31915 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
31916
31917 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
31918 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
31919 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
31920 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
31921 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
31922 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
31923 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
31924 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
31925 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
31926 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
31927 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
31928 renamed.
31929
31930
31931
31932 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
31933 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
31934 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
31935 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
31936 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_&.
31937 Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting the
31938 &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& at the point where the
31939 datestamp is required. For example:
31940 .code
31941 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
31942 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
31943 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
31944 .endd
31945 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
31946 examples of names generated by the above examples:
31947 .code
31948 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
31949 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
31950 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
31951 .endd
31952 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
31953 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
31954 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
31955 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
31956
31957 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
31958 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
31959 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& is removed from the string.
31960 In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following non-alphanumeric
31961 character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric character is
31962 removed. Thus, the three examples above would give these panic log names:
31963 .code
31964 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
31965 /var/log/exim-panic.log
31966 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
31967 .endd
31968
31969
31970 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
31971 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
31972 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
31973 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
31974 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
31975 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
31976 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
31977 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
31978 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
31979 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
31980 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
31981 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
31982 the time and host name to each line.
31983 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
31984
31985 .ilist
31986 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
31987 .next
31988 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
31989 .next
31990 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
31991 .endlist
31992
31993 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
31994 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
31995 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
31996 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
31997
31998 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
31999 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
32000 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
32001 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
32002 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
32003 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
32004 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
32005 RFC 3164, you should set
32006 .code
32007 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
32008 .endd
32009 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
32010 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
32011
32012 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
32013 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
32014 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
32015 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
32016 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
32017 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
32018 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
32019 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
32020 name, and pid as added by syslog:
32021 .code
32022 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
32023 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
32024 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
32025 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
32026 [5/5] mple>)
32027 .endd
32028 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
32029 (LOG_NOTICE):
32030 .code
32031 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
32032 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
32033 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
32034 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
32035 [5\18] .example>)
32036 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
32037 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
32038 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
32039 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
32040 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
32041 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
32042 [12\18] F From: <>
32043 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
32044 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
32045 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
32046 [16\18] le>
32047 [17\18] B Bcc:
32048 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
32049 .endd
32050 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
32051 without modification.
32052
32053 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
32054 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
32055 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
32056 where it is.
32057
32058
32059
32060 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
32061 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
32062 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
32063 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
32064 timestamp. The flags are:
32065 .display
32066 &`<=`& message arrival
32067 &`=>`& normal message delivery
32068 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
32069 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
32070 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
32071 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
32072 .endd
32073
32074
32075 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
32076 .cindex "log" "reception line"
32077 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
32078 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
32079 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
32080 .code
32081 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
32082 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
32083 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
32084 .endd
32085 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
32086 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
32087 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
32088 .code
32089 R=<message id>
32090 .endd
32091 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
32092
32093 .cindex "HELO"
32094 .cindex "EHLO"
32095 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
32096 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
32097 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
32098 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
32099 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
32100 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
32101 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
32102 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
32103 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
32104 name in parentheses.
32105
32106 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
32107 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
32108 the log containing text like these examples:
32109 .code
32110 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
32111 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
32112 .endd
32113 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
32114 on.
32115
32116 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
32117 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
32118 of Exim.
32119
32120 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
32121 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
32122 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
32123 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
32124 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
32125 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
32126 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
32127 suite that was used.
32128
32129 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
32130 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
32131 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
32132 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
32133 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
32134 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
32135 authenticator name.
32136
32137 .cindex "size" "of message"
32138 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
32139 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
32140 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
32141 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
32142 other).
32143
32144 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
32145 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
32146
32147
32148
32149 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
32150 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
32151 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
32152 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
32153 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
32154 to fit it on the page:
32155 .code
32156 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
32157 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
32158 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
32159 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
32160 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
32161 .endd
32162 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
32163 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
32164 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
32165 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
32166 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
32167
32168 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
32169 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
32170 .display
32171 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
32172 .endd
32173 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
32174 parentheses afterwards.
32175
32176 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
32177 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
32178 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
32179 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
32180 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
32181 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
32182
32183 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
32184 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
32185
32186 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
32187 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
32188
32189
32190 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
32191 .cindex "discarded messages"
32192 .cindex "message" "discarded"
32193 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
32194 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
32195 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
32196 .code
32197 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
32198 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
32199 .endd
32200 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
32201 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
32202 .code
32203 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
32204 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
32205 .endd
32206
32207
32208 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
32209 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
32210 .code
32211 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
32212 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
32213 .endd
32214 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
32215 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
32216 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
32217 .code
32218 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
32219 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
32220 .endd
32221 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
32222 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
32223 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
32224
32225
32226
32227 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
32228 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
32229 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
32230 following form is logged:
32231 .code
32232 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
32233 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
32234 .endd
32235 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
32236 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
32237 .code
32238 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
32239 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
32240 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
32241 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
32242 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
32243 .endd
32244 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
32245 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
32246 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
32247 flagged with &`**`&.
32248
32249
32250
32251 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
32252 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
32253 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
32254 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
32255 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
32256
32257
32258
32259 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
32260 A line of the form
32261 .code
32262 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
32263 .endd
32264 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
32265 at the end of its processing.
32266
32267
32268
32269
32270 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
32271 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
32272 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
32273 the following table:
32274 .display
32275 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id)
32276 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
32277 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
32278 &`CV `& certificate verification status
32279 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
32280 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
32281 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
32282 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
32283 &`H `& host name and IP address
32284 &`I `& local interface used
32285 &`id `& message id for incoming message
32286 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
32287 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
32288 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
32289 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
32290 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
32291 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
32292 &`S `& size of message
32293 &`ST `& shadow transport name
32294 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
32295 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
32296 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
32297 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
32298 .endd
32299
32300
32301 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
32302 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
32303 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
32304
32305 .ilist
32306 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
32307 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
32308 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
32309 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
32310 during the first delivery attempt.
32311 .next
32312 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
32313 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
32314 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
32315 .next
32316 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
32317 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
32318 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
32319 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
32320 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
32321 doing.
32322 .next
32323 .cindex "error" "ignored"
32324 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
32325 message:
32326 .olist
32327 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
32328 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
32329 .next
32330 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
32331 failed. The delivery was discarded.
32332 .next
32333 A delivery set up by a router configured with
32334 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
32335 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
32336 .code
32337 errors_to = <>
32338 .endd
32339 failed. The delivery was discarded.
32340 .endlist olist
32341 .endlist ilist
32342
32343
32344
32345
32346
32347 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
32348 .cindex "log" "selectors"
32349 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
32350 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
32351 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
32352 example:
32353 .code
32354 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
32355 .endd
32356 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
32357 selection marked by asterisks:
32358 .display
32359 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
32360 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
32361 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
32362 &` arguments `& command line arguments
32363 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
32364 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
32365 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
32366 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
32367 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
32368 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
32369 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
32370 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
32371 &` incoming_interface `& incoming interface on <= lines
32372 &` incoming_port `& incoming port on <= lines
32373 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
32374 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
32375 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
32376 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
32377 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
32378 &` pid `& Exim process id
32379 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
32380 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
32381 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
32382 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
32383 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
32384 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
32385 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
32386 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
32387 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
32388 &` smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
32389 &` smtp_connection `& SMTP connections
32390 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
32391 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
32392 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
32393 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
32394 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
32395 &` tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
32396 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
32397 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
32398 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
32399
32400 &` all `& all of the above
32401 .endd
32402 More details on each of these items follows:
32403
32404 .ilist
32405 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
32406 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
32407 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
32408 this log selector is set.
32409 .next
32410 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
32411 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
32412 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
32413 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
32414 such users cannot access the log).
32415 .next
32416 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
32417 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
32418 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
32419 parentheses between them.
32420 .next
32421 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
32422 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
32423 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
32424 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
32425 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
32426 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
32427 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
32428 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
32429 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
32430 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
32431 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
32432 between the caller and Exim.
32433 .next
32434 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
32435 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
32436 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
32437 .next
32438 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
32439 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
32440 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
32441 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
32442 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
32443 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
32444 .next
32445 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
32446 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
32447 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
32448 .next
32449 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
32450 .cindex "size" "of message"
32451 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
32452 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
32453 .next
32454 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
32455 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
32456 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
32457 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
32458 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
32459 .next
32460 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
32461 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
32462 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
32463 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
32464 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
32465 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
32466 .next
32467 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
32468 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
32469 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
32470 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
32471 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
32472 .next
32473 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
32474 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
32475 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
32476 client's ident port times out.
32477 .next
32478 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
32479 .cindex "interface" "logging"
32480 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
32481 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
32482 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
32483 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, and to
32484 rejection lines.
32485 .next
32486 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
32487 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
32488 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
32489 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
32490 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
32491 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
32492 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
32493 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
32494 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
32495 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
32496 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
32497 .next
32498 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
32499 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
32500 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
32501 .next
32502 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
32503 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
32504 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
32505 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
32506 containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
32507 the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
32508 number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
32509 .next
32510 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
32511 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
32512 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
32513 immediately after the time and date.
32514 .next
32515 .cindex "log" "queue run"
32516 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
32517 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
32518 .next
32519 .cindex "log" "queue time"
32520 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
32521 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
32522 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
32523 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
32524 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
32525 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
32526 message has been successfully received.
32527 .next
32528 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
32529 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
32530 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
32531 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
32532 .next
32533 .cindex "log" "recipients"
32534 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
32535 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
32536 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
32537 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
32538 has taken place.
32539 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
32540 in the list.
32541 .next
32542 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
32543 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
32544 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
32545 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
32546 .next
32547 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
32548 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
32549 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
32550 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
32551 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
32552 .next
32553 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
32554 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
32555 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
32556 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
32557 attempt.
32558 .next
32559 .cindex "log" "return path"
32560 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
32561 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
32562 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
32563 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
32564 .next
32565 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
32566 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
32567 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
32568 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
32569 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
32570 .next
32571 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
32572 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
32573 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
32574 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
32575 detail is lost.
32576 .next
32577 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
32578 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
32579 it is too big.
32580 .next
32581 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
32582 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
32583 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
32584 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
32585 it.
32586 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
32587 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
32588 .next
32589 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
32590 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
32591 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP dialogue for
32592 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
32593 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
32594 response.
32595 .next
32596 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
32597 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
32598 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
32599 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
32600 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
32601 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
32602 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
32603 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
32604 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
32605 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
32606
32607 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
32608 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
32609 reset if the daemon is restarted.
32610 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
32611 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
32612 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
32613 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
32614 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
32615 .next
32616 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
32617 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
32618 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
32619 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
32620 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
32621 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
32622 .next
32623 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
32624 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
32625 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
32626 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
32627 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
32628 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
32629 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
32630 already have their own log lines.
32631
32632 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
32633 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
32634 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
32635 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
32636 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
32637 the same logging options.
32638
32639 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
32640 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
32641 .code
32642 C=EHLO,QUIT
32643 .endd
32644 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
32645 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
32646 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
32647 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accep_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
32648 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
32649 .next
32650 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
32651 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
32652 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
32653 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
32654 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
32655 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
32656 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
32657 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
32658 .next
32659 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
32660 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
32661 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
32662 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
32663 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
32664 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
32665 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
32666 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
32667 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
32668 .next
32669 .cindex "log" "subject"
32670 .cindex "subject, logging"
32671 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
32672 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
32673 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
32674 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
32675 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
32676 .next
32677 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
32678 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
32679 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
32680 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
32681 .next
32682 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
32683 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
32684 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
32685 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
32686 .next
32687 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
32688 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
32689 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
32690 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
32691 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
32692 .next
32693 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
32694 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
32695 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
32696 .endlist
32697
32698
32699 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
32700 .cindex "message" "log file for"
32701 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
32702 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
32703 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
32704 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
32705 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
32706 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
32707 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
32708 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
32709 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
32710 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
32711 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
32712
32713 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
32714 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
32715 &%message_logs%& option false.
32716 .ecindex IIDloggen
32717
32718
32719
32720
32721 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32722 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32723
32724 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
32725 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
32726 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
32727 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
32728 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
32729
32730 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
32731 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
32732 "list what Exim processes are doing"
32733 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
32734 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
32735 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
32736 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
32737 various criteria"
32738 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
32739 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
32740 "extract statistics from the log"
32741 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
32742 "check address acceptance from given IP"
32743 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
32744 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
32745 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
32746 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
32747 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
32748 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
32749 .endtable
32750
32751 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
32752 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
32753 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
32754
32755
32756
32757
32758 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
32759 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
32760 .cindex "process, querying"
32761 .cindex "SIGUSR1"
32762 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
32763 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
32764 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
32765 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
32766 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
32767 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
32768 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
32769 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
32770
32771 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
32772 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
32773 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
32774
32775
32776 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
32777 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
32778 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
32779 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
32780 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
32781 options:
32782 .display
32783 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
32784 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
32785 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
32786 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
32787 .endd
32788 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
32789 .code
32790 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
32791 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
32792 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
32793 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
32794 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
32795 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
32796 .endd
32797 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
32798 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
32799
32800
32801
32802 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
32803 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
32804 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
32805 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
32806 .code
32807 exim -bpu
32808 .endd
32809 to obtain a queue listing with undelivered recipients only, and then greps the
32810 output to select messages that match given criteria. The following selection
32811 options are available:
32812
32813 .vlist
32814 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
32815 Match the sender address. The field that is tested is enclosed in angle
32816 brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
32817 .code
32818 exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
32819 .endd
32820 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
32821 Match a recipient address. The field that is tested is not enclosed in angle
32822 brackets.
32823
32824 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
32825 Match against the size field.
32826
32827 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
32828 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
32829
32830 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
32831 Match messages that are older than the given time.
32832
32833 .vitem &*-z*&
32834 Match only frozen messages.
32835
32836 .vitem &*-x*&
32837 Match only non-frozen messages.
32838 .endlist
32839
32840 The following options control the format of the output:
32841
32842 .vlist
32843 .vitem &*-c*&
32844 Display only the count of matching messages.
32845
32846 .vitem &*-l*&
32847 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
32848 the default.
32849
32850 .vitem &*-i*&
32851 Display message ids only.
32852
32853 .vitem &*-b*&
32854 Brief format &-- one line per message.
32855
32856 .vitem &*-R*&
32857 Display messages in reverse order.
32858 .endlist
32859
32860 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
32861
32862
32863
32864 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
32865 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
32866 .cindex "queue" "summary"
32867 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
32868 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
32869 running a command such as
32870 .code
32871 exim -bp | exiqsumm
32872 .endd
32873 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
32874 it, as in the following example:
32875 .code
32876 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
32877 .endd
32878 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
32879 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
32880 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
32881 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
32882
32883 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
32884 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
32885 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
32886 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
32887 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
32888 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
32889 sender.
32890
32891 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
32892 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
32893 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
32894 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
32895 level"& addresses).
32896
32897
32898
32899
32900 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
32901 "SECTextspeinf"
32902 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
32903 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
32904 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
32905 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
32906 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
32907 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
32908 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
32909 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
32910 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
32911 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
32912 .display
32913 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
32914 .endd
32915 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
32916
32917 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
32918 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
32919 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
32920
32921 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
32922 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
32923 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
32924 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
32925 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
32926
32927 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
32928 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
32929 regular expression.
32930
32931 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
32932 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
32933
32934 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
32935 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
32936 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
32937
32938
32939 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
32940 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
32941 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
32942 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
32943 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
32944 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
32945 the &%--help%& option.
32946
32947
32948 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
32949 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
32950 .cindex "cycling logs"
32951 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
32952 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
32953 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
32954 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
32955 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
32956 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
32957 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
32958 .ilist
32959 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
32960 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
32961 .next
32962 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
32963 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
32964 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
32965 configuration.
32966 .endlist
32967
32968 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
32969 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
32970 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
32971 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
32972 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
32973 logs are handled similarly.
32974
32975 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
32976 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
32977 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
32978 any existing log files.
32979
32980 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
32981 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
32982 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
32983 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
32984 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
32985 .code
32986 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
32987 .endd
32988 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
32989 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
32990
32991
32992
32993 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
32994 .cindex "statistics"
32995 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
32996 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
32997 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
32998 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
32999 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
33000
33001 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
33002 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
33003 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
33004 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
33005 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
33006 .code
33007 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
33008 .endd
33009 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
33010 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
33011 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
33012 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
33013 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
33014 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
33015 also produced per user.
33016
33017 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
33018 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
33019 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
33020 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
33021 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
33022
33023 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
33024 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
33025 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
33026 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
33027 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
33028 an entirely separate message.
33029
33030 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
33031 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
33032 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
33033 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
33034 least one address that failed.
33035
33036 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
33037 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
33038 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
33039 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
33040 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
33041 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
33042 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
33043
33044 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
33045 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
33046 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
33047
33048 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
33049 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
33050 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
33051 .code
33052 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
33053 .endd
33054
33055 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
33056 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
33057 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
33058 .cindex "checking access"
33059 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
33060 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
33061 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
33062 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
33063 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
33064 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
33065
33066 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
33067 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
33068 .code
33069 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
33070 .endd
33071 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
33072 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
33073 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
33074 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
33075 .code
33076 Rejected:
33077 550 Relay not permitted
33078 .endd
33079 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
33080 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
33081 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
33082 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
33083 you can use:
33084 .code
33085 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
33086 -f himself@there.example
33087 .endd
33088 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
33089 mandatory arguments.
33090
33091 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
33092 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
33093 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
33094
33095
33096
33097 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
33098 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
33099 .cindex "building DBM files"
33100 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
33101 .cindex "lower casing"
33102 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
33103 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
33104 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
33105 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
33106 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
33107 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
33108
33109 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
33110 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
33111 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
33112 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
33113 files.
33114
33115 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
33116 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
33117 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
33118 well.
33119
33120 .cindex "USE_DB"
33121 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
33122 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
33123 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
33124 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
33125 .code
33126 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
33127 .endd
33128 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
33129 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
33130
33131 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
33132 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
33133 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
33134 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
33135 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
33136 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
33137
33138 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
33139 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
33140 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
33141 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
33142 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
33143 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
33144 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
33145 return code is 2.
33146
33147
33148
33149
33150 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
33151 .cindex "retry" "times"
33152 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
33153 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
33154 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
33155 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
33156 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
33157 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
33158 output. For example:
33159 .code
33160 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
33161 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
33162 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
33163 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
33164 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
33165 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
33166 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
33167 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
33168 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
33169 past final cutoff time
33170 .endd
33171 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
33172 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
33173 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
33174 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
33175 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
33176 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
33177 run very often.
33178
33179 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
33180 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
33181 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
33182 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
33183 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
33184 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
33185
33186
33187
33188 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
33189 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
33190 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
33191 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
33192 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
33193 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
33194 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
33195
33196 .ilist
33197 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
33198 .next
33199 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
33200 for remote hosts
33201 .next
33202 &'callout'&: the callout cache
33203 .next
33204 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
33205 .next
33206 &'misc'&: other hints data
33207 .endlist
33208
33209 The &'misc'& database is used for
33210
33211 .ilist
33212 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
33213 .next
33214 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
33215 &(smtp)& transport)
33216 .endlist
33217
33218
33219
33220 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
33221 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
33222 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
33223 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
33224 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
33225 .code
33226 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
33227 .endd
33228 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
33229 .code
33230 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
33231 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
33232 .endd
33233 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
33234 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
33235 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
33236 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
33237 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
33238 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
33239 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
33240 and a textual description of the error.
33241
33242 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
33243 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
33244 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
33245 exceeded.
33246
33247 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
33248 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
33249 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
33250 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
33251 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
33252 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
33253 cross-references.
33254
33255
33256
33257 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
33258 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
33259 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
33260 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
33261 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
33262 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
33263 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
33264 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
33265 updated sufficiently often.
33266
33267 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
33268 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
33269 the retry database:
33270 .code
33271 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
33272 .endd
33273 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
33274 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
33275 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
33276 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
33277 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
33278 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
33279 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
33280 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
33281 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
33282 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
33283 whenever it removes information from the database.
33284
33285 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
33286 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
33287 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
33288 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
33289 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
33290
33291 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
33292 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
33293 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
33294 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
33295 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
33296 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
33297 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
33298 tidied.
33299
33300 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
33301 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
33302
33303
33304
33305
33306 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
33307 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
33308 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
33309 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
33310 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
33311 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
33312 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
33313 displayed.
33314
33315 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
33316 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
33317 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
33318 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
33319 by new data, for example:
33320 .code
33321 > 4 951102:1000
33322 .endd
33323 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
33324 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
33325 used as optional separators.
33326
33327
33328
33329
33330 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
33331 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
33332 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
33333 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
33334 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
33335 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
33336 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
33337 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
33338 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
33339 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
33340 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
33341 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
33342 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
33343
33344 .vlist
33345 .vitem &%-fcntl%&
33346 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
33347
33348 .vitem &%-flock%&
33349 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
33350 supports it.
33351
33352 .vitem &%-interval%&
33353 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
33354 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
33355
33356 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
33357 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
33358
33359 .vitem &%-mbx%&
33360 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
33361
33362 .vitem &%-q%&
33363 Suppress verification output.
33364
33365 .vitem &%-retries%&
33366 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
33367 the lock (default 10).
33368
33369 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
33370 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
33371 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
33372 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
33373 subsequently sees.
33374
33375 .vitem &%-timeout%&
33376 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
33377 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
33378 default), a non-blocking call is used.
33379
33380 .vitem &%-v%&
33381 Generate verbose output.
33382 .endlist
33383
33384 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
33385 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
33386 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
33387 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
33388 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
33389 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
33390 more than 30 minutes old.
33391
33392 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
33393 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
33394 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
33395 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
33396 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
33397 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
33398
33399 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
33400 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
33401 suppresses all output except error messages.
33402
33403 A command such as
33404 .code
33405 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
33406 .endd
33407 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
33408 .display
33409 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
33410 <&'some commands'&>
33411 &`End`&
33412 .endd
33413 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
33414 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
33415 such as
33416 .code
33417 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
33418 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
33419 .endd
33420 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
33421 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
33422 .ecindex IIDutils
33423
33424
33425 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33426 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33427
33428 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
33429 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
33430 .cindex "X-windows"
33431 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
33432 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
33433 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
33434 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
33435 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
33436 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
33437 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
33438 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
33439
33440
33441
33442 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
33443 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
33444 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
33445 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
33446 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
33447 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
33448 parameters are for.
33449
33450 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
33451 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
33452 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
33453 .code
33454 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
33455 .endd
33456 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
33457 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
33458 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
33459 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
33460 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
33461
33462 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
33463 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
33464 .code
33465 Eximon*background: gray94
33466 .endd
33467 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
33468 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
33469 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
33470 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
33471 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
33472 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
33473 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
33474 .code
33475 xrdb -merge <<End
33476 Eximon*highlight: gray
33477 End
33478 .endd
33479 .cindex "admin user"
33480 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
33481 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
33482
33483 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
33484 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
33485 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
33486 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
33487 different parts of the display.
33488
33489
33490
33491
33492 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
33493 .cindex "stripchart"
33494 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
33495 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
33496 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
33497 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
33498 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
33499 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
33500 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
33501 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
33502 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
33503
33504 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
33505 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
33506 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
33507 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
33508
33509 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
33510 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
33511 to a single partition.
33512
33513 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
33514 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
33515 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
33516 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
33517 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
33518 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
33519 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
33520
33521
33522
33523
33524 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
33525 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
33526 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
33527 .cindex "window size"
33528 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
33529 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
33530 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
33531 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
33532 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
33533 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
33534
33535 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
33536 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
33537 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
33538 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
33539
33540 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
33541 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
33542 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
33543 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
33544 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
33545 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
33546
33547 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
33548 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
33549 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
33550
33551
33552
33553 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
33554 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
33555 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
33556 the main log is maintained.
33557 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
33558 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
33559 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
33560 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
33561 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
33562
33563 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
33564 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
33565 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
33566 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
33567 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
33568 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
33569 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
33570 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
33571 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
33572 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
33573 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
33574
33575 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
33576 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
33577 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
33578 It cannot go further back up the log.
33579
33580 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
33581 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
33582 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
33583 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
33584 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
33585 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
33586
33587 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
33588 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
33589 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
33590 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
33591 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
33592 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
33593
33594 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
33595 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
33596 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
33597 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
33598 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
33599 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
33600 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
33601 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
33602 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
33603 window.
33604
33605
33606
33607 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
33608 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
33609 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
33610 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
33611 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
33612 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
33613 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
33614 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
33615 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
33616 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
33617
33618 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
33619 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
33620 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
33621 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
33622 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
33623 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
33624 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
33625
33626 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
33627 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
33628 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
33629 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
33630 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
33631 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
33632 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
33633
33634 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
33635 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
33636 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
33637 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
33638
33639 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
33640 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
33641 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
33642 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
33643 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
33644 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
33645 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
33646 not shown.
33647
33648 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
33649 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
33650
33651 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
33652 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
33653 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
33654 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
33655 display is updated.
33656
33657
33658
33659 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
33660 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
33661 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
33662 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
33663 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
33664 any selected text.
33665
33666 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
33667 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
33668 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
33669 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
33670 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
33671 .code
33672 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
33673 .endd
33674 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
33675 follows:
33676
33677 .ilist
33678 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
33679 in a new text window.
33680 .next
33681 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
33682 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
33683 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
33684 .next
33685 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
33686 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
33687 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
33688 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
33689 .next
33690 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
33691 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
33692 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
33693 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
33694 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
33695 .next
33696 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
33697 that the message be frozen.
33698 .next
33699 .cindex "thawing messages"
33700 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
33701 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
33702 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
33703 that the message be thawed.
33704 .next
33705 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
33706 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
33707 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
33708 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
33709 .next
33710 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
33711 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
33712 message.
33713 .next
33714 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
33715 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
33716 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
33717 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
33718 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
33719 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
33720 which case no action is taken.
33721 .next
33722 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
33723 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
33724 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
33725 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
33726 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
33727 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
33728 case no action is taken.
33729 .next
33730 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
33731 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
33732 .next
33733 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
33734 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
33735 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
33736 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
33737 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
33738 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
33739 the address is qualified with that domain.
33740 .endlist
33741
33742 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
33743 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
33744 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
33745 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
33746 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
33747 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
33748 if no output is generated.
33749
33750 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
33751 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
33752 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
33753 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
33754
33755 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
33756 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
33757 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
33758 .ecindex IIDeximon
33759
33760
33761
33762
33763
33764 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33765 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33766
33767 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
33768 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
33769 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
33770 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
33771
33772 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
33773 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
33774 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
33775 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
33776 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
33777 its security as compared with other MTAs.
33778
33779 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
33780 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
33781 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
33782 as soon as possible.
33783
33784
33785 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
33786 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
33787 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
33788 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
33789 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
33790 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
33791
33792 .ilist
33793 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
33794 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
33795 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
33796 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
33797 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
33798 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
33799
33800 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
33801 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
33802 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
33803 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
33804 .next
33805 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. the default configuration file or
33806 one which is trusted by virtue of matching a prefix listed in the
33807 TRUSTED_CONFIG_PREFIX_LIST file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are
33808 given with &%-D%&, then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim
33809 is root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
33810 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
33811 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
33812 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
33813 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
33814 separate commands.
33815 .next
33816 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
33817 is disabled.
33818 .next
33819 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
33820 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
33821 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
33822 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
33823 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
33824 .endlist
33825
33826
33827
33828
33829 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
33830 .cindex "setuid"
33831 .cindex "root privilege"
33832 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
33833 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
33834 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
33835 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
33836 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
33837 is required for two things:
33838
33839 .ilist
33840 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
33841 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
33842 not required.
33843 .next
33844 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
33845 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
33846 configuration.
33847 .endlist
33848
33849 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
33850 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
33851 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
33852 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
33853 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
33854 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
33855 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
33856 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
33857
33858 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
33859 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
33860 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
33861
33862 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
33863 uid and gid in the following cases:
33864
33865 .ilist
33866 .oindex "&%-C%&"
33867 .oindex "&%-D%&"
33868 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
33869 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
33870 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
33871 the calling process.
33872 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
33873 option may not be used at all.
33874 .next
33875 .oindex "&%-be%&"
33876 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
33877 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
33878 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
33879 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
33880 calling process.
33881 .next
33882 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
33883 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
33884 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
33885 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
33886 testing address verification
33887 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
33888 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
33889 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
33890 option).
33891 .next
33892 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
33893 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
33894 .endlist
33895
33896 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
33897
33898 .ilist
33899 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
33900 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
33901 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
33902 will be used during message reception.
33903 .next
33904 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
33905 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
33906 .next
33907 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
33908 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
33909 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
33910 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
33911 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
33912 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
33913 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
33914 generating bounce and warning messages.
33915
33916 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
33917 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
33918 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
33919 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
33920 .next
33921 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
33922 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
33923 .endlist
33924
33925
33926
33927
33928 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
33929 .cindex "privilege, running without"
33930 .cindex "unprivileged running"
33931 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
33932 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
33933 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
33934 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
33935 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
33936 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
33937 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
33938 to any other uid.
33939
33940 .cindex SIGHUP
33941 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
33942 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
33943 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
33944 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
33945
33946 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
33947 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
33948 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
33949 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
33950 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
33951
33952 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
33953 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
33954 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
33955 effect.
33956
33957 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
33958 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
33959 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
33960
33961 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
33962 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
33963 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
33964 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
33965 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
33966 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
33967 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
33968 address this problem at this time.
33969
33970 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
33971 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
33972 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
33973 be used in the most straightforward way.
33974
33975 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
33976 number of restrictions on what you can do:
33977
33978 .ilist
33979 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
33980 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
33981 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
33982 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
33983 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
33984 .next
33985 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
33986 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
33987 .next
33988 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
33989 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
33990 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
33991 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
33992 .next
33993 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
33994 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
33995
33996 .olist
33997 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
33998 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
33999 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
34000 .next
34001 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
34002 owned by the Exim user.
34003 .next
34004 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
34005 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
34006 mailboxes need to be created manually.
34007 .endlist olist
34008 .endlist ilist
34009
34010
34011 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
34012 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
34013 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
34014 gives more security at essentially no cost.
34015
34016 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
34017 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
34018
34019
34020
34021
34022 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
34023 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
34024 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
34025
34026
34027
34028 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
34029 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
34030 .cindex "IP source routing"
34031 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
34032 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
34033 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
34034 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
34035
34036
34037
34038 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
34039 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
34040 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
34041
34042
34043
34044
34045 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
34046 .cindex "trusted users"
34047 .cindex "admin user"
34048 .cindex "privileged user"
34049 .cindex "user" "trusted"
34050 .cindex "user" "admin"
34051 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
34052 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
34053 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
34054 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
34055 permit a remote host to be specified.
34056
34057 .oindex "&%-f%&"
34058 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
34059 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
34060 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
34061 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
34062 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
34063 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
34064
34065 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
34066 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
34067 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
34068 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
34069 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
34070
34071 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
34072 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
34073 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
34074 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
34075 includes the contents of files on the spool.
34076
34077 .oindex "&%-M%&"
34078 .oindex "&%-q%&"
34079 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
34080 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
34081 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
34082 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
34083 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
34084 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
34085
34086 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
34087 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
34088 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
34089 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
34090 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
34091 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
34092 files.
34093
34094
34095
34096 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
34097 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
34098 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
34099 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
34100 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
34101 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
34102
34103
34104
34105 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
34106 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
34107 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
34108 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
34109 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
34110 this.
34111
34112
34113
34114 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
34115 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
34116 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
34117 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
34118 converted output.
34119
34120
34121
34122 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
34123 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
34124 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
34125 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
34126 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
34127
34128
34129
34130 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
34131 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
34132 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
34133 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
34134 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
34135 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
34136 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
34137
34138 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
34139 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
34140 string.
34141
34142
34143
34144 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
34145 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
34146 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
34147 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
34148
34149
34150
34151 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
34152 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
34153 enough to hold the result.
34154 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
34155
34156
34157
34158
34159 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34160 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34161
34162 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
34163 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
34164 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
34165 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
34166 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
34167 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
34168 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
34169 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
34170 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
34171 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
34172 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
34173 themselves are recoverable.
34174
34175 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
34176 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
34177 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
34178
34179 .ilist
34180 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
34181 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
34182 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
34183 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
34184 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
34185 .next
34186 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
34187 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
34188 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
34189 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
34190 will always be the case.
34191 .next
34192 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
34193 .next
34194 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
34195 signature.
34196 .endlist
34197 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
34198
34199 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
34200 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
34201 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
34202 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
34203 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
34204 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
34205 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
34206 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
34207 attempt.
34208
34209 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
34210 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
34211 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
34212 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
34213 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
34214 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
34215 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
34216 normally the Exim user.
34217
34218 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
34219 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
34220 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
34221 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
34222 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
34223 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
34224 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
34225 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
34226
34227 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
34228 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
34229 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
34230 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
34231
34232 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
34233 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
34234
34235 .vlist
34236 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
34237 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
34238 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
34239 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
34240 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
34241 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
34242 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
34243 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
34244 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
34245 newlines.
34246
34247 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
34248 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
34249 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
34250 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
34251 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
34252 character. It may contain internal newlines.
34253
34254 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
34255 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
34256 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
34257 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
34258 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
34259 character. It may contain internal newlines.
34260
34261 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
34262 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
34263 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
34264
34265 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
34266 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
34267 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
34268 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
34269 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
34270
34271 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
34272 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
34273 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
34274 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
34275 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
34276
34277 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
34278 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
34279 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
34280
34281 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
34282 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
34283 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
34284
34285 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
34286 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
34287 present.
34288
34289 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
34290 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
34291 present if the number is greater than zero.
34292
34293 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
34294 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
34295 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
34296
34297 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
34298 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
34299 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
34300
34301 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
34302 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
34303 command.
34304
34305 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
34306 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
34307 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
34308 messages.
34309
34310 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
34311 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
34312 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
34313 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
34314
34315 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
34316 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
34317 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
34318
34319 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
34320 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
34321 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
34322 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
34323 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
34324 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
34325
34326 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
34327 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
34328 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
34329 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
34330 supplied by the remote host, if any.
34331
34332 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
34333 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
34334 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
34335 generated messages.
34336
34337 .vitem &%-local%&
34338 The message is from a local sender.
34339
34340 .vitem &%-localerror%&
34341 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
34342
34343 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
34344 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
34345 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
34346 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
34347
34348 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
34349 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
34350 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
34351
34352 .vitem &%-N%&
34353 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
34354 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
34355 &%-N%& is assumed.
34356
34357 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
34358 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
34359 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
34360
34361 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
34362 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
34363 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
34364
34365 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
34366 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
34367 of &$spam_score_int$&.
34368
34369 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
34370 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
34371 certificate was verified by the server.
34372
34373 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
34374 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
34375 name of the cipher suite that was used.
34376
34377 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
34378 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
34379 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
34380 certificate.
34381 .endlist
34382
34383 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
34384 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
34385 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
34386 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
34387 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
34388 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
34389 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
34390 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
34391 addresses are complete.
34392
34393 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
34394 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
34395 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
34396 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
34397 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
34398 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
34399 .code
34400 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
34401 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
34402 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34403 .endd
34404 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
34405 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
34406 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
34407 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
34408 example:
34409 .code
34410 4
34411 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34412 darcy@austen.fict.example
34413 rdo@foundation
34414 alice@wonderland.fict.example
34415 .endd
34416 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
34417 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
34418 line is of the following form:
34419 .display
34420 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
34421 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
34422 .endd
34423 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
34424 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
34425 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
34426 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
34427 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
34428 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
34429 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
34430 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
34431
34432
34433 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
34434 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
34435 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
34436 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
34437 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
34438 following:
34439
34440 .table2 50pt
34441 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
34442 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
34443 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
34444 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
34445 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
34446 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
34447 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
34448 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
34449 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
34450 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
34451 .endtable
34452
34453 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
34454 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
34455 typical set of headers:
34456 .code
34457 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
34458 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
34459 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
34460 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
34461 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
34462 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
34463 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
34464 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34465 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
34466 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34467 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
34468 .endd
34469 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
34470 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
34471 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
34472 .ecindex IIDforspo1
34473 .ecindex IIDforspo2
34474 .ecindex IIDforspo3
34475
34476 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34477 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34478
34479 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail) - RFC4871" "CHID12" &&&
34480 "DKIM Support"
34481 .cindex "DKIM"
34482
34483 Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
34484 disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
34485
34486 Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
34487 .olist
34488 Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
34489 It can co-exist with all other Exim features, including transport filters.
34490 .next
34491 Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
34492 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
34493 different signature contexts.
34494 .endlist
34495
34496 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
34497 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
34498 Exim's standard controls.
34499
34500 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
34501 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
34502 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
34503 signature status. Here is an example:
34504 .code
34505 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM: d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
34506 .endd
34507 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
34508 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
34509 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
34510 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
34511 senders).
34512
34513
34514 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
34515 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
34516
34517 Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
34518 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
34519
34520 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
34521 MANDATORY:
34522 The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
34523 option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
34524
34525 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
34526 MANDATORY:
34527 This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
34528 variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
34529 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
34530 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
34531
34532 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
34533 MANDATORY:
34534 This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
34535 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
34536 The result can either
34537 .ilist
34538 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
34539 .next
34540 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
34541 the private key.
34542 .next
34543 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
34544 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
34545 is set.
34546 .endlist
34547
34548 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
34549 OPTIONAL:
34550 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
34551 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
34552 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
34553 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
34554
34555 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
34556 OPTIONAL:
34557 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
34558 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
34559 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
34560 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
34561 variables here.
34562
34563 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
34564 OPTIONAL:
34565 When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
34566 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
34567 signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
34568 used.
34569
34570
34571 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
34572 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
34573
34574 Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
34575 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
34576 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
34577
34578 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
34579 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
34580 runtime of the ACL.
34581
34582 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
34583 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
34584 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
34585 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
34586
34587 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
34588 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
34589 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
34590 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
34591 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
34592 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
34593 it defaults as:
34594 .code
34595 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
34596 .endd
34597 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
34598 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
34599 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
34600 .code
34601 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
34602 .endd
34603 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
34604 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
34605 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
34606 .code
34607 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
34608 .endd
34609
34610 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
34611 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
34612
34613
34614 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
34615 available (from most to least important):
34616
34617 .vlist
34618 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
34619 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
34620 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
34621 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
34622 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
34623 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
34624 .ilist
34625 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
34626 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
34627 .next
34628 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
34629 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
34630 .next
34631 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
34632 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
34633 .next
34634 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
34635 .endlist
34636 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
34637 A string giving a litte bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
34638 "fail" or "invalid". One of
34639 .ilist
34640 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
34641 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
34642 .next
34643 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
34644 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
34645 .next
34646 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
34647 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
34648 means that the message body was modified in transit.
34649 .next
34650 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
34651 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
34652 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
34653 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
34654 .endlist
34655 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
34656 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
34657 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
34658 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
34659 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
34660 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
34661 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
34662 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
34663 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
34664 The key record selector string.
34665 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
34666 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
34667 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
34668 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
34669 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
34670 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
34671 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
34672 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
34673 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
34674 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
34675 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
34676 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
34677 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
34678 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
34679 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
34680 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
34681 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
34682 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
34683 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
34684 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
34685 integer size comparisons against this value.
34686 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
34687 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
34688 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
34689 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
34690 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomaining%&
34691 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
34692 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
34693 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
34694 in the key record.
34695 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
34696 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
34697 in the key record.
34698 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
34699 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
34700 .endlist
34701
34702 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
34703
34704 .vlist
34705 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
34706 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
34707 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
34708 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
34709 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
34710
34711 .code
34712 # Warn when message apparently from GMail has no signature at all
34713 warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
34714 sender_domains = gmail.com
34715 dkim_signers = gmail.com
34716 dkim_status = none
34717 .endd
34718
34719 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
34720 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
34721 results agains the actual result of verification. This is typically used
34722 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, like:
34723
34724 .code
34725 deny message = Message from Paypal with invalid or missing signature
34726 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
34727 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
34728 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
34729 .endd
34730
34731 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
34732 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
34733 for more information of what they mean.
34734 .endlist
34735
34736 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34737 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34738
34739 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
34740 "Adding drivers or lookups"
34741 .cindex "adding drivers"
34742 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
34743 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
34744 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
34745 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
34746
34747 .olist
34748 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
34749 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
34750 .next
34751 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
34752 .display
34753 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
34754 .endd
34755 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
34756 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
34757 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
34758 .next
34759 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
34760 .code
34761 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
34762 .endd
34763 .next
34764 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
34765 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
34766 .next
34767 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
34768 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
34769 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
34770 .next
34771 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
34772 &_src_&.
34773 .next
34774 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
34775 as for other drivers and lookups.
34776 .endlist
34777
34778 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
34779 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
34780 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
34781 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
34782 searched using a binary chop procedure.
34783
34784 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
34785 the interface that is expected.
34786
34787
34788
34789
34790 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34791 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34792
34793 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34794 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
34795 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
34796 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
34797 . processors.
34798 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34799
34800 .literal xml
34801 <?sdop
34802 format="newpage"
34803 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
34804 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
34805 ?>
34806 .literal off
34807
34808 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
34809 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
34810 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
34811
34812
34813 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34814 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////